OWNER’S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time
of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make
changes at any time so that our policy of continual product
improvement may be carried out.
This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes
descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard
equipment. As a result, you may find material in this manual
that does not apply to your specific vehicle.
Introduction
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR HYUNDAI
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering
the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations
established by the U.S. Department of Transportation and other federal or state
agencies.
7:2ǘ:$<5$',225&(//8/$5
TELEPHONE INSTALLATION
Your vehicle is equipped with electronic fuel injection and other electronic
components. It is possible for an improperly installed/adjusted two-way radio
or cellular telephone to adversely affect electronic systems. For this reason,
we recommend that you carefully follow the radio manufacturer’s instructions
or consult your HYUNDAI dealer for precautionary measures or special
instructions if you choose to install one of these devices.
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and
NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in
death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result
in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
F2
HYUNDAI VEHICLE OWNER PRIVACY POLICY
Your Hyundai vehicle may be equipped with technologies and services that use
information collected, generated, recorded or stored by the vehicle. Hyundai
has created a Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy to explain how these technologies
and services collect use and share this information.
You may read our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy on the Hyundaiusa.com website
at: https://www.hyundaiusa.com/owner-privacy-policy.aspx
If you would like to receive a hard copy of our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy,
please contact our Customer Care Center at:
Hyundai Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728
800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through
Friday, between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST and Saturday between
6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Care assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are
available Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
F3
Table of Contents
Foreword
1
Vehicle Information
2
Safety System
3
Instrument Cluster
4
Convenience Features
5
While Driving
6
Emergency Situations
7
Maintenance
8
Index
I
1. Foreword
Introduction........................................................................................................ 1-2
Hyundai Motor America .................................................................................... 1-2
Guide to Hyundai Genuine Parts ...................................................................... 1-3
How to Use This Manual ....................................................................................1-4
Safety Messages ................................................................................................1-4
Fuel Requirements ............................................................................................. 1-5
Vehicle Modifications ........................................................................................ 1-7
Vehicle Break-In Process ................................................................................... 1-7
Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders ........................................1-8
1
Foreword
INTRODUCTION
Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome
you to the growing number of discerning people who drive HYUNDAIs. We are very
proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of each HYUNDAI
we build.
Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new
HYUNDAI. To become familiar with your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it,
read this Owner’s Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle.
This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to
familiarize you with your vehicle’s controls and safety features so you can safely
operate your vehicle.
This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe
operation of the vehicle. It is recommended that all service and maintenance on your
car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. HYUNDAI dealers are prepared
to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance that may be
required.
This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and
should be kept in the vehicle so you can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay
with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with important operating, safety
and maintenance information.
HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA
CAUTION
Severe engine and transmission damage may result from the use of poor quality
fuels and lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications. You must always use
high quality fuels and lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 2-11 in
the Vehicle Specifications section of the Owner’s Manual.
Copyright 2021 HYUNDAI Motor America. All rights reserved. No part of this publication
may be reproduced, stored in any retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any
means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI Motor America.
1-2
01
GUIDE TO HYUNDAI GENUINE PARTS
1. What are HYUNDAI Genuine Parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are the
same parts used by HYUNDAI Motor
Company to manufacture vehicles.
They are designed and tested for the
optimum safety, performance, and
reliability for our customers.
2. What are HYUNDAI Genuine Parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are
engineered and built to meet rigid
manufacturing requirements.
Damage caused by using imitation,
counterfeit or used salvage parts is
not covered under the HYUNDAI New
Vehicle Limited Warranty or any other
HYUNDAI warranty.
In addition, any damage to or failure
of HYUNDAI Genuine Parts caused
by the installation or failure of an
imitation, counterfeit or used salvage
part is not covered by any HYUNDAI
Warranty.
3. How can you tell if you are
purchasing HYUNDAI Genuine Parts?
Look for the HYUNDAI Genuine Parts
Logo on the package (see below).
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts exported
to the U.S. are packaged with labels
written only in English.
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are only
sold through authorized HYUNDAI
Dealerships.
1-3
Foreword
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
SAFETY MESSAGES
We want to help you get the greatest
possible driving pleasure from your
vehicle. Your Owner’s Manual can assist
you in many ways. To gain an overview
of the contents of your Owner’s Manual,
use the Table of Contents in the front
of the manual. The first page of each
Chapter includes a detailed Table of
Contents of the topics in that Chapter.
To quickly locate information about your
vehicle, use the Index in the back of the
manual. It is an alphabetical list of what
is in this manual and the page number
where it can be found.
For your convenience, we have
incorporated tabs on the right-hand
page edges. These tabs are coded with
the Chapter titles to assist you with
navigating through the manual.
Your safety, and the safety of others,
is very important. This Owner’s
Manual provides you with many safety
precautions and operating procedures.
This information alerts you to potential
hazards that may hurt you or others, as
well as damage to your vehicle.
Safety messages found on vehicle
labels and in this manual describe these
hazards and what to do to avoid or
reduce the risks.
Warnings and instructions contained in
this manual are for your safety. Failure to
follow safety warnings and instructions
can lead to serious injury or death.
1-4
01
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
Throughout this manual DANGER,
WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and the
SAFETY ALERT SYMBOL will be used.
This is the safety alert symbol. It
is used to alert you to potential
physical injury hazards. Obey
all safety messages that follow
this symbol to avoid possible
injury or death. The safety alert
symbol precedes the signal
words DANGER, WARNING and
CAUTION.
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, will
result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided, could
result in minor or moderate injury.
Your new vehicle is designed to obtain
maximum performance with UNLEADED
FUEL, as well as minimize exhaust
emissions and spark plug fouling.
Your new vehicle is designed to perform
optimally unleaded fuel having an octane
number ((R+M)/2) of 87 (Research
Octane Number 91) or higher. (Do not
use methanol blended fuels)
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the engine and
engine components, never add any fuel
system cleaning agents to the fuel tank
other than what has been specified.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for additional information.
WARNING
ś Do not “top off” after the nozzle
automatically shuts off when
refueling.
ś Always check that the fuel cap is
installed securely to prevent fuel
spillage in the event of an accident.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which,
if not avoided, could result in vehicle
damage.
1-5
Foreword
Gasoline containing alcohol or
methanol
Using Fuel Additives (except
Detergent Fuel Additives)
Gasohol, a mixture of gasoline and
ethanol (also known as grain alcohol) are
being marketed along with or instead
of leaded or unleaded gasoline. For
example, “E15” is a gasohol comprised of
15% ethanol and 85% gasoline.
Do not use gasohol containing more than
15% ethanol, and do not use gasoline or
gasohol containing any methanol. Either
of these fuels may cause drivability
problems and damage to the fuel
system, engine control system and
emission control system.
Discontinue using gasohol of any kind if
drivability problems occur.
“E85” fuel is an alternative fuel
comprised of 85 percent ethanol and 15
percent gasoline, and is manufactured
exclusively for use in Flexible Fuel
Vehicles. “E85” is not compatible with
your vehicle. Use of “E85” may result in
poor engine performance and damage
to your vehicle’s engine and fuel system.
HYUNDAI recommends that customers
do not use fuel with an ethanol content
exceeding 15 percent.
Using fuel additives such as:
- Silicone fuel additive
- Ferrocene (iron-based) fuel additive
- Other metallic-based fuel additives
may result in cylinder misfire, poor
acceleration, engine stalling, damage
to the catalyst, or abnormal corrosion,
and may cause damage to the engine
resulting in a reduction in the overall life
of the powertrain.
- The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)
may illuminate.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle’s
engine and fuel system:
ś Never use gasohol which contains
methanol.
ś Never use gasohol containing more
than 15% ethanol.
ś Never use leaded fuel or leaded
gasohol.
ś Never use “E85” fuel.
Your New Vehicle Limited Warranty
does not cover damage to the fuel
system or any performance problems
caused by the use of “E85” fuel.
1-6
NOTICE
Damage to the fuel system or
performance problem caused by the
use of these fuels or fuel additives may
not be covered by your New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
Gasoline containing MMT
Some gasoline contains harmful
manganese-based fuel additives such
as MMT (Methylcyclopentadienyl
Manganese Tricarbonyl).
HYUNDAI does not recommend the use
of gasoline containing MMT.
This type of fuel can reduce vehicle
performance and affect your emission
control system.
The malfunction indicator lamp on the
cluster may come on.
01
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS
Detergent Fuel Additives
HYUNDAI recommends that you use
good quality gasolines treated with
detergent additives such as TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline, which help prevent
deposit formation in the engine. These
gasolines will help the engine run
cleaner and enhance performance of
the Emission Control System. For more
information on TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline, please go to the website (www.
toptiergas.com).
For customers who do not use TOP Tier
Detergent Gasoline regularly, and have
problems starting or the engine does
not run smoothly, detergent-based
fuel additives that you can purchase
separately may be added to the gasoline.
If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is
not available, one bottle of additive
added to the fuel tank according to the
maintenance schedule is recommended
(refer to the Maintenance Schedule in
chapter 8).
Additives are available from your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with
information on how to use them. Do not
mix other additives.
Operation in foreign countries
If you are going to drive your vehicle in
another country, be sure to:
ś Observe all regulations regarding
registration and insurance.
ś Determine that acceptable fuel is
available.
ś This vehicle should not be modified.
Modification of your vehicle could
affect its performance, safety or
durability and may even violate
governmental safety and emissions
regulations.
In addition, damage or performance
problems resulting from any
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
ś If you use unauthorized electronic
devices, it may cause the vehicle to
operate abnormally, wire damage,
battery discharge and fire. For your
safety, do not use unauthorized
electronic devices.
9(+,&/(%5($.ǘ,1
PROCESS
By following a few simple precautions for
the first 600 miles (1,000 km) you may
add to the performance, economy and
life of your vehicle.
ś Do not race the engine.
ś While driving, keep your engine speed
(rpm, or revolutions per minute)
between 2,000 rpm and 4,000 rpm.
ś Do not maintain a single speed for
long periods of time, either fast or
slow. Varying engine speed is needed
to properly break-in the engine.
ś Avoid hard stops, except in
emergencies, to allow the brakes to
seat properly.
1-7
Foreword
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Items contained in motor vehicles or
emitted from them are known to the
State of California to cause cancer and
birth defects or reproductive harm.
These include:
ś Gasoline and its vapors
ś Engine exhaust
ś Used engine oil
ś Interior passenger compartment
components and materials
ś Component parts which are subject
to heat and wear
In addition, battery posts, terminals and
related accessories contain lead, lead
compounds and other chemicals known
to the State of California to cause
cancer and reproductive harm.
For more information go to
https://www.p65warnings.ca.gov/
passenger-vehicle
1-8
VEHICLE DATA COLLECTION
AND EVENT DATA
RECORDERS
This vehicle is equipped with an event
data recorder (EDR). The main purpose
of an EDR is to record, in certain crash
or near crash-like situations, such as
an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in
understanding how a vehicle’s systems
performed. The EDR is designed to
record data related to vehicle dynamics
and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The
EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
such data as:
ś How various systems in your vehicle
were operating;
ś Whether or not the driver and
passenger safety belts were buckled/
fastened;
ś How far (if at all) the driver was
depressing the accelerator and/or
brake pedal; and,
ś How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better
understanding of the circumstances in
which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE:
EDR data are recorded by your vehicle
only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the
EDR under normal driving conditions
and no personal data (e.g., name,
gender, age, and crash location) are
recorded. However, other parties, such
as law enforcement, could combine the
EDR data with the type of personally
identifying data routinely acquired
during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR,
special equipment is required, and
access to the vehicle or the EDR is
needed. In addition to the vehicle
manufacturer, other parties, such as
law enforcement, that have the special
equipment, can read the information if
they have access to the vehicle or the
EDR.
2. Vehicle Information
Exterior Overview ..............................................................................................2-2
Interior Overview .............................................................................................. 2-4
Instrument Panel Overview .............................................................................. 2-5
Engine Compartment ....................................................................................... 2-6
Dimensions.........................................................................................................2-7
Engine .................................................................................................................2-7
Bulb Wattage..................................................................................................... 2-8
Tires and Wheels ............................................................................................... 2-9
Volume and Weight .........................................................................................2-10
Air Conditioning System ..................................................................................2-10
Recommended Lubricants and Capacities .....................................................2-11
Recommended SAE Viscosity Number .....................................................................2-12
Vehicle Identification Number (vin) ................................................................ 2-13
Vehicle Certification Label .............................................................................. 2-13
Tire Specification and Pressure Label ............................................................ 2-14
Engine Number ................................................................................................ 2-14
2
Vehicle Information
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW
Front view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OQX019001L
1. Hood ....................................................... 5-31
5. Side view mirror.................................... 5-20
2. Headlamp/Daytime running lamp ......8-50
6. Front windshield wiper blades ............ 8-23
3. Turn signal lamp ....................................8-51
7. Windows ................................................5-22
4. Tires and wheels ....................................8-27
2-2
02
Rear view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OQX019002N
1. Antenna ..................................................5-76
6. Rear window wiper blade .................... 8-24
2. Doors ...................................................... 5-12
7. Liftgate ...................................................5-32
3. Fuel filler door ....................................... 5-34
8. Rear lamps ............................................ 8-55
4. High mounted stop lamp ..................... 8-57
9. Back-up lamp........................................8-56
5. Rear view camera ................................. 5-47
2-3
Vehicle Information
INTERIOR OVERVIEW
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
1. Door lock/unlock button....................... 5-13
2. Outside rearview mirror control
switch ..................................................... 5-21
OQX019003N
7. Lane Keeping Assist system
On/Off Button ........................................ 6-71
8. ESC OFF button .................................... 6-24
3. Central door lock switch ....................... 5-14
9. Hood release lever................................. 5-31
4. Power window switches .......................5-22
10. Steering wheel tilt/telescopic lever .....5-18
5. Power window lock switch ...................5-25
11. Steering wheel ....................................... 5-17
6. Instrument panel illumination control
switch ...................................................... 4-5
12. Seat.......................................................... 3-3
13. Instrument panel fuse ..........................8-40
14. Fuel filler door ....................................... 5-34
2-4
02
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OQX010011N
1. Instrument cluster .................................. 4-4
9. Manual transmission shift lever............ 6-12
2. Horn ........................................................ 5-19
Intelligent variable transmission
shift lever................................................ 6-15
3. Key ignition switch ................................. 6-6
Engine Start/Stop button ....................... 6-9
10. Seat warmer ........................................... 3-12
4. Infotainment system .............................5-76
11. Drive mode selection knob .................. 6-28
5. Hazard warning flasher switch ...............7-2
12. Power outlet.......................................... 5-70
6. Manual climate control system ........... 5-48
13. USB charger ........................................... 5-71
Automatic climate control system ...... 5-56
14. Driver’s front air bag............................. 3-33
7. Passenger’s front air bag ..................... 3-33
15. Light control.......................................... 5-36
8. Glove box .............................................. 5-69
Turn signals ............................................5-41
16. Wiper/Washer ....................................... 5-45
2-5
Vehicle Information
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
The actual engine room in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OQX089001L
1. Engine coolant reservoir .......................8-16
6. Windshield washer fluid reservoir ....... 8-20
2. Brake/clutch fluid reservoir ..................8-19
7. Engine room junction block..................8-41
3. Engine air filter ...................................... 8-21
8. Battery ................................................... 8-25
4. Engine oil dipstick .................................8-15
9. Radiator cap........................................... 8-17
5. Engine oil filler cap ................................8-15
2-6
02
DIMENSIONS
Item
in (mm)
Overall length
159.0 (4,040)
Overall width
69.7 (1,770)
Overall height
Front tread
Rear tread
With roof rack
62.7 (1,592)
Without roof rack
61.6 (1,565)
185/65R15 (6.0J)
61.2 (1,555)
205/55R17 (6.5J)
60.4 (1,535)
185/65R15 (6.0J)
61.6 (1,565)
205/55R17 (6.5J)
Wheelbase
60.9 (1,546)
99.2 (2,520)
ENGINE
Item
Displacement
Bore x Stroke
Firing order
No. of cylinders
Smartstream G1.6
cu.in (cc)
in (mm)
97.5 (1,598)
2.98 x 3.5 (75.6 x 89.0)
1-3-4-2
4, in-line
2-7
Vehicle Information
BULB WATTAGE
Light bulb
Type A
Type B
Front
Type C
Bulb type
Wattage
Headlamp (High/Low)
HB3
65
Parking lamp
W5W
5
Headlamp
HB3
65
Daytime running lamp
(DRL)/parking lamp
LED
LED
Cornering lamp
H7
55
Headlamp (High/low)
LED
LED
Daytime running lamp
(DRL)/parking lamp
LED
LED
Cornering lamp
Turn signal lamp
W5W
WY5W
5
Side repeater lamp (Outside mirror)
LED
LED
Stop/tail lamp
P21/5W
21/5
Turn signal lamp
27W
7
Type B
Side marker
-
-
Stop/tail lamp
LED
LED
Tail lamp
LED
LED
Side marker
LED
LED
Turn signal lamp
PY21W
21
License plate lamp
W5W
5
Back up lamp
W16W
16
Map lamp
2-8
5
Side marker
High mounted stop lamp
Interior
55
28/8
Side repeater lamp
Type A
Rear
H7
2357NA
W16W
16
Type A
W10W
10
Type B
FESTOON
8
Room lamp
FESTOON
8
Vanity mirror lamp
FESTOON
5
Luggage compartment lamp
FESTOON
8
02
TIRES AND WHEELS
Inflation pressure kPa (psi)
Item
Full size tire
Tire Size
Front
Maximum load
Rear
Front
Rear
185/65 R15 6.0Jx15 250 (36)
250 (36)
250 (36)
250 (36)
205/55 R17
230 (33)
230 (33)
230 (33)
Compact T125/80 D15
spare tire
(if equipped) T125/80 D16
*1 :
Wheel
Size
Normal load *1
6.5Jx17 230 (33)
4Tx15
420 (60) 420 (60) 420 (60) 420 (60)
4Tx16
420 (60) 420 (60) 420 (60) 420 (60)
Wheel lug
nut torque
kgf·m
(lbf·ft,
N·m)
11~13
(79~94,
107~127)
Normal load: Up to 3 persons
NOTICE
ś It is permissible to add 3 psi to the standard tire pressure specification if colder
temperatures are expected soon.
Tires typically loose 1psi (7kPa) for every 12°F temperature drop. If extreme
temperature variations are expected, recheck your tire pressure as necessary to
keep them properly inflated.
ś An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above
sea level. Thus, if you plan to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures
in advance. If necessary, inflate them to a proper level. (Air inflation per altitude:
+2.4 psi/1 mile)
CAUTION
ś When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle.
Using tires of a different size can damage the related parts or not work properly.
ś When replacing tires, ALWAYS use the same size, type, construction and tread
pattern supplied with the vehicle for all tires.
2-9
Vehicle Information
VOLUME AND WEIGHT
Smartstream G1.6
Items
Gross vehicle weight
lbs. (kg)
Luggage volume (SAE)
cu ft (Ţ)
IVT
M/T
3,770 (1,710)
3,638 (1,650)
Behind 1st row : 18.66 (528)
Behind 2st row : 31.86 (902)
M/T: Manual transmission
IVT: Intelligent variable transmission
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Item
Refrigerant
Compressor lubricant
oz. (g)
oz. (g)
Weight of Volume
Classification
17.6±0.88 (500±25)
R-134a
4.23±0.35 (120±10)
PAG
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.
2-10
02
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance and durability, use only
lubricants of the proper quality. The correct lubricants also help promote engine
efficiency that results in improved fuel economy.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant
Volume
Classification
Engine oil
(drain and refill)
*1 *2
Smartstream
G1.6
4.02 US qt. (3.8 Ţ) API SN PLUS/SP or ILSAC GF-6
HK SYN MTF 70W (SK)
SPIRAX S6 GHME 70W MTF
(H.K.SHELL)
GS MTF HD 70W (GS CALTEX)
API GL-4, SAE 70W, TGO-9
Manual transmission fluid
1.59 ~ 1.69 US qt.
(1.5 ~ 1.6 Ţ)
Intelligent variable transmission
fluid
6.34 US qt. (6.7 Ţ) CVTF (SP-CVT1) *3
Coolant
M/T
IVT
5.94 US qt. (5.62 Ţ) Mixture of antifreeze and water
(Phosphate-based Ethylene glycol
6.32 US qt. (5.78 Ţ) coolant for aluminum radiator)
Brake/clutch fluid
0.74 ~ 0.85 US qt. SAE J1704 DOT-4 LV, FMVSS 116
(0.7 ~ 0.8 Ţ)
DOT-4, ISO4925 CLASS-6
Fuel
11.89 US gal. (45 Ţ)
Refer to “Fuel requirements” in
chapter 1.
M/T: Manual transmission
IVT: Intelligent variable transmission
*1 : Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on page 12.
*2 : Requires
grade engine oil.
If a lower grade engine oil (mineral oil including Semi-synthetic) is used, then the engine
oil and engine oil filter must be replaced as indicated severe maintenance condition.
*3 : Use only specified genuine Intelligent variable transmission fluid. The use of nonspecified fluid (even marked as compatible with genuine) could result in shift quality
deterioration and vibrations, eventually, the transmission failure.
2-11
Vehicle Information
Recommended SAE Viscosity
Number
Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an
effect on fuel economy and cold weather
operating (engine start and engine oil
flowability). Lower viscosity engine oils
can provide better fuel economy and
cold weather performance, however,
higher viscosity engine oils are required
for satisfactory lubrication in hot
weather.
Using oils of any viscosity other than
those recommended could result in
engine damage.
When choosing an oil, consider the
range of temperature your vehicle will be
operated in before the next oil change.
Proceed to select the recommended oil
viscosity from the chart.
CAUTION
Always be sure to clean the area around
any filler plug, drain plug, or dipstick
before checking or draining any
lubricant. This is especially important
in dusty or sandy areas and when the
vehicle is used on unpaved roads.
Cleaning the plug and dipstick areas
will prevent dirt and grit from entering
the engine and other mechanisms that
could be damaged.
Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers
Temperature
Engine Oil
*1 :
°C
(°F)
-30
-20
-10
-10
0
20
0
10
40
20
60
30
80
40
50
100 120
0W-20*ǎ
Requires grade engine oil.
If a lower grade engine oil (mineral oil including Semi-synthetic) is used, then the engine
oil and engine oil filter must be replaced as indicated severe maintenance condition.
An engine oil displaying this API Certification Mark conforms to
the international Lubricant Specification Advisory Committee
(ILSAC). It is recommended to only use engine oils that uphold
this API Certification Mark.
2-12
02
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
180%(5ǣ9,1Ǥ
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION
LABEL
Frame number
OIB084003
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is
the number used in registering your car
and in all legal matters pertaining to its
ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the passenger seat. To check the
number, open the cover.
OIB074059
The vehicle certification label attached
on the driver’s side center pillar gives the
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
VIN label
OIB074054
The VIN is also on a plate attached to the
top of the dashboard. The number on
the plate can easily be seen through the
windshield from outside.
2-13
Vehicle Information
TIRE SPECIFICATION AND
PRESSURE LABEL
ENGINE NUMBER
OQX089040L
OQX089049N
The tires supplied on your new
vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar gives the tire pressures
recommended for your car.
2-14
The engine number is stamped on the
engine block as shown in the drawing.
3. Safety System
This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect yourself and your
passengers. It explains how to properly use your seats and seat belts, and how your air bags work.
Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.
Important Safety Precautions ...........................................................................3-2
Always Wear Your Seat Belt ......................................................................................... 3-2
Restrain All Children ..................................................................................................... 3-2
Air Bag Hazards ............................................................................................................ 3-2
Driver Distraction ......................................................................................................... 3-2
Control Your Speed ...................................................................................................... 3-2
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition ........................................................................... 3-2
Seats .................................................................................................................. 3-3
Safety Precautions .......................................................................................................3-4
Front Seats ....................................................................................................................3-5
Rear Seats ..................................................................................................................... 3-7
Head Restraints ............................................................................................................3-9
Seat Warmers ..............................................................................................................3-12
Seat Belts ..........................................................................................................3-14
Seat Belt Safety Precautions ..................................................................................... 3-14
Seat Belt Warning Light ..............................................................................................3-15
Seat Belt Restraint System ........................................................................................ 3-16
Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions ...................................................................3-20
Care of Seat Belts ....................................................................................................... 3-22
Child Restraint System (CRS) ......................................................................... 3-23
Children Always in the Rear ....................................................................................... 3-23
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) .................................................................3-24
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS) ................................................................. 3-25
Air Bag - Advanced Supplemental Restraint System .................................... 3-31
Where Are the Air Bags? ............................................................................................3-33
How Does the Air Bag System Operate?...................................................................3-36
What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates ..................................................................3-39
Occupant Classification System (OCS) .................................................................... 3-40
Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? .......................................................... 3-46
SRS Care .................................................................................................................... 3-50
Additional Safety Precautions ................................................................................... 3-51
Air Bag Warning Labels .............................................................................................. 3-51
3
Safety System
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout this
section, and throughout this manual.
The safety precautions in this section are
among the most important.
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all
types of accidents. Air bags are designed
to supplement seat belts, not replace
them. So even though your vehicle is
equipped with air bags, ALWAYS make
sure you and your passengers wear your
seat belts, and wear them properly.
Restrain All Children
All children under age 13 should ride
in your vehicle properly restrained in a
rear seat, not the front seat. Infants and
small children should be restrained in
an appropriate child restraint. Larger
children should use a booster seat with
the lap/shoulder belt until they can use
the seat belt properly without a booster
seat.
Air Bag Hazards
While air bags can save lives, they can
also cause serious or fatal injuries to
occupants who sit too close to them, or
who are not properly restrained. Infants,
young children, and shorter adults are at
the greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating air bag. Follow all instructions
and warnings in this manual.
Driver Distraction
Driver distraction presents a serious and
potentially deadly danger, especially for
inexperienced drivers. Safety should be
the first concern when behind the wheel
and drivers need to be aware of the wide
array of potential distractions, such as
drowsiness, reaching for objects, eating,
personal grooming, other passengers,
and using cellular phones.
3-2
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel to
focus on activities other than driving. To
reduce your risk of distraction or getting
into an accident:
ś ALWAYS set up your mobile devices
(i.e., MP3 players, phones, navigation
units, etc.) when your vehicle is
parked or safely stopped.
ś ONLY use your mobile device when
allowed by laws and when conditions
permit safe use. NEVER text or email
while driving. Most states have laws
prohibiting drivers from texting. Some
states and cities also prohibit drivers
from using handheld phones.
ś NEVER let the use of a mobile device
distract you from driving. You have a
responsibility to your passengers and
others on the road to always drive
safely, with your hands on the wheel
as well as your eyes and attention on
the road.
Control Your Speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash
injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but
serious injuries can also occur at lower
speeds. Never drive faster than is safe
for current conditions, regardless of the
maximum speed posted.
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe
Condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical
failure can be extremely hazardous. To
reduce the possibility of such problems,
check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly
scheduled maintenance.
03
SEATS
OQX039001N
Front seats
(1) Forward and backward
(2) Seatback angle
(3) Seat cushion height
(4) Head restraint
(5) Seat warmer
Rear seats
(6) Head restraint
(7) Seatback folding
3-3
Safety System
Safety Precautions
Adjusting the seats so that you are sitting
in a safe, comfortable position plays an
important role in driver and passenger
safety together with the seat belts and
air bags in an accident.
WARNING
Do not use a cushion that reduces
friction between the seat and the
passenger. The passenger’s hips may
slide under the lap portion of the seat
belt during an accident or a sudden
stop. Serious or fatal internal injuries
could result because the seat belt
cannot operate properly.
Air Bags
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air bag.
Sitting too close to an air bag greatly
increases the risk of injury in the event
the air bag inflates.
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) recommends
that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25
cm) between the center of the steering
wheel and their chest.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating air bag, take the
following precautions:
ś Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the
rear as possible while maintaining
the ability to maintain full control of
the vehicle.
ś Adjust the front passenger seat as far
to the rear as possible.
ś Hold the steering wheel by the rim
with hands at the 9 o’clock and 3
o’clock positions to minimize the risk
of injuries to your hands and arms.
3-4
ś NEVER place anything or anyone
between the steering wheel and the
air bag.
ś Do not allow the front passenger to
place feet or legs on the dashboard
to minimize the risk of leg injuries.
Seat Belts
Always fasten your seat belt before
starting any trip.
At all times, passengers should sit
upright and be properly restrained.
Infants and small children must be
restrained in appropriate child restraint
systems. Adults and children who
have outgrown a booster seat must be
restrained using the seat belts.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat belt:
ś NEVER use one seat belt for more
than one occupant.
ś Always position the seatback upright
with the lap portion of the seat belt
snug and low across the hips.
ś NEVER allow children or small infants
to ride on a passenger’s lap.
ś Do not route the seat belt across your
neck, across sharp edges, or reroute
the shoulder strap away from your
body.
ś Do not allow the seat belt to become
caught or jammed.
03
Front Seats
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
adjusting your seat:
ś NEVER attempt to adjust the seat
while the vehicle is moving. The seat
could respond with unexpected
movement and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Do not place anything under the
front seats. Loose objects in the
driver’s foot area could interfere
with the operation of the foot pedals,
causing an accident.
ś Do not allow anything to interfere
with the normal position and proper
locking of the seatback.
ś Do not place a cigarette lighter on
the floor or seat. When you operate
the seat, gas may exit out of the
lighter causing a fire.
ś Use extreme caution when picking
up small objects trapped under the
seats or between the seat and the
center console. Your hands might be
cut or injured by the sharp edges of
the seat mechanism.
ś If there are occupants in the rear
seats, be careful while adjusting the
front seat position.
ś Make sure that the seat is locked in
place after the adjustment. If not,
the seat might move unexpectedly
resulting in an accident.
Manual Adjustment
The front seat can be adjusted by using
the levers located on the outside of
the seat cushion. Before driving, adjust
the seat to the proper position so that
you can easily control the steering
wheel, foot pedals and controls on the
instrument panel.
OQX039002L
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Pull up the seat slide adjustment lever
and hold it.
2. Slide the seat to the position you
desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seat is locked in place. Move forward
and rearward without using the lever.
If the seat moves, it is not locked
properly.
CAUTION
To prevent injury:
ś Do not adjust your seat while
wearing your seat belt. Moving the
seat cushion forward may cause
strong pressure on your abdomen.
ś Do not allow your hands or fingers to
get caught in the seat mechanisms
while the seat is moving.
3-5
Safety System
OQX039003L
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Lean forward slightly and lift up the
seatback lever.
2. Carefully lean back on the seat and
adjust the seatback to the position
you desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure the
seatback is locked in place. (The lever
MUST return to its original position for
the seatback to lock.)
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protection of
your restraint system (seat belts and air
bags) is greatly reduced by reclining your
seatback.
WARNING
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal
injuries in the event of a collision or
sudden stop.
Drivers and passengers should ALWAYS
sit well back in their seats, properly
belted, and with the seatbacks upright.
3-6
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly. When
the seatback is reclined, the shoulder
belt cannot do its job because it will not
be snug against your chest. Instead,
it will be in front of you. During an
accident, you could be thrown into the
seat belt, causing neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or the
passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder
belt.
OQX039004L
Seat cushion height (for driver’s seat)
To change the height of the seat cushion:
ś Push down on the lever several times,
to lower the seat cushion.
ś Pull up on the lever several times, to
raise the seat cushion.
03
Seatback Pocket (if equipped)
Rear Seats
Folding the Rear Seat
The rear seatbacks can be folded to
facilitate carrying long items or to
increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
WARNING
OQX039041L
The seatback pocket is provided on the
back of the front seatbacks.
WARNING
To prevent the Occupant Classification
System from malfunctioning:
Do not hang onto the front passenger’s
seatback.
CAUTION
Do not put heavy or sharp objects in the
seatback pockets. In an accident they
could come loose from the pocket and
injure occupants.
ś Never allow passengers to sit on top
of the folded down seatback while
the vehicle is moving. This is not a
proper seating position and no seat
belts are available for use. This could
result in serious injury or death in
case of an accident or sudden stop.
ś Objects carried on the folded down
seatback should not extend higher
than the top of the front seatbacks.
This could allow cargo to slide
forward and cause injury or damage
during sudden stops.
To fold down the rear seatback:
1. Set the front seatback to the upright
position and if necessary, slide the
front seat forward.
OQX039012N
2. Lower the rear head restraints to
the lowest position by pushing and
holding the release button and
pushing down on the head restraint.
3-7
Safety System
OQX039013N
3. Locate the seatbelt toward the
outboard position before folding
down the seatback. If not, the seatbelt
system may be interfered by the
seatback.
OQX039006N
5. To use the rear seat, lift and unfold
the seatback to the upright position.
Push the seatback firmly until it clicks
into place. Make sure the seatback is
locked in place.
Return the seatbelt back into the
guide (1).
WARNING
OQX039005N
When returning the rear seatback from
a folded to an upright position, hold the
seatback and return it slowly. Ensure
that the seatback is completely locked
into its upright position by pushing on
the top of the seatback. In an accident
or sudden stop, an unlocked seatback
could allow cargo to move forward with
great force and enter the passenger
compartment, which could result in
serious injury or death.
WARNING
Do not place objects in the rear seats,
since they cannot be properly secured
and may hit vehicle occupants in a
collision causing serious injury or death.
OQX039007N
4. Pull out the seatbelt from guide (1)
and pull up the seatback folding lever
(2), then fold the seat toward the front
of the vehicle.
3-8
03
WARNING
Make sure the vehicle is off, the shift
lever is in P (Park), and the parking
brake is securely applied whenever
loading or unloading cargo. Failure to
take these steps may allow the vehicle
to move if the shift lever is inadvertently
moved to another position.
NOTICE
ś Be careful when loading cargo
through the rear passenger seats
to prevent damage to the vehicle
interior.
ś When cargo is loaded through the
rear passenger seats, ensure the
cargo is properly secured to prevent
it from moving while driving.
ś Unsecured cargo in the passenger
compartment can cause damage
to the vehicle or injury to the
occupants.
Head Restraints
The vehicle’s front and rear seats
have adjustable head restraints. The
head restraints provide comfort for
passengers, but more importantly they
are designed to help protect passengers
from whiplash and other neck and spinal
injuries during an accident, especially in
a rear impact collision.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death in an accident, take the following
precautions when adjusting your head
restraints:
ś Always properly adjust the head
restraints for all passengers BEFORE
starting the vehicle.
ś NEVER let anyone ride in a seat
with the head restraints removed or
reversed.
OLF034072N
Adjust the head restraints so the
middle of the head restraint is at the
same height as the height of the top
of the eyes.
ś NEVER adjust the head restraint
position of the driver’s seat when the
vehicle is in motion.
ś Adjust the head restraint as close to
the passenger’s head as possible. Do
not use a seat cushion that holds the
body away from the seatback.
ś Make sure the head restraint locks
into position after adjusting it.
NOTICE
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull
on the head restraints.
CAUTION
When there are no occupants in the
rear seats, adjust the height of the head
restraint to the lowest position. The
rear seat head restraint can reduce the
visibility of the rear area.
3-9
Safety System
Front Seat head Restraints
OLF034015
OQX039008L
Both the driver’s and passenger’s front
seat are equipped with adjustable head
restraints for the safety and comfort.
NOTICE
If you recline the seatback towards the
front with the head restraint and seat
cushion raised, the head restraint may
come in contact with the sunvisor or
other parts of the vehicle.
OQX039009L
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
3-10
OQX039010L
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the head restraint:
1. Recline the seatback (2) rearward
using the seatback angle lever (1).
2. Raise the head restraint as far as it can
go.
3. Press the head restraint release button
(3) while pulling the head restraint up
(4).
03
CAUTION
ś For each rear passenger, adjust the
head restraint so that the middle
of the head restraint is at the same
height as the height of the top of the
eyes.
OQX039011L
To reinstall the head restraint:
1. Put the head restraint poles (2) into
the holes while pressing the release
button (1).
2. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
3. Adjust the seatback (4) forward using
the seatback angle lever (3).
ś When seating on the rear seat, do
not adjust the height of the head
restraints to the lowest position.
Rear Seat head Restraints
OQX039015N
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
OQX039032L
The rear seats are equipped with head
restraints in all the seating positions for
the passenger’s safety and comfort.
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button (2)
on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
3-11
Safety System
Seat Warmers (if equipped)
Seat warmers are provided to warm the
seats during cold weather.
WARNING
OQX039015N
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the head restraint:
1. Raise the head restraint as far as it can
go.
2. Press the head restraint release button
(2) while pulling the head restraint up
(1).
To reinstall the head restraint:
1. Put the head restraint poles into the
holes (3) while pressing the release
button (2).
2. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
The seat warmers can cause a SERIOUS
BURN, even at low temperatures and
especially if used for long periods of
time.
Passengers must be able to feel if the
seat is becoming too warm so they can
turn it off, if needed.
People who cannot detect temperature
change or pain to the skin should
use extreme caution, especially the
following types of passengers:
ś Infants, children, elderly or disabled
persons, or hospital outpatients.
ś People with sensitive skin or who
burn easily.
ś Fatigued individuals.
ś Intoxicated individuals.
ś People taking medication that can
cause drowsiness or sleepiness.
WARNING
NEVER place anything on the seat
that insulates against heat when the
seat warmer is in operation, such as a
blanket or seat cushion. This may cause
the seat warmer to overheat, causing a
burn or damage to the seat.
3-12
03
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seat warmers
and seats:
ś Never use a solvent such as paint
thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline
to clean the seats.
ś Do not place heavy or sharp objects
on seats equipped with seat
warmers.
ś Do not change the seat cover. It may
damage the seat warmer.
ś Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows:
OFF
LOW (
)
HIGH (
)
MIDDLE (
)
ś When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the seat warmer
operating, the seat warmer will turn
OFF.
ś The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position each time the ignition switch
is turned to the ON position.
Information
With the seat warmer switch in the ON
position, the heating system in the seat
turns off or on automatically depending on
the seat temperature.
OQX030016N
While the engine is running, push either
of the switches to warm the driver’s seat
or front passenger’s seat.
During mild weather or under conditions
where the operation of the seat warmer
is not needed, keep the switches in the
OFF position.
3-13
Safety System
SEAT BELTS
This section describes how to use the
seat belts properly. It also describes
some of the things to avoid when using
seat belts.
Seat Belt Safety Precautions
Always fasten your seat belt and make
sure all passengers have fastened their
seat belts before starting any trip. Air
bags are designed to supplement the
seat belt as an additional safety device,
but they are not a substitute. Most states
require all occupants of a vehicle to wear
seat belts.
WARNING
Seat belts must be used by ALL
passengers whenever the vehicle is
moving. Take the following precautions
when adjusting and wearing seat belts:
ś ALWAYS properly restrain children
under age 13 in the rear seats.
ś NEVER allow children to ride in the
front passenger seat. If a child age 13
or older must be seated in the front
seat, move the seat as far back as
possible and properly restrain them
in the seat.
ś NEVER allow an infant or child to be
carried on an occupant’s lap.
ś NEVER ride with the seatback
reclined when the vehicle is moving.
ś Do not allow children to share a seat
or seat belt.
ś Do not wear the shoulder belt under
your arm or behind your back.
ś Always wear both the shoulder
portion and lap portion of the lap/
shoulder belt.
ś Do not use the seat belt if it is
twisted. A twisted seat belt will not
protect you properly in an accident.
ś Do not use a seat belt if the webbing
or hardware is damaged.
3-14
ś Do not latch the seat belt into the
buckles of other seats.
ś NEVER unfasten the seat belt
while driving. This may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Make sure there is nothing in the
buckle interfering with the seat belt
latch mechanism. This may prevent
the seat belt from fastening securely.
ś No modifications or additions
should be made by the user which
will either prevent the seat belt
adjusting devices from operating to
remove slack, or prevent the seat
belt assembly from being adjusted to
remove slack.
WARNING
Damaged seat belts and seat belt
assemblies will not operate properly.
Always replace:
ś Frayed, contaminated, or damaged
webbing
ś Damaged hardware
ś The entire seat belt assembly after it
has been worn in an accident, even
if damage to webbing or assembly is
not apparent
03
Seat Belt Warning Light
Seat Belt Warning Light
(for Front Passenger’s Seat)
Seat Belt Warning Light
(for Driver’s Seat)
OQX039033L
As a reminder to the driver, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds each time
you place the ignition switch to the ON
position regardless of belt fastening.
However, if the seat belt is unfasted,
a warning chime will sound for
approximately 6 seconds.
If you continue not to fasten the seat belt
and you drive under 12 mph (20 km/h),
the warning light will stay illuminated.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h)
the seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
If you unfasten the seat belt while driving
under 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt
warning light will illuminate until the seat
belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger’s seat belt warning
lights will illuminate for approximately 6
seconds each time you place the ignition
switch to the ON position regardless of
belt fastening.
If you continue not to fasten the seat belt
and you drive under 12 mph (20 km/h),
the warning light will stay illuminated.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h)
the seat belt warning chime will sound
for approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
If you unfasten the seat belt while driving
under 12 mph (20 km/h) the seat belt
warning light will illuminate until the seat
belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
WARNING
The front passenger’s seat belt warning
light may not properly operate if the
front passenger does not sit properly in
the seat.
If you place an object on the passenger
seat or back seat or under the seats,
the warning chime may sound. Please
remove the object if the chime sounds.
3-15
Safety System
Seat Belt Restraint System
Seat Belt-Driver’s 3-point System
with Emergency Locking Retractor
WARNING
Improperly positioned seat belts may
increase the risk of serious injury
in an accident. Take the following
precautions when adjusting the seat
belt:
ś Position the lap portion of the seat
belt as low as possible across your
hips, not on your waist, so that it fits
snugly.
ś Position one arm under the shoulder
belt and the other over the belt, as
shown in the illustration.
ś Always position the shoulder belt
anchor into the locked position at the
appropriate height.
ś Never position the shoulder belt
across your neck or face.
OHI038140
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor and
insert the metal tab (1) into the buckle
(2). There will be an audible “click” when
the tab locks into the buckle.
OHI038137
You should place the lap belt (1) portion
across your hips and the shoulder belt (2)
portion across your chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to the
proper length after the lap belt portion
is adjusted manually so that it fits snugly
around your hips. If you lean forward in
a slow, easy motion, the belt will extend
and move with you.
If there is a sudden stop or impact, the
belt will lock into position. It will also lock
if you try to lean forward too quickly.
3-16
03
NOTICE
If you are not able to smoothly pull
enough of the seat belt out from the
retractor, firmly pull the seat belt out
and release it. After release, you will be
able to pull the belt out smoothly.
OHI038142
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the locking
buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen, check
the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then
try again.
Rear Seat Belt – Passenger’s 3-point
System with Convertible Locking
Retractor
This type of seat belt combines the
features of both an emergency locking
retractor seat belt and an automatic
locking retractor seat belt. Convertible
retractor type seat belts are installed
in the rear seat positions to help
accommodate the installation of child
restraint systems. Although a convertible
retractor is also installed in the front
passenger seat position, NEVER place
any infant/child restraint system in the
front seat of the vehicle.
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor
and insert the metal tab into the buckle.
There will be an audible “click” when
the tab locks into the buckle. When
not securing a child restraint, the seat
belt operates in the same way as the
driver’s seat belt (Emergency Locking
Retractor Type). It automatically adjusts
to the proper length only after the lap
belt portion of the seat belt is adjusted
manually so that it fits snugly across your
hips.
When the seat belt is fully extended from
the retractor to allow the installation of
a child restraint system, the seat belt
operation changes to allow the belt to
retract, but not to extend (Automatic
Locking Retractor Type). Refer to the
“Using a Child Restraint System” section
in this chapter.
NOTICE
Although the seat belt retractor
provides the same level of protection
for seated passengers in either
emergency or automatic locking
modes, the emergency locking mode
allows seated passengers to move
freely in their seat while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a
collision or sudden stop, the retractor
automatically locks the belt to help
restrain your body.
To deactivate the automatic locking
mode, unbuckle the seat belt and allow
the belt to fully retract.
3-17
Safety System
Pre-tensioner Seat Belt
(Driver And Front Passenger)
OHI038142
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the locking
buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen, check
the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then
try again.
Rear Center Seat Belt
OQX039051N
When using the rear center seat belt, the
buckle with the “CENTER” mark must be
used.
WARNING
Make sure that the seatback is locked in
place when using the rear center seat
belt.
If not, the seatback may move when
there is a sudden stop or collision,
which could result in serious injury.
3-18
OHI038143L
Your vehicle is equipped with driver’s
and front passenger’s Pre-tensioner
Seat Belts (Retractor Pre-tensioner). The
purpose of the pre-tensioner is to make
sure the seat belts fit tightly against the
occupant’s body in certain frontal or side
collision(s).
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or
if the occupant tries to lean forward
too quickly, the seat belt retractor will
lock into position. In certain frontal or
side collision(s), the pre-tensioner will
activate and pull the seat belt into tighter
contact against the occupant’s body.
If the system senses excessive tension
on the driver or passenger’s seat belt
when the pre-tensioner system activates,
the load limiter inside the retractor
pre-tensioner will release some of the
pressure on the affected seat belt.
03
WARNING
ś Always wear your seat belt and sit
properly in your seat.
ś Do not use the seat belt if it is loose
or twisted. A loose or twisted seat
belt will not protect you properly in
an accident.
ś Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely affect
the buckle and cause it to function
improperly.
ś Always replace your pre-tensioners
after activation or an accident.
ś NEVER inspect, service, repair or
replace the pre-tensioners yourself.
This must be done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
WARNING
Do not touch the pre-tensioner seat
belt assemblies for several minutes
after they have been activated. When
the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the pretensioners become hot and can burn
you.
OLMB033040
The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System
consists mainly of the following
components. Their locations are shown
in the illustration above:
1. SRS air bag warning light
2. Retractor pre-tensioner
3. SRS control module
NOTICE
The sensor that activates the SRS air
bag is connected with the pre-tensioner
seat belts. The SRS air bag warning light
on the instrument panel will illuminate
for approximately 6 seconds after the
ignition switch is in the ON position,
and then it should turn off.
If the pre-tensioner is not working
properly, the warning light will
illuminate even if the SRS air bag is not
malfunctioning. If the warning light
does not illuminate, stays illuminated
or illuminates when the vehicle is being
driven, have an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer inspect the pre-tensioner seat
belts and SRS air bags as soon as
possible.
3-19
Safety System
NOTICE
ś Both the driver’s and front
passenger’s pre-tensioner seat belts
may be activated in certain frontal or
side collisions or rollovers.
ś When the pre-tensioner seat belts
are activated, a loud noise may be
heard and fine dust, which may
appear to be smoke, may be visible in
the passenger compartment. These
are normal operating conditions and
are not hazardous.
ś Although it is non-toxic, the fine
dust may cause skin irritation and
should not be inhaled for prolonged
periods. Wash all exposed skin areas
thoroughly after an accident in
which the pre-tensioner seat belts
were activated.
WARNING
ś Fasten your seat belt while sitting
properly in an upright position to
maximize the effectiveness of the
pre-tensioner seat belt system.
ś A pre-tensioner seat belt system
is designed to activate only once.
Replace the pre-tensioner seat belt
system, if it was activated in an
accident.
Additional Seat Belt Safety
Precautions
Seat Belt use during Pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat belt.
Pregnant women should always wear
a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed
between your breasts and away from
your neck. Place the lap belt line so
that it fits snugly and as low as possible
across the hips, not across the abdomen.
WARNING
ś A pregnant woman or a patient is
more vulnerable to any imapcts on
the abdomen during an abrupt stop
or accident. If you are in an accident
while pregnant, we recommend you
consult your doctor.
ś To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to an unborn child during an
accident, pregnant women should
NEVER place the lap portion of the
seat belt above or over the area of
the abdomen where the unborn child
is located.
Seat Belt use and Children
Infant and small children
All 50 states have child restraint laws
which require children to travel in
approved child restraint devices,
including booster seats. The age at
which seat belts can be used instead
of child restraints differs among states,
so you should be aware of the specific
requirements in your state, and where
you are travelling. Infant and child
restraints must be properly placed
and installed in a rear seat. For more
information refer to the “Child Restraint
Systems” section in this chapter.
3-20
03
WARNING
ALWAYS properly restrain infants
and small children in a child restraint
appropriate for the child’s height and
weight.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death to a child and other passengers,
NEVER hold a child in your lap or arms
when the vehicle is moving. The violent
forces created during an accident will
tear the child from your arms and throw
the child against the interior of the
vehicle.
Small children are best protected
from injury in an accident when
properly restrained in the rear seat
by a child restraint system that meets
the requirements of the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards. Before buying
any child restraint system, make sure
that it has a label certifying that it meets
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard
FMVSS 213. The restraint must be
appropriate for your child’s height and
weight. Check the label on the child
restraint for this information. Refer to the
“Child Restraint Systems” section in this
chapter.
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are too
large for a booster seat must always
occupy the rear seat and use the
available lap/shoulder belts. A seat belt
should lie across the upper thighs and
be snug across the shoulder and chest
to restrain the child safely. Check belt fit
periodically. Children are afforded the
most safety in the event of an accident
when they are restrained by a proper
restraint system and/or seat belts in the
rear seat. Always have the LATCH system
inspected by your authorized HYUNDAI
dealer after an accident. An accident can
damage the LATCH system and may not
properly secure the child restraint.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child must
be securely restrained by the available
lap/shoulder belt and the seat should be
placed in the rearmost position.
If the shoulder belt portion slightly
touches the child’s neck or face, try
placing the child closer to the center
of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still
touches their face or neck they need to
be returned to an appropriate booster
seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
ś Always make sure children are
wearing their seat belts and that they
are properly adjusted before driving.
ś NEVER allow the shoulder belt to
contact the child’s neck or face.
ś Do not allow more than one child to
use a single seat belt.
3-21
Safety System
Transporting an Injured Person
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific
recommendations.
One Person Per Belt
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
Do Not Lie Down
Sitting in a reclined position when the
vehicle is in motion can be dangerous.
Even when buckled up, the protections
of your restraint system (seat belts and
air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining
your seatback.
To reduce the chance of injuries in the
event of an accident and to achieve the
maximum effectiveness of the restraint
system, all passengers should be sitting
up and the front and rear seats should
be in an upright position when the car is
moving.
A seat belt cannot provide proper
protection if the person is lying down in
the rear seat or if the front or rear seats
are in a reclined position.
WARNING
ś NEVER ride with a reclined seatback
when the vehicle is moving.
ś Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
ś Drivers and passengers should
always sit well back in their seats,
properly belted, and with the
seatbacks upright.
3-22
Care of Seat Belts
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition,
care should be taken to assure that seat
belts and belt hardware are not damaged
by seat hinges, doors or other abuse.
Periodic Inspection
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of
any kind. Any damaged parts should
be replaced as soon as possible by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Keep Belts Clean and Dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution
and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong
detergents or abrasives should not be
used because they may damage and
weaken the fabric.
When to Replace Seat Belts
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident.
This should be done even if no damage is
visible. Additional questions concerning
seat belt operation should be directed to
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
&+,/'5(675$,176<67(0ǣ&56Ǥ
Children Always in the Rear
WARNING
Always properly restrain children in the
rear seats of the vehicle.
Children of all ages are safer when
restrained in the rear seat. A child riding
in the front passenger seat can be
forcefully struck by an inflating air bag
resulting in SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH.
Children under age 13 must always
ride in the rear seats and must always
be properly restrained to minimize the
risk of injury in an accident, sudden
stop or sudden maneuver. According
to accident statistics, children are safer
when properly restrained in the rear
seats than in the front seat. Even with
air bags, children can be seriously
injured or killed. Children too large for
a child restraint must use the seat belts
provided.
All 50 states have child restraint laws
which require children to travel in
approved child restraint devices. The
laws governing the age or height/weight
restrictions at which seat belts can be
used instead of child restraints differs
among states, so you should be aware of
the specific requirements in your state,
and where you are travelling.
Child restraint systems must be properly
placed and installed in the rear seat.
You must use a commercially available
child restraint system that meets the
requirements of the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS 213).
Child restraint systems are generally
designed to be secured in a vehicle seat
by lap belt portion of a lap/shoulder belt,
or by a LATCH system in the rear seats of
the vehicle.
Child Restraint System (CRS)
Infants and younger children must be
restrained in an appropriate rear-facing
or forward-facing CRS that has first
been properly secured to the rear seat
of the vehicle. Read and comply with
the instructions for installation and use
provided by the manufacturer of the
child restraint.
WARNING
An improperly secured child restraint
can increase the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH in an accident. Always
take the following precautions when
using a child restraint system:
ś NEVER install a child or infant
restraint in the front passenger’s
seat.
ś Always properly secure the child
restraint to a rear seat of the vehicle.
ś Always follow the child restraint
system manufacturer’s instructions
for installation and use.
ś Always properly restrain your child in
the child restraint.
ś If the vehicle head restraint prevents
proper installation of a child seat
(as described in the child restraint
system manual), the head restraint of
the respective seating position shall
be readjusted or entirely removed.
ś Do not use an infant carrier or a
child safety seat that “hooks” over
a seatback, it may not provide
adequate protection in an accident.
ś After an accident, have a HYUNDAI
dealer check the child restraint
system, seat belts, tether anchors
and lower anchors.
3-23
Safety System
Selecting a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
When selecting a CRS for your child,
always:
ś Make sure the CRS has a label
certifying that it meets applicable
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards (FMVSS 213).
ś Select a child restraint based on
your child’s height and weight. The
required label or the instructions for
use typically provide this information.
ś Select a child restraint that fits the
vehicle seating position where it will
be used.
ś Read and comply with the warnings
and instructions for installation and
use provided with the child restraint
system.
Child Restraint System Types
There are three main types of child
restraint systems: rear-facing seats,
forward-facing seats, and booster seats.
They are classified according to the
child’s age, height and weight.
Rear-facing child seats
WARNING
NEVER install a child or infant restraint
in the front passenger’s seat.
Placing a rear-facing child restraint in
the front seat can result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH if the child restraint is
struck by an inflating air bag.
3-24
OQX039018N
A rear-facing child seat provides restraint
with the seating surface against the back
of the child. The harness system holds
the child in place, and in an accident,
acts to keep the child positioned in the
seat and reduce the stress to the neck
and spinal cord.
All children under age one must always
ride in a rear-facing infant child restraint.
Convertible and 3-in-1 child seats
typically have higher height and weight
limits for the rear-facing position,
allowing you to keep your child rearfacing for a longer period of time.
Continue to use a rear-facing child seat
for as long as your child will fit within the
height and weight limits allowed by the
child seat manufacturer. It’s the best way
to keep them safe. Once your child has
outgrown the rear-facing child restraint,
your child is ready for a forward-facing
child restraint with a harness.
03
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
OQX039022N
Forward-facing child restraints
A forward-facing child seat provides
restraint for the child’s body with a
harness. Keep children in a forwardfacing child seat with a harness until
they reach the top height or weight
limit allowed by your child restraint’s
manufacturer.
Once your child outgrows the forwardfacing child restraint, your child is ready
for a booster seat.
Booster seats
A booster seat is a restraint designed to
improve the fit of the vehicle’s seat belt
system. A booster seat positions the seat
belt so that it fits properly over the lap of
your child.
Keep your child in a booster seat until
they are big enough to sit in the seat
without a booster and still have the
seat belt fit properly. For a seat belt
to fit properly, the lap belt must lie
snugly across the upper thighs, not the
stomach. The shoulder belt should lie
snug across the shoulder and chest and
not across the neck or face. Children
under age 13 must always ride in the
rear seats and must always be properly
restrained to minimize the risk of injury.
Before installing your child restraint
system always:
ś Read and follow the instructions
provided by the manufacturer of the
child restraint.
ś Read and follow the instructions
regarding child restraint systems in
this manual.
Failure to follow all warnings and
instructions could increase the risk of
the SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if an
accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle head restraint prevents
proper installation of a child seat (as
described in the child seat system
manual, the head restraint of the
respective seating position shall be
readjusted or entirely removed.
3-25
Safety System
After selecting a proper child seat
for your child, check to make sure it
fits properly in your vehicle. Follow
the instructions provided by the
manufacturer when installing the child
seat. Note these general steps when
installing the seat to your vehicle:
ś Properly secure the child restraint
to the vehicle. All child restraints
must be secured to the vehicle with
the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt
or with the LATCH system. If using
the lap/shoulder belt for your child
restraint, the convertible locking
retractor should be pulled all the way
out to engage the “automatic locking”
mode. (See page 3-29)
ś Make sure the child restraint is
firmly secured. After installing a
child restraint to the vehicle, push
and pull the seat forward-and-back
and side-to-side to verify that it
is securely attached to the seat. A
child restraint secured with a seat
belt should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-to-side
movement can be expected.
ś Secure the child in the child
restraint. Make sure the child is
properly strapped in the child restraint
according to the manufacturer
instructions.
Lower Anchors And Tether for
Children (LATCH System)
The LATCH system holds a child restraint
during driving and in an accident. This
system is designed to make installation
of the child restraint easier and reduce
the possibility of improperly installing
your child restraint. The LATCH system
uses anchors in the vehicle and
attachments on the child restraint. The
LATCH system eliminates the need to use
seat belts to secure the child restraint to
the rear seats.
Lower anchors are metal bars built into
the vehicle. There are two lower anchors
for each LATCH seating position that
will accommodate a child restraint with
lower attachments.
To use the LATCH system in your vehicle,
you must have a child restraint with
LATCH attachments.
The child seat manufacturer will provide
you with instructions on how to use the
child seat with its attachments for the
LATCH lower anchors.
CAUTION
A child restraint in a closed vehicle can
become very hot. To prevent burns,
check the seating surface and buckles
before placing your child in the child
restraint.
3-26
OQX039034L
LATCH anchors have been provided in
the left and right outboard rear seating
positions. Their locations are shown
in the illustration. There are no LATCH
anchors provided for the center rear
seating position.
03
WARNING
Do not attempt to install a child
restraint system using LATCH anchors in
the rear center seating position. There
are no LATCH anchors provided for this
seat. Using the outboard seat anchors
can damage the anchors which may
break or fail in a collision resulting in
serious injury or death.
Securing a Child Restraint with the
LATCH Anchors System
To install a LATCH-compatible child
restraint in either of the rear outboard
seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away from
the lower anchors.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchors that could prevent a
secure connection between the child
restraint and the lower anchors.
3. Place the child restraint on the vehicle
seat, then attach the seat to the lower
anchors according to the instructions
provided by the child restraint
manufacturer.
4. Follow the child restraint instructions
for properly adjusting and tightening
the lower attachments on the child
restraint to the lower anchors.
OQX039020L
[A]: ISOFIX Anchorage Position Indicator,
[B]: ISOFIX Anchorage
The lower anchor position indicator
symbols are located on the left and right
rear seat backs to identify the position
of the lower anchors in your vehicle (see
arrows in illustration).
The LATCH anchors are located between
the seatback and the seat cushion of the
rear seat left and right outboard seating
positions.
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the LATCH system:
ś Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your child
restraint system.
ś To prevent the child from reaching
and taking hold of unretracted
seat belts, buckle all unused rear
seat belts and retract the seat belt
webbing behind the child. Children
can be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around their neck
and the seat belt tightens.
ś NEVER attach more than one
child restraint to a single anchor.
This could cause the anchor or
attachment to come loose or break.
ś Always have the LATCH system
inspected by your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer after an accident.
An accident can damage the LATCH
system and may not properly secure
the child restraint.
3-27
Safety System
NOTICE
The recommended weight for the
LATCH system is under 65 lb (30 kg).
How to determine an appropriate child
restraint weight:
Child weight + Child restraint weight <
65 lb (30kg)
Securing a Child Restraint Seat with
“Tether Anchor” System
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
installing the tether strap:
ś Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with your child
restraint system.
ś NEVER attach more than one child
restraint to a single tether anchor.
This could cause the anchor or
attachment to come loose or break.
ś Do not attach the tether strap to
anything other than the correct
tether anchor. It may not work
properly if attached to something
else.
ś Do not use the tether anchors for
adult seat belts or harnesses, or for
attaching other items or equipment
to the vehicle.
OQX039021N
First secure the child restraint with
the LATCH lower anchors or the seat
belt. If the child restraint manufacturer
recommends that the top tether strap
be attached, attach and tighten the
top tether strap to the top tether strap
anchor.
Child restraint hook holders are located
on the rear of the seatbacks.
OQX039022N
To install the tether anchor:
1. Route the child restraint tether strap
over the child restraint seatback.
Route the tether strap under the
head restraint and between the head
restraint posts, or route the tether
strap over the top of the vehicle
seatback. Make sure the strap is not
twisted.
2. Connect the tether strap hook to the
tether anchor, then tighten the tether
strap according to the child seat
manufacturer’s instructions to firmly
secure the child restraint to the seat.
3-28
03
3. Check that the child restraint is
securely attached to the seat by
pushing and pulling the seat forwardand-back and side-to-side.
Securing a Child Restraint with Lap/
shoulder Belt
When not using the LATCH system, all
child restraints must be secured to a
vehicle rear seat with the lap part of a
lap/shoulder belt.
WARNING
To install a child restraint system on the
rear seats, do the following:
1. Place the child restraint system
on a rear seat and route the lap/
shoulder belt around or through the
child restraint, following the restraint
manufacturer’s instructions.
Be sure the seat belt webbing is not
twisted.
Make sure to insert the belt into the
guide(1).
NOTICE
ALWAYS place a rear-facing child
restraint in the rear seat of the vehicle.
Placing a rear-facing child restraint in
the front seat can result in serious injury
or death if the child restraint is struck
by an inflating air bag.
When using the rear center seat belt,
you should also refer to the “Rear Seat
Belt – Passenger’s 3-point system”
section in this chapter.
OQX039057N
OHI038145
Automatic locking mode
Since all passenger seat belts move
freely under normal conditions and
only lock under extreme or emergency
conditions (emergency locking mode),
you must manually pull the seat belt all
the way out to shift the retractor to the
“Automatic Locking” mode to secure a
child restraint.
The “Automatic Locking” mode will
help prevent the normal movement of
the child in the vehicle from causing
the seat belt to loosen and compromise
the child restraint system. To secure a
child restraint system, use the following
procedure.
2. Make sure to insert the belt into the
guide (1) and check that the seat belt
is not twisted.
OHI038146
3. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct
“click” sound.
3-29
Safety System
Information
Position the release button so that it is easy
to access in case of an emergency.
OLF034076
4. Pull the shoulder portion of the
seat belt all the way out. When the
shoulder portion of the seat belt
is fully extended, it will shift the
retractor to the “Automatic Locking”
(child restraint) mode.
6. Remove as much slack from the belt
as possible by pushing down on the
child restraint system while feeding
the shoulder belt back into the
retractor.
7. Push and pull on the child restraint
system to confirm that the seat belt
is holding it firmly in place. If it is not,
release the seat belt and repeat steps
2 through 6.
8. Double check that the retractor is in
the “Automatic Locking” mode by
attempting to pull more of the seat
belt out of the retractor. If you cannot,
the retractor is in the “Automatic
Locking” mode.
If your CRS (child restraint system)
manufacturer instructs or recommends
you to use a tether anchor with the lap/
shoulder belt, refer to the previous pages
for more information.
NOTICE
When the seat belt is allowed to
retract to its fully stowed position, the
retractor will automatically switch from
the “Automatic Locking” mode to the
emergency lock mode for normal adult
usage.
WARNING
OLF034075
5. Slowly allow the shoulder portion of
the seat belt to retract and listen for
an audible “clicking” or “ratcheting”
sound. This indicates that the retractor
is in the “Automatic Locking” mode.
If no distinct sound is heard, repeat
steps 3 and 4.
If the retractor is not in the “Automatic
Locking” mode, the child restraint
can move when your vehicle turns or
stops suddenly. A child can be seriously
injured or killed if the child restraint
is not properly anchored in the car,
including manually pulling the seat belt
all the way out to shift the rectractor to
the “Automatic Locking” mode.
To remove the child restraint, press the
release button on the buckle and then
pull the lap/shoulder belt out of the
restraint and allow the seat belt to retract
fully.
3-30
03
$,5%$*ǘ$'9$1&('6833/(0(17$/5(675$,176<67(0
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OQX039023N
1.
2.
3.
4.
Driver’s front air bag
Passenger’s front air bag
Side air bag
Curtain air bag
3-31
Safety System
This vehicle is equipped with an Advanced Supplemental Air Bag System for the
driver’s seat and front passenger’s seats.
The front air bags are designed to supplement the three-point seat belts. For these air
bags to provide protection, the seat belts must be worn at all times when driving.
You can be severely injured or killed in an accident if you are not wearing a seat belt.
Air bags are designed to supplement seat belts, but do not replace them. Also, air bags
are not designed to deploy in every collision. In some accidents, the seat belts are the
only restraint protecting you.
WARNING
AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
ALWAYS use seat belts and child restraints - every trip, every time, everyone! Even
with air bags, you can be seriously injured or killed in a collision if you are improperly
belted or not wearing your seat belt when the air bag inflates.
NEVER place a child in any child restraint or booster seat in the front passenger seat.
An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant or child causing serious or fatal
injuries.
ABC - Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the safest place
for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older must be seated in the front
seat, he or she must be properly belted and the seat should be moved as far back as
possible.
All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their
feet on the floor until the vehicle is parked and is turned off. If an occupant is out of
position during an accident, the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully contact the
occupant causing serious or fatal injuries.
You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily close to the air bags
or lean against the door or center console.
Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still maintaining
control of the vehicle. The U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) recommends that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the
center of the steering wheel and the chest.
3-32
03
Where Are the Air Bags?
Driver’s And Passenger’s Front Air
Bags
Your vehicle is equipped with an
Advanced Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) and lap/shoulder belts at
both the driver and passenger seating
positions.
The SRS consists of air bags which are
located in the center of the steering
wheel, in the driver’s side lower crash
pad below the steering wheel column
and the passenger’s side front panel pad
above the glove box.
The air bags are labeled with the letters
“AIR BAG” embossed on the pad covers.
Driver’s front air bag
OQX039024L
Passenger’s front air bag
OQX039035L
The purpose of the SRS is to provide the
vehicle’s driver and front passengers
with additional protection than that
offered by the seat belt system alone.
The advanced SRS offers the ability to
control the air bag inflation within two
levels. A first stage level is provided for
moderate-severity impacts. A second
stage level is provided for more severe
impacts.
According to the impact severity, the
SRS Control Module (SRSCM) controls
the air bag inflation. Failure to properly
wear seat belts can increase the risk or
severity of injury in an accident.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from inflating front air bags, take
the following precautions:
ś Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
ś Move your seat as far back as
possible from front air bags, while
still maintaining control of the
vehicle.
ś Never lean against the door or center
console.
ś Do not allow the front passenger
to place their feet or legs on the
dashboard.
ś No objects (such as crash pad
cover, cellular phone holder, cup
holder, perfume or stickers) should
be placed over or near the air bag
modules on the steering wheel,
instrument panel, windshield glass,
and the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box. Such objects
could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
crash severe enough to cause the air
bags to deploy.
3-33
Safety System
Side Air Bags
WARNING
OIB034021
OQX039048
Your vehicle is equipped with a side air
bag in each front seat. The purpose of
the air bag is to provide the vehicle’s
driver and the front passenger with
additional protection than that offered by
the seat belt alone.
The side air bags are designed to deploy
during certain side impact collisions,
depending on the crash severity.
The side and curtain air bags on both
sides of the vehicle may deploy if a
rollover or possible rollover is detected.
The side air bags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
3-34
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating side air bag,
take the following precautions:
ś Seat belts must be worn at all times
to help keep occupants positioned
properly.
ś Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
ś Hold the steering wheel at the 9
o’clock and 3 o’clock positions, to
minimize the risk of injuries to your
hands and arms.
ś Do not use any accessory seat
covers. This could reduce or prevent
the effectiveness of the system.
ś Do not place any objects over the
air bag or between the air bag and
yourself. Also, do not attach any
objects around the area the air bag
inflates such as the door, side door
glass, front and rear pillar.
ś Do not place any objects between
the door and the seat. They may
become dangerous projectiles if the
side air bag inflates.
ś Do not install any accessories on the
side or near the side air bags.
ś Do not put any objects between the
side airbag label and seat cushion. It
could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
crash severe enough to cause the air
bags to deploy.
ś Do not cause impact to the doors
when the ignition switch button is in
the ON position as this may cause the
side air bags to inflate.
ś If the seat or seat cover is damaged,
have the vehicle checked and
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
03
Curtain Air Bags
WARNING
OQX039052
OQX039053
Curtain air bags are located along both
sides of the roof rails above the front and
rear doors.
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants and
the rear outboard seat occupants in
certain side impact collisions.
The curtain air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity.
The side and curtain air bags on both
sides of the vehicle may deploy if a
rollover or possible rollover is detected.
The curtain air bags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating curtain air bag,
take the following precautions:
ś All seat occupants must wear
seat belts at all times to help keep
occupants positioned properly.
ś Properly secure child restraints as far
away from the door as possible.
ś Do not place any objects over the air
bag. Also, do not attach any objects
around the area the air bag inflates
such as the door, side door glass,
front and rear pillar, roof side rail.
ś Do not hang other objects except
clothes, especially hard or breakable
objects. In an accident, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
ś Do not allow passengers to lean their
heads or bodies onto doors, put their
arms on the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
ś Do not open or repair the side curtain
air bags.
3-35
Safety System
How Does the Air Bag System
Operate?
SRS warning light
The SRS (Supplement Restraint System)
air bag warning light on the instrument
panel displays the air bag symbol
depicted in the illustration. The system
checks the air bag electrical system for
malfunctions. The light indicates that
there is a potential malfunction with your
air bag system, which could include your
side and curtain air bags used for rollover
protection.
OQX039027
The SRS consists of the following
components:
1. Driver’s front air bag module
2. Passenger’s front air bag module
3. Side air bag modules
4. Curtain air bag modules
5. Retractor pre-tensioner
6. Air bag warning light
7. SRS control module (SRSCM)/Rollover
sensor
8. Front impact sensors
9. Side impact sensors
10. Side pressure sensors
11. Occupant classification system
The SRSCM (Supplemental Restraint
System Control Module) continually
monitors all SRS components while the
ignition switch is in the ON position to
determine if a crash impact is severe
enough to require air bag deployment or
pre-tensioner seat belt deployment.
3-36
WARNING
If your SRS malfunctions, the air bag
may not inflate properly during an
accident increasing the risk of serious
injury or death.
If any of the following conditions occur,
your SRS is malfunctioning:
ś The light does not turn on for
approximately six seconds when the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON
position.
ś The light stays on after illuminating
for approximately six seconds.
ś The light comes on while the vehicle
is in motion.
ś The light blinks when the engine is
running.
Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
inspect the SRS as soon as possible if
any of these conditions occur.
03
During a frontal collision, sensors will
detect the vehicle’s deceleration. If the
rate of deceleration is high enough, the
control unit will inflate the front air bags.
The front air bags help protect the driver
and front passenger by responding to
frontal impacts in which seat belts alone
cannot provide adequate restraint. When
needed, the side air bags help provide
protection in the event of a side impact
or rollover.
ś Air bags are activated (able to inflate
if necessary) only when the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON
position.
ś Air bags inflate in the event of certain
frontal or side collisions to help
protect the occupants from serious
physical injury.
ś Generally, air bags are designed to
inflate based upon the severity of
a collision, its direction, etc. These
two factors determine whether
the sensors produce an electronic
deployment/inflation signal.
ś The front air bags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant. It is
virtually impossible for you to see the
air bags inflate during an accident. It is
much more likely that you will simply
see the deflated air bags hanging out
of their storage compartments after
the collision.
ś In addition to inflating in certain side
collisions, vehicles equipped with a
rollover sensor, side and curtain air
bags will inflate if the sensing system
detects a rollover.
When a rollover is detected, side and
curtain air bags will remain inflated
longer to help provide protection
from ejection, especially when used in
conjunction with the seat belts.
ś To help provide protection, the air
bags must inflate rapidly. The speed
of air bag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which
to inflate the air bag between the
occupant and the vehicle structures
before the occupant impacts those
structures. This speed of inflation
reduces the risk of serious or lifethreatening injuries and is thus a
necessary part of air bag design.
However, the rapid air bag inflation
can also cause injuries which can
include facial abrasions, bruises and
broken bones because the inflation
speed also causes the air bags to
expand with a great deal of force.
ś There are even circumstances under
which contact with the air bag can
cause fatal injuries, especially if the
occupant is positioned excessively
close to the air bag.
You can take steps to help reduce the
risk of being injured by an inflating air
bag. The greatest risk is sitting too close
to the air bag. An air bag needs about 10
inches (25 cm) of space to inflate. NHTSA
recommends that drivers allow at least
10 inches (25 cm) between the center of
the steering wheel and the chest.
3-37
Safety System
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death from an inflating air bag, take the
following precautions:
ś NEVER place a child restraint in the
front passenger seat.
Always properly restrain children
under age 13 in the rear seats of the
vehicle.
ś Adjust the front passenger’s and
driver’s seats as far to the rear as
possible while allowing you to
maintain full control of the vehicle.
ś Hold the steering wheel with
hands at the 9 o’clock and 3 o’clock
positions.
ś Never place anything or anyone
between the air bag and the seat
occupant.
ś Do not allow the front passenger
to place their feet or legs on the
dashboard.
Driver’s front air bag (1)
ODN8039077L
When the SRSCM detects a sufficiently
severe impact to the front of the vehicle,
it will automatically deploy the front air
bags.
Driver’s front air bag (2)
ODN8039078L
Upon deployment, tear seams molded
directly into the pad covers will separate
under pressure from the expansion of the
air bags. Further opening of the covers
allows full inflation of the air bags.
A fully inflated air bag, in combination
with a properly worn seat belt, slows the
driver or the front passenger forward
motion, reducing the risk of head and
chest injury.
3-38
03
What to Expect After an Air Bag
Inflates
Driver’s front air bag (3)
After a frontal or side air bag inflates, it
will deflate very quickly. Air bag inflation
will not prevent the driver from seeing
out of the windshield or being able
to steer. Curtain air bags may remain
partially inflated for some time after they
deploy.
ODN8039079L
Passenger’s front air bag
ODN8039080L
After complete inflation, the air bag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility
and the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
WARNING
To prevent objects from becoming
dangerous projectiles when the
passenger’s air bag inflates:
ś Do not install or place any objects
(drink holder, CD holder, stickers,
etc.) on the front passenger’s panel
above the glove box where the
passenger’s air bag is located.
ś Do not install a container of liquid
air freshener near the instrument
cluster or on the instrument panel
surface.
WARNING
After an air bag inflates, take the
following precautions:
ś Open your windows and doors as
soon as possible after impact to
reduce prolonged exposure to the
smoke and powder released by the
inflating air bag.
ś Do not touch the air bag storage
area’s internal components
immediately after an air bag has
inflated. The parts that come into
contact with an inflating air bag may
be very hot.
ś Always wash exposed skin areas
thoroughly with cold and mild soap.
ś Always have an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer replace the air bag
immediately after deployment. Air
bags are designed to be used only
once.
3-39
Safety System
Noise And Smoke from Inflating Air
Bag
When the air bags inflate, they make a
loud noise and may produce smoke and
powder in the air inside of the vehicle.
This is normal and is a result of the
ignition of the air bag inflator. After the
air bag inflates, you may feel substantial
discomfort in breathing because of the
contact of your chest with both the seat
belt and the air bag, as well as from
breathing the smoke and powder. The
powder may aggravate asthma for some
people. If you experience breathing
problems after an air bag deployment,
seek medical attention immediately.
Though the smoke and powder are
nontoxic, they may cause irritation to
the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If this is
the case, wash and rinse with cold water
immediately and seek medical attention
if the symptoms persist.
Occupant Classification System
(OCS)
OQX039025L
Your vehicle is equipped with an
Occupant Classification System (OCS) in
the front passenger’s seat.
Main Components of the Occupant
Classification System
ś A detection device located within the
front passenger seat cushion.
ś Electronic system to determine
whether the passenger air bag
systems should be activated or
deactivated.
ś An indicator light located on the
instrument panel which illuminates
the words “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicating the front passenger air bag
system is deactivated.
ś The instrument panel air bag indicator
light is interconnected with the OCS.
The OCS is designed to help detect
the presence of a properly-seated
front passenger and determine if the
passenger’s front air bag should be
enabled (may inflate) or not.
The purpose is to help reduce the risk
of injury or death from an inflating air
bag to certain front passenger seat
occupants, such as children, by requiring
the air bag to be automatically turned
OFF.
3-40
03
For example, if a child restraint of the
type specified in the regulations is on the
seat, the occupant classification sensor
can detect it and cause the air bag to
turn OFF.
Front passenger seat adult occupants
who are properly seated and wearing the
seat belt properly, should not cause the
passenger air bag to be automatically
turned OFF. For small adults it may be
turned OFF, however, if the occupant
does not sit in the seat properly (for
example, by not sitting upright, by sitting
on the edge of the seat, or by otherwise
being out of position), this could cause
the sensor to turn the air bag OFF.
You will find the “PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF” indicator on the center fascia
panel. This system detects the conditions
1-4 in the following table and activates or
deactivates the front passenger air bag
based on these conditions.
Always be sure that you and all vehicle
occupants are seated properly and
wearing the seat belt properly for the
most effective protection by the air bag
and the seat belt.
The OCS may not function properly if the
passenger takes actions which can affect
the classification system. These include:
ś Failing to sit in an upright position.
ś Leaning against the door or center
console.
ś Sitting towards the sides of the front
of the seat.
ś Putting their legs on the dashboard or
resting them on other locations which
reduce the passenger weight on the
front seat.
ś Wearing the seat belt improperly.
ś Reclining the seatback.
ś Wearing a thick cloth like ski wear or
hip protection wear.
ś Putting an additional thick cushion on
the seat.
ś Putting electrical devices (e.g.
notebook, satellite radio) on the seat
with inverter charging.
3-41
Safety System
Condition and operation in the front passenger Occupant Classification System
Indicator/Warning light
Condition detected by the
occupant classification system
Devices
“PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF”
indicator light
SRS warning
light
Front passenger
air bag
1. Adult *1
Off
Off
Activated
2. Infant *2 or child restraint
system with 12 months old
On
Off
Deactivated
3. Unoccupied
On
Off
Deactivated
4. Malfunction in the system
Off
On
Activated
*3 *4
The system judges a person of adult size as an adult. When a smaller adult sits in the
front passenger seat, the system may recognize him/her as a child depending on his/her
physique and posture.
*2 : Do not allow children to ride in the front passenger seat. When a larger child who has
outgrown a child restraint system sits in the front passenger seat, the system may
recognize him/her as an adult depending upon his/her physique or sitting position.
*3 : Never install a child restraint system on the front passenger seat.
*4 : The PASSENGER AIR BAG “OFF” indicator may turn on or off when a child above 12
months to 12 years old (with or without child restraint system) sits in the front passenger
seat. This is a normal condition.
*1 :
3-42
03
WARNING
Riding in an improper position or placing weight on the front passenger’s seat when
it is unoccupied by a passenger adversely affects the OCS. To reduce the risk of
serious injury or death:
ś NEVER put a heavy load in the front seat or seatback
pocket, or hang any items on the front passenger
seat.
OVQ036013NB
OLMB033100
OLMB033101
OLMB033103
ś NEVER place your feet on the front passenger
seatback.
ś NEVER sit with your hips shifted towards the front of
the seat.
ś NEVER ride with the seatback reclined when the
vehicle is moving.
ś NEVER place your feet or legs on the dashboard.
OLMB033102
3-43
Safety System
ś NEVER lean on the door or center console or sit on
one side of the front passenger seat.
OLMB033104
ODH035900K
ODH035901K
OQX039046
ś Do not sit on the passenger seat wearing heavily
padded clothes such as ski wear and hip protector.
ś Do not use car seat accessories such as thick blankets
and cushions which cover up the car seat surface.
ś Do not place electronic devices such as laptops, DVD
player, or conductive materials such as water bottles
on the passenger seat.
ś Do not use electronic devices such as laptops and
satellite radios which use inverter chargers.
ś If large quantity of liquid has been spilled on the
passenger seat, the air bag warning light may
illuminate or malfunction.
Therefore, make sure the seat has been completely
dried before driving the vehicle.
OQX039047
ś Do not place sharp objects on the front passenger seat. These may damage the
occupant detection system, if they puncture the seat cushion.
ś Do not place any items under the front passenger seat.
ś When changing or replacing the seat or seat cover, use original items only.
The OCS has been developed based on using original HYUNDAI car seats only.
Altering or changing the authentic parts may result in system malfunction and
increase risk of injury when in collision. Any of the above could interfere with the
proper operation of the OCS sensor thereby increasing the risk of an injury in an
accident.
3-44
03
WARNING
B990A01O
Proper seated position for OCS
If the “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator is on when an adult is seated
in the front passenger seat, place the
Engine Start/Stop button in the OFF
position and ask the passenger to sit
properly (sitting upright with the seat
back in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat belt
on, legs comfortably extended and their
feet on the floor). Restart the engine and
have the person remain in that position.
This will allow the system to detect the
person and to enable the passenger air
bag. If the “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator is still on, ask the passenger to
move to the rear seat.
Never allow an adult passenger to ride
in the front passenger seat when the
“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” indicator
is illuminated. During a collision, the
air bag will not inflate if the indicator
is illuminated. Have your passenger
reposition themselves in the seat. If the
“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” indicator
remains illuminated after the passenger
repositions themselves properly
and the vehicle is restarted, have
the passenger move to the rear seat
because the air bag will not inflate.
NOTICE
The “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”
indicator illuminates for approximately
4 seconds after the Engine Start/
Stop button is in the ON position or
after the engine is started. If the front
passenger seat is occupied, the OCS will
then classify the front passenger after
several more seconds.
3-45
Safety System
Do Not Install a Child Restraint in the
Front Passenger’s Seat
Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in
a Collision?
Air bags are not designed to inflate in
every collision. There are certain types
of accidents in which the air bag would
not be expected to provide additional
protection. These include rear impacts,
second or third collisions in multiple
impact accidents, as well as low speed
impacts. Damage to the vehicle indicates
a collision energy absorption, and is not
an indicator of whether or not an air bag
should have inflated.
1JBH3051
Even though your vehicle is equipped
with the OCS, never install a child
restraint in the front passenger’s seat.
An inflating air bag can forcefully strike a
child or child restraint resulting in serious
or fatal injury.
WARNING
ś NEVER place a rear-facing or frontfacing child restraint in the front
passenger’s seat of the vehicle.
ś An inflating frontal air bag could
forcefully strike a child resulting in
serious injury or death.
ś Always properly restrain children in
an appropriate child restraint in the
rear seat of the vehicle.
3-46
Air Bag Collision Sensors
WARNING
To reduce the risk of an air bag
deploying unexpectedly and causing
serious injury or death:
ś Do not hit or allow any objects to
impact the locations where air bags
or sensors are installed.
ś Do not perform maintenance on or
around the air bag sensors. If the
location or angle of the sensors is
altered, the air bags may deploy
when they should not or may not
deploy when they should.
ś Do not install bumper guards or
replace the bumper with a nongenuine HYUNDAI parts. This may
adversely affect the collision and air
bag deployment performance.
ś Place the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF or ACC position when the
vehicle is being towed to prevent
inadvertent air bag deployment.
ś Have all air bag repairs conducted by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
03
OQX039029L/OQX039030L/OQX039028L/OQX039036L/OQXI039029
1.
2.
3.
4.
SRS control module/Rollover sensor
Front impact sensor
Side pressure sensor
Side impact sensor
3-47
Safety System
Air Bag Inflation Conditions
OQXI039030
Front air bags
Front air bags are designed to inflate
in a frontal collision depending on the
severity of impact of the front collision.
Side and curtain air bags
Side and curtain air bags are designed
to inflate when an impact is detected by
side collision sensors depending on the
severity of impact resulting from a side
impact collision.
Although the driver’s and front
passenger’s air bags are designed to
inflate only in frontal collisions, they also
may inflate in other types of collisions
if the front impact sensors detect a
sufficient impact. Side and curtain air
bags are designed to inflate only in side
impact collisions or rollover situations,
but they may inflate in other collisions
if the side impact sensors detect a
sufficient impact.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved roads,
the air bags may deploy. Drive carefully
on unimproved roads or on surfaces not
designed for vehicle traffic to prevent
unintended air bag deployment.
Air Bag Non-inflation Conditions
OQX039042L
OQXI039031
OQX039053
3-48
In certain low-speed collisions the air
bags may not deploy. The air bags are
designed not to deploy in such cases
because they may not provide benefits
beyond the protection of the seat belts.
03
OQXI039032
Front air bags are not designed to inflate
in rear collisions, because occupants
are moved backward by the force of the
impact. In this case, inflated air bags
would not provide any additional benefit.
OQX039042L
Front air bags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move in the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, front air bag
deployment would not provide additional
occupant protection.
However, side and curtain air bags may
inflate depending on the severity of
impact.
OQX039040L
In an angled collision, the force of impact
may direct the occupants in a direction
where the air bags would not be able to
provide any additional benefit, and thus
the sensors may not deploy any air bags.
OQXI039034
Just before impact, drivers often brake
heavily. Such heavy braking lowers the
front portion of the vehicle causing it
to “ride” under a vehicle with a higher
ground clearance. Air bags may not
inflate in this “underride” situation
because deceleration forces that are
detected by sensors may be significantly
reduced by such “underride” collisions.
3-49
Safety System
SRS Care
OQXI039035
Front air bags may not inflate in rollover
accidents because air bag deployment
may not provide protection to the
occupants.
However, side and curtain air bags may
inflate when the vehicle is rolled over by a
side impact collision.
OQX039043L
Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility poles
or trees, where the point of impact is
concentrated and the collision energy is
absorbed by the vehicle structure.
3-50
The SRS is virtually maintenance-free
and there are no parts you can safely
service by yourself. If the SRS air bag
warning light does not illuminate when
the ignition switch is in the ON position,
or continuously remains on, have your
vehicle immediately inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Any work on the SRS system, such as
removing, installing, repairing, or any
work on the steering wheel, the front
passenger’s panel, front seats and roof
rails must be performed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer. Improper handling of
the SRS system may result in serious
personal injury.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death, take the following precautions:
ś Do not attempt to modify or
disconnect the SRS components or
wiring, including the addition of any
kind of badges to the pad covers or
modifications to the body structure.
ś Do not place objects over or near
the air bag modules on the steering
wheel, instrument panel, or the front
passenger’s panel above the glove
box.
ś Clean the air bag pad covers with a
soft cloth moistened with plain water.
Solvents or cleaners could adversely
affect the air bag covers and proper
deployment of the system.
ś Always have inflated air bags
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś If components of the air bag system
must be discarded, or if the vehicle
must be scrapped, certain safety
precautions must be observed.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for the necessary information.
Failure to follow these precautions
could increase the risk of personal
injury.
03
Additional Safety Precautions
Passengers should not move out of
or change seats while the vehicle is
moving. A passenger who is not wearing
a seat belt during a crash or emergency
stop can be thrown against the inside of
the vehicle, against other occupants, or
be ejected from the vehicle.
Do not use any accessories on seat
belts. Devices claiming to improve
occupant comfort or reposition the seat
belt can reduce the protection provided
by the seat belt and increase the chance
of serious injury in a crash.
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components or side air bags.
Do not place items under the front
seats. Placing items under the front seats
could interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing
components and wiring harnesses.
Do not cause impact to the doors.
Impact to the doors when the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ON position
may cause the air bags to inflate.
Modifications to accommodate
disabilities. If you require modification
to your vehicle to accommodate
a disability, contact the HYUNDAI
Customer Connect Center at 800-6335151.
Air Bag Warning Labels
OQX039031N
Air bag warning labels, required by the
U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA), are attached
to alert the driver and passengers of
potential risks of the air bag system. Be
sure to read all of the information about
the air bags that are installed on your
vehicle in this Owners Manual.
Adding Equipment to or Modifying
Your Air Bag equipped Vehicle
If you modify your vehicle by changing
your vehicle’s frame, bumper system,
front end or side sheet metal or ride
height, this may affect the operation of
your vehicle’s air bag system.
3-51
4. Instrument Cluster
Instrument Cluster ............................................................................................ 4-4
Instrument Cluster Control ..........................................................................................4-5
Adjusting Instrument Cluster Illumination ...............................................................4-5
Gauges and Meters ......................................................................................................4-5
Speedometer .............................................................................................................4-5
Tachometer ............................................................................................................... 4-6
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge ....................................................................... 4-6
Fuel Gauge ................................................................................................................ 4-6
Outside Temperature Gauge ..................................................................................... 4-7
Odometer ................................................................................................................... 4-7
Range ......................................................................................................................... 4-8
Transmission Shift Indicator ....................................................................................... 4-8
Manual Transmission Shift Indicator ....................................................................... 4-8
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) .................................................................... 4-9
Warning and Indicator Lights ..................................................................................... 4-9
Air Bag Warning Light ............................................................................................... 4-9
Seat Belt Warning Light ............................................................................................ 4-9
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Light............................................................ 4-10
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light.......................................................... 4-11
Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) System Warning Light ........................ 4-11
Electric Power Steering (EPS) Warning Light.......................................................... 4-11
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) .......................................................................... 4-12
Charging System Warning Light ............................................................................. 4-12
Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light ......................................................................... 4-12
Low Fuel Level Warning Light ................................................................................. 4-13
Master Warning Light .............................................................................................. 4-13
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light ............................................................................ 4-13
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Indicator Light ................................................. 4-14
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator Light.......................................... 4-14
Immobilizer Indicator Light (without Smart Key) .................................................. 4-14
Immobilizer Indicator Light (with Smart Key) ........................................................ 4-15
Turn Signal Indicator Light ...................................................................................... 4-15
Headlamp Warning Light ........................................................................................ 4-15
High Beam Indicator Light ...................................................................................... 4-16
Light ON Indicator Light .......................................................................................... 4-16
High Beam Assist (HBA) Indicator Light................................................................. 4-16
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist Warning Light............................................... 4-16
Lane Keep Assist Indicator Light............................................................................. 4-16
4
4
LCD Display Messages ................................................................................................4-17
Shift to P or N to Start Engine(for Smart Key System and Intelligent Variable
Transmission (IVT)) ...................................................................................................4-17
Shift to P (for Smart Key System) .............................................................................4-17
Low Key Battery (for Smart Key System) .................................................................4-17
Press Brake Pedal to Start Engine (for Smart Key System) ....................................4-17
Key Not in Vehicle (for Smart Key System)..............................................................4-17
Key Not Detected (for Smart Key System) ..............................................................4-17
Press START Button Again (for Smart Key System) ................................................4-17
Battery Discharging Due to External Electrical Devices ........................................4-17
Press Clutch Pedal to Start Engine (for Smart Key System and Manual
Transmission) ........................................................................................................... 4-18
Press START Button with Key (for Smart Key System) ........................................... 4-18
Check BRAKE SWITCH Fuse (for Smart Key System) ............................................ 4-18
Door, Hood, Liftgate Open Indicator ...................................................................... 4-18
Sunroof Open ........................................................................................................... 4-18
Icy Road Warning Light ........................................................................................... 4-19
Low Pressure ............................................................................................................ 4-19
Turn FUSE SWITCH on ............................................................................................. 4-19
Lights Mode..............................................................................................................4-20
Wiper ........................................................................................................................4-20
Low Fuel ...................................................................................................................4-20
Engine Overheated ..................................................................................................4-20
Check Headlight ......................................................................................................4-20
Check High Beam Assist (HBA) System ..................................................................4-21
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) System ..............................................4-21
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist System ...............................................4-21
Check Driver Attention Warning System.................................................................4-21
Check Lane Keeping Assist System .........................................................................4-21
4. Instrument Cluster
LCD Display ..................................................................................................... 4-22
LCD Display Control ...................................................................................................4-22
LCD Display Modes ....................................................................................................4-23
Shift to P to Edit Settings ........................................................................................4-24
Quick Guide Help .....................................................................................................4-24
Trip Computer Mode ...............................................................................................4-24
Drive Assist Mode ....................................................................................................4-24
Master Warning Mode .............................................................................................4-25
User Settings Mode .................................................................................................4-25
Trip Computer ..................................................................................................4-31
Trip Modes ................................................................................................................ 4-31
Average Fuel Economy/
Instant Fuel Economy .............................................................................................. 4-31
Accumulated Info Display .......................................................................................4-32
Drive Info Display .....................................................................................................4-32
Digital Speedometer................................................................................................4-33
4
Instrument Cluster
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
OQX049024N
1. Tachometer
4. Engine coolant temperature gauge
2. Speedometer
5. Warning and indicator lights
3. Fuel gauge
6. LCD display (including trip computer)
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more information, refer to the "Gauges and Meters" in this chapter.
4-4
04
Instrument Cluster Control
Adjusting Instrument Cluster
Illumination
OHCR046110
OQX049010N
When the vehicle's parking lamps or
headlamps are on, press the illumination
control button to adjust the brightness of
the instrument panel illumination.
When pressing the illumination control
button, the interior switch illumination
intensity is also adjustable.
WARNING
ś The brightness of the instrument
panel illumination is displayed.
ś If the brightness reaches the
maximum or minimum level, a chime
will sound.
For information regarding the
illumination setting on your audio
display, refer to the "Setup" section of
your Audio or Navigation manual.
Gauges and Meters
Speedometer
Never adjust the instrument cluster
while driving. Doing so could lead to
driver distraction which may cause an
accident and lead to vehicle damage,
serious injury, or death.
OQX049006L
The speedometer indicates the speed of
the vehicle and is calibrated in miles per
hour (MPH) and/or kilometers per hour
(km/h).
4-5
Instrument Cluster
NOTICE
Tachometer
If the gauge pointer moves beyond
the normal range area toward the "H"
position, it indicates overheating that
may damage the engine.
Do not continue driving with an
overheated engine. If your engine
overheats, refer to "If the Engine
Overheats" in chapter 7.
WARNING
OQX049008L
The tachometer indicates the
approximate number of engine
revolutions per minute (RPM).
Use the tachometer to select the correct
shift points and to prevent lugging and/
or over-revving the engine.
Never remove the radiator cap or
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
The engine coolant is under pressure
and could severely burn. Wait until the
engine is cool before adding coolant to
the reservoir.
Fuel Gauge
NOTICE
Do not operate the engine within the
tachometer's RED ZONE. This may
cause severe engine damage.
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge
OQXI049109
This gauge indicates the approximate
amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank.
Information
OQXI049107
This gauge indicates the temperature
of the engine coolant when the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
4-6
ś The fuel tank capacity is given in
chapter 2.
ś The fuel gauge is supplemented by
a low fuel warning light, which will
illuminate when the fuel tank is nearly
empty.
ś On inclines or curves, the fuel gauge
pointer may fluctuate or the low fuel
warning light may come on earlier than
usual due to the movement of fuel in
the tank.
04
WARNING
Running out of fuel can expose vehicle
occupants to danger.
You must stop and obtain additional
fuel as soon as possible after the
warning light comes on or when the
gauge indicator comes close to the "E
(Empty)" level.
NOTICE
For vehicles equipped with Automatic
Climate Control, you can also:
- Press and hold the AUTO and OFF
buttons on the climate control unit for
3 seconds
Both the temperature unit on the cluster
LCD display and climate control screen
will change.
Odometer
Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire and damage
the catalytic converter.
Outside Temperature Gauge
OQX059149N
The odometer indicates the total
distance that the vehicle has been
driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should be
performed.
OPD047463N
This gauge indicates the current outside
air temperature by 1°F (1°C).
- Temperature range: -40°F ~ 140°F
(40°C ~ 60°C)
Note that the temperature indicated
on the LCD display may not change
as quickly as the outside temperature
(there may be a slight delay before the
temperature changes.)
You can change the temperature unit
from °F to °C or °C to °F in the User
Settings mode in the cluster:
- *RWR8VHU6HWWLQJV0RGHƟ2WKHUƟ
Temperature Unit.
4-7
Instrument Cluster
Transmission Shift Indicator
Range
Manual Transmission Shift Indicator
(if equipped)
OAD048563L
ś The range is the estimated distance
the vehicle can be driven with the
remaining fuel.
ś If the estimated distance is below
1 mi. (1 km), the trip computer will
display "----" as range.
Information
ś If the vehicle is not on level ground or
the battery power has been interrupted,
the range function may not operate
correctly.
ś The range may differ from the actual
driving distance as it is only an estimate
of the available driving range for the
vehicle and driving conditions.
ś The trip computer may not register
additional fuel if less than 1.6 gallon (6
liters) of fuel are added to the vehicle.
ś The range may vary significantly based
on driving conditions, driving habits,
and condition of the vehicle.
4-8
OQX059123L
This indicator informs which gear is
desired while driving to save fuel.
ś Shifting up : Ÿ2, Ÿ3, Ÿ4, Ÿ5, Ÿ6
ś Shifting down : ź1, ź2, ź3, ź4, ź5
For example
: Indicates that shifting up to the 3rd
gear is desired (currently, the shift lever
is in the 2nd or 1st gear).
: Indicates that shifting down to the
3rd gear is desired (currently, the shift
lever is in the 4th, 5th, or 6th gear).
When the system is not working properly,
the indicator is not displayed.
04
Intelligent Variable Transmission
(IVT) (if equipped)
Warning and Indicator Lights
Information
Make sure that all warning lights are OFF
after starting the engine. If any light is still
ON, this indicates a situation that needs
attention.
Air Bag Warning Light
OTL045132
This indicator displays which gear
position is selected.
ś Park : P
ś Reverse : R
ś Neutral : N
ś Drive : D
ś Manual shift Mode : 1~6
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The air bag warning light illuminates
for about 6 seconds and then turns
off when all checks have been
performed
ś The air bag warning light will remain
illuminated if there is a malfunction
with the Safety Restraint System (SRS)
air bag operation.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Seat Belt Warning Light
OTL045134
Shift indicator pop-up
The pop-up indicates the current gear
position displayed in the cluster for
about 2 seconds when shifting into other
positions (P/R/N/D).
This warning light informs the driver that
the seat belt is not fastened.
For more information, refer to “Seat
Belts” in chapter 3.
4-9
Instrument Cluster
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The parking brake light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and will then
turn off once the parking brake is
released.
ś Whenever the parking brake is
applied.
ś Whenever the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid level in
the reservoir is low.
If the brake fluid level in the reservoir is
low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the engine stopped, check
the brake fluid level immediately
and add fluid as required (For more
information, refer to "Brake Fluid" in
chapter 8). After adding brake fluid,
check all brake components for fluid
leaks. If a brake fluid leak is found, or
if the warning light remains on, or if
the brakes do not operate properly, do
not drive the vehicle. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
4-10
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with
dualdiagonal braking systems. This
means you still have braking on two
wheels even if one of the dual systems
should fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal travel
and greater pedal pressure is required to
stop the vehicle.
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as short
a distance with only a portion of the
brake system working.
If the brakes fail while you are driving,
shift to a lower gear for additional engine
braking and stop the vehicle as soon as it
is safe to do so.
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning
Light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light
ON is dangerous. If the Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid Warning Light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid level is
low.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
04
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The ABS warning light illuminates
for about 3 seconds and then turns
off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the ABS.
Note that the hydraulic braking
system will still be operational even if
there is a malfunction with the ABS.
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD) System
Warning Light
These two warning lights illuminate at the
same time while driving:
When the ABS and regular brake system
may not work normally.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Information - Electronic Brake
Force Distribution (EBD)
System Warning Light
When the ABS Warning Light is on
or both ABS and Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid Warning Lights are on, the
speedometer, odometer, or tripmeter may
not work. Also, the EPS Warning Light
may illuminate and the steering effort may
increase or decrease.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The Electric Power Steering Warning
light illuminates for about 3 seconds
and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the EPS.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Electronic Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) System Warning Light
When both ABS and Parking Brake &
Brake Fluid Warning Lights are on, the
brake system will not work normally
and you may experience an unexpected
and dangerous situation during sudden
braking.
In this case, avoid high speed driving
and abrupt braking.
Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
4-11
Instrument Cluster
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL)
Charging System Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The malfunction indicator light
illuminates for about 3 seconds and
then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
either the emission control system or
the engine or the vehicle powertrain.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
When this warning light illuminates while
the engine is running, the battery is not
being charged. Immediately turn OFF
all electrical accessories. Try not to use
electrically operated controls, such as
the power windows. Keep the engine
running.
Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
Driving with the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on may cause damage to
the emission control system which
could affect drivability and/or fuel
economy.
NOTICE
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) illuminates, potential catalytic
converter damage is possible which
could result in loss of engine power.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
4-12
Engine Oil Pressure Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates:
When the engine oil pressure is low.
If the engine oil pressure is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. Turn the engine off and check
the engine oil level (For more
information, refer to "Engine Oil" in
chapter 8). If the level is low, add oil
as required.
If the warning light remains on after
adding oil or if oil is not available, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
04
NOTICE
ś If the engine is not turned OFF
immediately after the Engine
Oil Pressure Warning Light is
illuminated, severe damage could
occur.
ś If the warning light stays on while the
engine is running, it indicates that
there may be serious engine damage
or malfunction. In this case:
1. Stop the vehicle as soon as it is
safe to do so.
2. Turn off the engine and check the
oil level. If the oil level is low, fill
the engine oil to the proper level.
3. Start the engine again. If the
warning light stays on after the
engine has started, turn the
engine off immediately. In this
case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Low Fuel Level Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
When the fuel tank is nearly empty. Add
fuel as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Master Warning Light
This indicator light illuminates:
When there is a malfunction in operation
in any of the following systems:
- Exterior lamp (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)
(if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the LCD display.
Low Tire Pressure Warning
Light (if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition in the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When one or more of your tires are
significantly underinflated. (The
location of the underinflated tires is
displayed on the LCD display.)
For more information, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)" in
chapter 7.
Driving with the Low Fuel Level warning
light on or with the fuel level below "E"
can cause the engine to misfire and
damage the catalytic converter.
4-13
Instrument Cluster
This warning light remains ON after
blinking for approximately 60 seconds, or
repeatedly blinks ON and OFF in 3 second
intervals:
When there is a malfunction with the
TPMS.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as
soon as possible.
For more information, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)" in
chapter 7.
WARNING
Safe Stopping
ś The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors.
ś If you notice any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off the
accelerator pedal, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- The Electronic Stability Control
indicator light illuminates for about
3 seconds and then goes off.
ś Whenever there is a malfunction with
the ESC system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
While the ESC is operating.
For more information, refer to
“Electronic Stability Control (ESC)” in
chapter 6.
4-14
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) OFF Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When you place the ignition switch to
the ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When you deactivate the ESC system
by pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more information, refer to
“Electronic Stability Control (ESC)” in
chapter 6.
Immobilizer Indicator Light
(without Smart Key)
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When the vehicle detects the
immobilizer in the key with the
ignition switch in the ON position.
- At this time, you can start the
engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
ś When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
04
Immobilizer Indicator Light
(with Smart Key)
(if equipped)
Turn Signal Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates for up to
30 seconds:
When the vehicle detects the smart key
in the vehicle with the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ACC or ON position.
- Once the smart key is detected, you
can start the engine.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the engine.
This indicator light blinks:
When you operate the turn signal
indicator stalk.
This indicator light blinks for a few seconds:
When the smart key is not in the vehicle.
- If the smart key is not detected, you
cannot start the engine.
This indicator light illuminates for 2
seconds and goes off:
If the smart key is in the vehicle and the
Engine Start/Stop button is ON, but the
vehicle cannot detect the smart key.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with the
immobilizer system.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If any of the following occur, there may be
a malfunction with the turn signal system.
- The turn signal indicator light
illuminates but does not blink
- The turn signal indicator light blinks
rapidly
- The turn signal indicator light does not
illuminate at all
If any of these conditions occur, have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Headlamp Warning Light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates:
If one of the exterior bulbs (headlamp,
stop lamp, high mounted stop lamp) is
not operating properly. One of the bulbs
may need to be replaced. If the vehicle
is equipped with LED headlamps, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
When replacing the bulb, use the same
wattage bulb.
For more details, refer to "Light bulbs" in
chapter 8.
4-15
Instrument Cluster
High Beam Indicator Light
Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist Warning Light
(if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When the headlights are on and in the
high beam position.
ś When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
This warning light illuminates:
ś When you set the ignition switch or
Engine Start/Stop button to the ON
position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
ś When there is a malfunction with
FCA. In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized dealer of
HYUNDAI.
For more information, refer to "Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system" in chapter 6.
Light ON Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates:
When the tail lights or headlamps are on.
High Beam Assist (HBA)
Indicator Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś When the high-Beam is on with the
light switch in the AUTO light position.
ś If your vehicle detects oncoming or
preceding vehicles, the High Beam
Assist (HBA) system will switch the
high beam to low beam automatically.
For more information, refer to "High
Beam Assist (HBA) system" in chapter 5.
4-16
Lane Keep Assist Indicator
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
ś [Green] When you activate the lane
departure warning system by pressing
the LKA button and all of the system
operating conditions are satisfied.
ś [White] When system operating
conditions are not satisfied or when
the sensor does not detect the lane
line.
ś [Yellow] When there is a malfunction
with lane keeping assist system.
In this case, have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more information, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA) system" in chapter
6.
04
LCD Display Messages
Shift to P or N to Start Engine
(for Smart Key System and
Intelligent Variable Transmission
(IVT))
This warning message is displayed if you
try to start the engine with the shift lever
not in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position.
Information
You can start the engine with the shift
lever in the N (Neutral) position. But, for
your safety, we recommend that you start
the engine with the shift lever in the P
(Park) position.
Shift to P (for Smart Key System)
This message is displayed if you try to
turn off the engine without the shift lever
in P (Park) position.
If this occurs, the Engine Start/Stop
button turns to the ACC position (If you
press the Engine Start/Stop button once
more, it will turn to the ON position).
Low Key Battery
(for Smart Key System)
This warning message is displayed if the
battery of the smart key is discharged
while changing the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position.
Press Brake Pedal to Start Engine
(for Smart Key System)
This warning message is displayed if the
Engine Start/Stop button changes to
the ACC position twice by pressing the
button repeatedly without depressing
the brake pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing
the brake pedal and then pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button.
Key Not in Vehicle
(for Smart Key System)
This warning message is displayed if the
smart key is not in the vehicle when you
press the Engine Start/Stop button.
When attempting to start the vehicle,
always have the smart key with you.
Key Not Detected
(for Smart Key System)
This warning message is displayed if the
smart key is not detected when you press
the Engine Start/Stop button.
Press START Button Again
(for Smart Key System)
This message is displayed if you were
unable to start the vehicle when the
Engine Start/Stop button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the engine
by pressing the Engine Start/Stop button
again.
If the warning message appears each
time you press the Engine Start/Stop
button, have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Battery Discharging Due to External
Electrical Devices (if equipped)
This message is displayed if the battery
voltage is weak due to any non-factory
electrical accessories (ex. dashboard
camera) while parking. Be careful that
the battery is not discharged.
If the warning message appears after
removing the non-factory electrical
accessories, we recommend that
you have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
4-17
Instrument Cluster
Press Clutch Pedal to Start Engine
(for Smart Key System and Manual
Transmission)
Door, Hood, Liftgate Open Indicator
This warning message is displayed if the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the ACC
position twice by pressing the button
repeatedly without depressing the clutch
pedal.
Depress the clutch pedal to start the
engine.
Press START Button with Key
(for Smart Key System)
OQX049014L
This warning message is displayed if you
press the Engine Start/Stop button while
the warning message "Key not detected"
is displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
This warning is displayed if any door or
the hood or the liftgate is left open. The
warning will indicate which door is open
in the display.
Check BRAKE SWITCH Fuse
(for Smart Key System)
Before driving the vehicle, you should
confirm that the door/hood/liftgate
is fully closed. Also, check there is no
door/hood/liftgate open warning light
or message displayed on the instrument
cluster.
This warning message is displayed if the
brake switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a new
one before starting the engine.
If that is not possible, you can start the
engine by pressing the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds in the ACC
position.
CAUTION
Sunroof Open (if equipped)
OQX049015L
This warning is displayed if you turn off
the engine when the sunroof is open.
Close the sunroof securely before leaving
your vehicle.
4-18
04
Icy Road Warning Light (if equipped)
Low Pressure
OQX059122L
This warning light is to warn the driver
that the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside
temperature gauge is approximately
below 40°F (4°C), the Icy Road Warning
Light and Outside Temperature Gauge
blinks 10 times, and then illuminates.
Also, the warning chime sounds 3 times.
OQX049018L
This warning message is displayed if the
tire pressure is low. The corresponding
tire on the vehicle will be illuminated.
For more information, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)" in
chapter 7.
Turn FUSE SWITCH on
Information
If the icy road warning light appears while
driving, you should drive more attentively
and safely and refrain from speeding,
rapid acceleration, sudden braking or
sharp turning, etc.
OQX049033N
This warning message is displayed if
the fuse switch located on the fuse box
under the steering wheel is OFF.
The fuse switch is turned OFF to
minimize battery draw when the vehicle
is in storage or in transportation where
the vehicle will not be operated for some
time.
Under normal conditions, the fuse switch
should be set to the ON position.
For more information, refer to "Fuses"
in chapter 8.
4-19
Instrument Cluster
Lights Mode
Low Fuel
This warning message is displayed if the
fuel tank is almost out of fuel.
When this message is displayed, the low
fuel level warning light in the cluster will
come on.
It is recommended to look for the nearest
fueling station and refuel as soon as
possible.
Add fuel as soon as possible.
OIK047145L
This indicator displays which exterior
light is selected using the lighting
control.
Wiper
Engine Overheated
This warning message is displayed
when the engine coolant temperature
is above 248°F (120°C). This means that
the engine is overheated and may be
damaged.
If your vehicle has overheated, refer to
“If the Engine Overheats” in chapter 7.
Check Headlight (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if the
headlamps are not operating properly.
A headlamps bulb may need to be
replaced.
Information
OQX049035N
This indicator displays which wiper speed
is selected using the wiper control.
4-20
Make sure to replace the burned out bulb
with a new one of the same wattage rating.
04
Check High Beam Assist (HBA)
System (if equipped)
Check Driver Attention Warning
System (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with High Beam
Assist (HBA) system. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more information, refer to "High
Beam Assist (HBA) system" in chapter 5.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with Driver Attention
Warning system. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more information, refer to "Driver
Attention Warning (DAW)" in chapter 6.
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW) System (if equipped)
Check Lane Keeping Assist System
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed
if there is a problem with Blind-Spot
Collision Warning system. Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Blind-Spot
Collision Warning (BCW) or Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning (RCCW)" in
chapter 6.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with Lane Keeping
Assist system. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more information, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA)" in chapter 6.
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist System (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a malfunction with Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system. Have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
For more information, refer to "Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)" in
chapter 6.
4-21
Instrument Cluster
LCD DISPLAY
LCD Display Control
OQX069070
The LCD display modes can be changed by using the control buttons.
: MODE button for changing modes
1.
,
: MOVE switch for changing items
2.
3. OK : SELECT/RESET button for setting or resetting the selected item
4-22
04
LCD Display Modes
Modes
Symbol
Explanation
Trip Computer
This mode displays driving information such as the
tripmeter, fuel economy, etc.
For more information, refer to "Trip Computer" in
this chapter.
Drive Assist
(if equipped)
This mode displays the state of:
- Lane Keeping Assist system
- Driver Attention Warning system
- Tire pressure
For more information, refer to "Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA)”, “Driver Attention Warning (DAW)” in
chapter 6 and "Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 7.
User Settings
The User Settings menu provides user options for
a variety of settings including door lock/unlock
features, convenience features, driver assistance
settings, etc.
Master Warning
The Warning mode displays warning messages
related to the vehicle when one or more systems is
not operating normally.
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-23
Instrument Cluster
Shift to P to Edit Settings
Drive Assist Mode
This warning message appears if you try
to adjust the User Settings while driving.
For your safety, change the User Settings
after parking the vehicle, applying the
parking brake and moving the shift lever
to P (Park).
Quick Guide Help
This mode provides quick guides for the
systems in the User Settings mode.
Select an item, press and hold the OK
button.
For more information about each
system, refer to this Owner's Manual.
Trip Computer Mode
OQX049017L
LKA/DAW
This mode displays the state of Lane
Keeping Assist system and Driver
Attention Warning system.
For more information, refer to each
system in chapter 6.
OQX049036N
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including fuel economy, trip
meter information and vehicle speed.
For more information, refer to "Trip
Computer" in this chapter.
4-24
OQX049018L
Tire Pressure
This mode displays information related to
Tire Pressure.
For more information, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)" in
chapter 7.
04
Master Warning Mode
User Settings Mode
OQX059124L
This warning light informs the driver the
following situations.
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system malfunction (if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- Lamp malfunction (if equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction
(if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction (if equipped)
The Master Warning Light illuminates
if one or more of the above warning
situations occur. At this time, a Master
Warning icon ( ) will appear beside
the User Settings icon ( ), on the LCD
display.
If the warning situation is solved, the
master warning light will be turned
off and the Master Warning icon will
disappear.
OQX059096L
In this mode, you can change the
settings of the instrument cluster, doors,
lamps, etc.
1. Driver assistance
2. Door
3. Lights
4. Convenience
5. Service interval
6. Other
7. Language
8. Reset
The information provided may differ
depending on which functions are
applicable to your vehicle.
4-25
Instrument Cluster
Edit settings after shifting to P
OQX049040N
This warning message appears if you try
to adjust the User Settings while driving.
Quick guide help
This mode provides quick guides for the
systems in the User Settings mode.
Select an item, press and hold the OK
button.
For more details, about each system,
refer to this Owner's Manual.
4-26
04
1. Driver Assistance
Items
Explanation
Warning Timing
To adjust the warning timing of the driver assistance system.
śNormal / Later
Driver Attention
Warning
To activate or deactivate Leading Vehicle Departure Alert.
To activate or deactivate Inattentive Driving Warning.
For more information, refer to the “Driver Attention Warning
(DAW)” in chapter 6.
Forward safety
To adjust the Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist function.
śActive Assist / Warning only / Off
For more details, refer to the “Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist” in chapter 6.
Lane Safety
To adjust the Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) function.
śActive Lane Keeping Assist / Lane Keeping Assist / Lane Departure
Warning / Off
For more details, refer to the “Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system”
in chapter 6.
Blind-Spot Safety
To adjust the Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) System.
śWarning only
śOff
For more details, refer to “Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)” in
chapter 6.
Parking Safety
To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist System.
For more details, refer to “Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist (RCCA)” in chapter 6.
à The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-27
Instrument Cluster
2. Door
Items
Explanation
Auto Lock
śDisable: The auto door lock operation will be deactivated.
śEnable on Speed: All doors will be automatically locked when the
vehicle speed exceeds 9.3 mph (15km/h).
śEnable on Shift: All doors will be automatically locked if the
intelligent variable transmission shift lever is changed from the P
(Park) position to the R (Reverse), N (Neutral), or D (Drive) position.
(Only when the engine is running)
Auto Unlock
śDisable: The auto door unlock operation will be canceled.
śOn key out/Vehicle Off: All doors will be automatically unlocked
when the ignition key is removed from the ignition switch or the
Engine Start/Stop button is set to the OFF position.
śOn Shift to P: All doors will be automatically unlocked if the
intelligent variable transmission shift lever is changed to P (Park)
position. (Only when the engine is running)
Two Press Unlock
śOff: The two press unlock function will be deactivated. Therefore,
all doors will unlock if the door unlock button is pressed.
śOn: Only the driver’s door will unlock if the door unlock button is
pressed. When the door unlock button is pressed again within 4
seconds, the remaining doors will unlock.
Horn Feedback
To activate or deactivate the horn feedback.
If the horn feedback is activated, after locking the door by pressing
the lock button on the remote key, and pressing it again within 4
seconds, the horn feedback sound will operate once to indicate that
all doors are locked (if equipped with remote key).
à The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
3. Light
Items
Explanation
One Touch Turn
Signal
śOff: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated.
ś3, 5, 7 Flashes: The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7 times
when the turn signal lever is moved slightly.
For more information, refer to "Lighting" in chapter 5.
Headlight Delay
śTo activate or deactivate the headlamp delay function.
For more information, refer to "Lighting" in chapter 5.
High Beam Assist
śTo activate or deactivate the High Beam Assist (HBA) System.
For more details, refer to “High Beam Assist (HBA) system” in
chapter 5.
à The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-28
04
4. Convenience
Items
Explanation
To activate or deactivate Leading Vehicle Departure Alert.
To activate or deactivate Inattentive Driving Warning.
Wiper/Lights Display
When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/Light
mode whenever you changed the mode.
Auto Rear Wiper
(reverse)
To activate or deactivate the rear wiper while the vehicle is in
reverse with the front wiper ON.
Gear Position Popup
To activate or deactivate the gear position pop-up.
When activated, the gear position will be displayed on the LCD
display.
Icy Road Warning
To activate or deactivate the Icy Road Warning function.
à The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
5. Service interval
Items
Explanation
Enable Service
Interval
To activate or deactivate the service interval function.
Adjust Interval
If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the time
and distance.
Information
To use the service interval menu, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the service interval is activated and the time and distance is adjusted, messages are
displayed in the following situations each time the vehicle is turned on.
- Service in: Displayed to inform the driver the remaining mileage and days to service.
- Service required: Displayed when the mileage and days to service has been reached
or passed.
Information
If any of the following conditions occur, the mileage and number of days to service may be
incorrect.
- The battery cable is disconnected.
- The fuse switch is turned off.
- The battery is discharged.
4-29
Instrument Cluster
6. Other
Items
Explanation
Fuel Economy Reset
śOff: The average fuel economy will not reset automatically
whenever refueling.
śAfter ignition: When the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or longer
the average fuel economy will reset automatically.
śAfter refueling: The average fuel economy will reset automatically
after adding 1.6 gallons (6 liters) of fuel or more and after driving
speed exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).
For more information, refer to “Trip Computer” in this chapter.
Speed Unit
(if equipped)
To select the speed unit. (km/h / MPH)
Fuel Economy Unit
To select the fuel economy unit. (US gallon / UK gallon)
Temperature Unit
To select the temperature unit. (°C / °F)
Tire Pressure Unit
To select the tire pressure unit. (psi / kPa / bar)
7. Language
Items
Language
Explanation
To select language.
8. Reset
Items
Reset
Explanation
You can reset the menus in the User Settings mode. All menus in the
User Settings mode are reset to factory settings, except language
and service interval.
à The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable
to your vehicle.
4-30
04
TRIP COMPUTER
The trip computer is a microcomputercontrolled driver information system that
displays information related to driving.
Average Fuel Economy/
Instant Fuel Economy
Information
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip Modes
Fuel Economy
OQX049034N
śAverage Fuel Economy
śInstant Fuel Economy
Average Fuel Economy (1)
ś The average fuel economy is
calculated by the total driving
distance and fuel consumption since
the last average fuel economy reset.
ś The average fuel economy can
be reset both manually and
automatically.
Accumulated Info
śTripmeter
śAverage Fuel Economy
śElapsed Time
Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the OK button on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second
when the average fuel economy is
displayed.
Drive Info
śTripmeter
śAverage Fuel Economy
śElapsed Time
Digital Speedometer
OQX069060L
To change the trip mode, toggle the “
” switch on the steering wheel.
,
Automatic reset
To automatically reset the average fuel
economy after refueling, select the "Fuel
Econ. Reset" mode in the User Settings
menu on the LCD display.
- After Ignition: When the engine has
been OFF for 4 hours or longer the
average fuel economy will reset
automatically.
- After Refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically after
adding 1.6 gallons (6 liters) of fuel or
more and after driving speed exceeds
1 mph (1 km/h).
4-31
Instrument Cluster
Information
Information
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum
of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the last
ignition key cycle before the average fuel
economy will be recalculated.
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum
of 300 meters (0.19 miles) since the last
ignition key cycle before the average fuel
economy will be recalculated.
Instant Fuel Economy (2)
The instantaneous fuel economy is
displayed according to the bar graph in
the LCD display while driving.
Drive Info Display
Accumulated Info Display
OPD047468N
OPD047466N
This display shows the accumulated trip
distance (1), the average fuel economy
(2), and the total driving time (3).
The information is accumulated starting
from the last reset.
To reset the information, press and
hold the OK button when viewing the
Accumulated driving info. The trip
distance, the average fuel economy,
and total driving time will reset
simultaneously.
The accumulated driving information will
continue to be counted while the engine
is still running (EX: when the vehicle is in
traffic or stopped at a stop light).
4-32
This display shows the trip distance (1),
the average fuel economy (2), and the
total driving time (3).
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the engine
has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the
Drive Info screen will reset.
To manually reset the information, press
and hold the OK button when viewing
the Drive Info. The trip distance, the
average fuel economy, and total driving
time will reset simultaneously.
The driving information will continue
to be counted while the engine is still
running (for example, when the vehicle is
in traffic or stopped at a stop light).
Information
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum
of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the last
ignition key cycle before the average fuel
economy will be recalculated.
04
Digital Speedometer
OPDE046145R
The digital speedometer display shows
the speed of the vehicle.
4-33
5. Convenience Features
Accessing Your Vehicle..................................................................................... 5-4
Remote Key...................................................................................................................5-4
Smart Key ...................................................................................................................... 5-7
Immobilizer System .................................................................................................... 5-11
Door Locks........................................................................................................ 5-12
Operating Door Locks from Outside the Vehicle ......................................................5-12
Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle .........................................................5-13
Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features...............................................................5-15
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks ...............................................................................5-15
Theft-Alarm System .........................................................................................5-16
Steering Wheel ................................................................................................. 5-17
Electric Power Steering (EPS).....................................................................................5-17
Tilt Steering / Telescope Steering ............................................................................. 5-18
Horn............................................................................................................................. 5-19
Mirrors ..............................................................................................................5-19
Inside Rearview Mirror ............................................................................................... 5-19
Side View Mirrors .......................................................................................................5-20
Windows ...........................................................................................................5-22
Power Windows .......................................................................................................... 5-23
Sunroof ............................................................................................................ 5-26
Sunshade .................................................................................................................... 5-27
Tilt Open/close ........................................................................................................... 5-27
Sunroof Opening and Closing ...................................................................................5-28
Automatic Reversal ....................................................................................................5-28
Front Lamps ................................................................................................................5-29
Sunroof Open Warning ..............................................................................................5-30
5
Exterior Features .............................................................................................. 5-31
Hood.............................................................................................................................5-31
Liftgate ........................................................................................................................ 5-32
Fuel Filler Door ...........................................................................................................5-34
Lighting............................................................................................................ 5-36
Exterior Lights ............................................................................................................5-36
Interior Lights .............................................................................................................5-42
Wipers and Washers ....................................................................................... 5-45
Windshield Wipers .....................................................................................................5-45
Windshield Washers .................................................................................................. 5-46
Rear Window Wiper and Washer ............................................................................. 5-46
Rear View Monitor System ............................................................................. 5-47
Manual Climate Control System ....................................................................5-48
Heating and Air Conditioning ................................................................................... 5-49
System Operation .......................................................................................................5-52
System Maintenance .................................................................................................5-54
Automatic Climate Control System ............................................................... 5-56
5
Automatic Temperature Control Mode ..................................................................... 5-57
Manual Temperature Control Mode ..........................................................................5-58
System Operation .......................................................................................................5-62
System Maintenance .................................................................................................5-63
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging .......................................................... 5-65
Rear Window Defroster..............................................................................................5-67
Storage Compartment....................................................................................5-68
Center Console Storage ............................................................................................ 5-68
Sliding Armrest .......................................................................................................... 5-68
Glove Box ................................................................................................................... 5-69
5. Convenience Features
Interior Features..............................................................................................5-69
Cup Holder................................................................................................................. 5-69
Sunvisor ......................................................................................................................5-70
Power Outlet ...............................................................................................................5-70
USB Charger ................................................................................................................5-71
Clock ........................................................................................................................... 5-72
Clothes Hanger........................................................................................................... 5-72
Floor Mat Anchor(s) .................................................................................................... 5-73
Luggage Net Holder ................................................................................................... 5-73
Cargo Area Cover ....................................................................................................... 5-74
Exterior Features ..............................................................................................5-75
Roof Side Rails ............................................................................................................ 5-75
Infotainment System .......................................................................................5-76
USB and IPod® Port .................................................................................................... 5-76
Antenna ....................................................................................................................... 5-76
Steering Wheel Audio Control ................................................................................... 5-77
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology Hands-Free .......................................................... 5-78
Audio (Display Audio) / Video / Navigation System (AVN) ...................................... 5-78
5
Convenience Features
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
Remote Key (if equipped)
WARNING
Do not leave the keys in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could place the
key in the ignition switch and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking Your Vehicle
OQX059138
Your HYUNDAI uses a remote key, which
you can use to lock or unlock the driver
and passenger doors or the rear liftgate.
(1) Door Lock
(2) Door Unlock
(3) Panic
Locking Your Vehicle
To lock your vehicle:
1. Make sure all doors, the engine hood
and the liftgate are closed.
2. Press the Door Lock button (1) on the
remote key to lock all doors.
3. If the Door Lock button (1) is pressed
once more within four seconds, the
horn will beep once and the hazard
warning lights will blink.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door lock
button inside the vehicle.
Information
After locking the doors, if you press the
Door Lock button again within four
seconds, the hazard warning lights will
blink and the horn will sound one time to
confirm that the doors are locked.
5-4
To unlock your vehicle:
1. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on
the remote key.
2. The driver’s door will unlock. The
hazard warning lights will blink two
times.
Two press unlock setting:
If you press the Door Unlock button
on the remote key again within
four seconds, then all the doors will
unlock.
Two press unlock setting can be
changed according to owner’s
preference in the cluster User Settings
mode or with the remote key.
śUser settings mode method:
Select or deselect the ‘Two Press
Unlock’ feature in the User Settings
mode on the cluster LCD display (User
6HWWLQJVƟ'RRUƟ7ZR3UHVV8QORFN
Information
After unlocking the doors, the doors will
automatically relock after 30 seconds
unless a door is opened.
05
Panic Button (3)
Press and hold the Panic button (3) for
more than one second. The horn sounds
and hazard warning lights flash for about
30 seconds.
To cancel the panic mode, press any
button on the remote key.
Start-up
For information, refer to the “Key
Ignition Switch” section in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the remote key:
ś Keep the remote key away from
water or any liquid and fire. Internal
circuits may malfunction if the inside
of the remote key gets damp (from
liquids or moisture) or if it is heated.
This can exclude the remote key from
being covered under warranty.
ś Avoid dropping or throwing the
remote key.
ś Protect the remote key from extreme
temperatures.
Mechanical Key
To unfold the mechanical key, press the
release button on the remote.
To return the key to its stored position,
press the release button and fold the key
back into the remote.
Remote Key Precautions
The remote key will not work if any of the
following occur:
ś The key is in the ignition switch.
ś You exceed the operating distance
limit (about 90 feet [30 m]).
ś The remote key battery is weak.
ś Other vehicles or objects may be
blocking the signal.
ś The weather is extremely cold.
ś The remote key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the remote key.
If the remote key does not work
correctly, open and close the door
with the mechanical key. If you have a
problem with the remote key contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the remote key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is specifically
relevant when the phone is active such
as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails.
When possible, avoid placing the remote
key and your mobile phone in the same
location such as a pants or jacket pocket
in order to avoid interference between
the two devices.
OQX059139
If the remote key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver’s door by using the mechanical
key.
5-5
Convenience Features
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
NOTICE
Keep the remote key away from
electromagnetic materials that block
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
Battery Replacement
OPD046002
If the remote key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and
gently pry open the cover.
2. Using a screw driver, remove the
battery cover.
3. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the battery cover and key
cover in the reverse order of removal.
If you suspect your remote key might
have sustained some damage, or you feel
your remote key is not working correctly
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human health.
Dispose of the battery according
to your local law(s) or regulation.
5-6
05
Smart Key (if equipped)
Information
The door handle button will only operate
when the smart key is within 28~40 inches
(0.7~1 m) from the outside door handle.
OQX059036L
Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key, which
you can use to lock or unlock the driver
and passenger doors or the rear liftgate.
1. Door Lock
2. Door Unlock
3. Remote start
4. Panic
Locking Your Vehicle
Note that you cannot lock your vehicle
using the door handle button if any of
the following occur:
ś The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
ś The Engine Start/Stop button is in
ACC or ON position.
ś Any of the doors are open except for
the liftgate.
WARNING
Do not leave the Smart Key in your
vehicle with unsupervised children.
Unattended children could press the
Engine Start/Stop button and may
operate power windows or other
controls, or even make the vehicle
move, which could result in serious
injury or death.
Unlocking Your Vehicle
OQX059038L
To lock your vehicle using the door
handle button or the Smart Key:
1. Close all doors, hood and liftgate.
2. Either press the door handle button or
press the Door Lock button (1) on the
smart key.
3. The hazard warning lights will blink
and the chime will sound once.
4. When the doors are locked, the
indicator light on the central door
lock/unlock switch will be illuminated.
OQX059038L
To unlock your vehicle:
1. Make sure you have the smart key in
your possession.
2. Press either the button on the door
handle or the Door Unock button (2)
on the smart key. The driver’s door will
unlock and the hazard warning lights
will blink two times.
5-7
Convenience Features
3. Two Press Unlock Feature
The priority for unlocking the driver
door only, or unlocking all the doors
with one press may be adjusted in the
User Settings menu in the LCD cluster
display.
The Two Press Unlock feature, when
enabled, will require the user to press
the door unlock button once for driver
door only and twice for unlocking all
the doors.
Select or Deselect the Two Press Unlock
Feature in the User Settings menu in the
LCD cluster display. The option can be
found under the following menu:
86(56(77,1*6Ɵ'225Ɵ7:235(66
UNLOCK
Information
ś The door handle buttons will only
operate when the smart key is within
28-40 inches (0.7~1m) from the outside
door handle
ś Either the driver or front passenger
door can be opened with the door
handle button when the smart key is
within this range
ś If you press the front passenger outside
door handle with the smart key in your
possession, all the doors will unlock
5-8
Remote Start (if equipped)
You can start the engine and turn on the
climate system by pressing the remote
start button (3) outside the vehicle.
To start and stop engine remotely:
1. Press the door lock button (1), and
then the hazard warning lights blink
once to alert you.
2. Press the Remote Start button (3)
for more than 2 seconds to start the
engine within 4 seconds after pressing
the door lock button (1).
3. While remote starting, the hazard
warning lights blink three times. If you
want to stop the engine, press the
Remote Start button (3) again.
The climate system will be continuously
maintained, as selected when the engine
is restarted. If the climate system is
turned off before you have stopped
the engine, the climate system does
not operate when you start the engine
remotely.
If someone without a designated smart
key drives your vehicle while remote
starting, the engine is automatically
stopped for security purposes.
Information
After remotely starting the engine, the
engine will turn off automatically after 10
minutes if you do not drive your vehicle.
05
CAUTION
Mechanical Key
ś The remote start will not work if you
exceed the operating distance limit
(about 10 m).
ś Avoid idling the engine for prolonged
periods to follow the emission
regulations in your country.
ś Laws in your country may restrict the
use of remote start. You should check
country regulations before using this
remote starting system.
ś It is only possible to start the engine
remotely when shifted to P (Park).
ś If the hood or the liftgate is opened,
you cannot start the engine
remotely.
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver’s door by using the mechanical
key.
Panic Button
To remove the mechanical key from the
smart key FOB, slide the release lever in
the direction of the arrow (1) and then
pull the mechanical key (2) outward.
To unlock the vehicle using the
mechanical key. insert the mechanical
key into the key hole in the driver door.
To reinstall the mechanical key into the
FOB, insert the key in the top of the key
FOB and push inward until a click sound
is heard.
Press and hold the Panic button (4) for
more than one second. The horn sounds
and hazard warning lights blink for about
30 seconds. To cancel the panic mode,
press any button on the Smart Key.
Start-up
You can start the vehicle without
inserting the key.
For information, refer to the “Engine
Start/Stop Button” section in chapter 6.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the smart key:
ś Keep the smart key in a cool,
dry place to avoid damage or
malfunction. Exposure to moisture
or high temperature may cause
the internal circuit of the smart key
to malfunction which may not be
covered under warranty.
ś Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
ś Protect the smart key from extreme
temperatures.
OPD046045
Loss of a Smart Key
A maximum of two Smart Keys can be
registered to a single vehicle. If you
happen to lose your smart key, you
should immediately take the vehicle
and remaining keys to your authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle, if
necessary.
5-9
Convenience Features
Smart Key Precautions
The smart key may not work if any of the
following occur:
ś The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station or
an airport which can interfere with
normal operation of the transmitter.
ś The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular phone.
ś Another vehicle’s smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
If the smart key does not work correctly,
open and close the door with the
mechanical key. If you have a problem
with the smart key, contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity to
your mobile phone, the signal could be
blocked by your mobile phone’s normal
operational signals. This is specifically
relevant when the phone is active such
as making and receiving calls, text
messaging, and/or sending/receiving
emails. When possible, avoid keeping the
smart key and your mobile phone in the
same location such as a pants or jacket
pocket in order to avoid interference
between the two devices.
NOTICE
Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that blocks
electromagnetic waves to the key
surface.
NOTICE
Always have the smart key with you
when leaving the vehicle. If the smart
key is left near the vehicle, the vehicle
battery may be discharged.
5-10
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
Battery Replacement
OQX059142N
If the Smart Key is not working properly,
try replacing the battery with a new one.
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Remove the mechanical key.
2. Use a slim tool to pry open the rear
cover of the smart key.
3. Remove the old battery and insert the
new battery. Make sure the battery
position is correct.
4. Reinstall the rear cover of the smart
key.
If you suspect your smart key might have
sustained some damage, or you feel
your smart key is not working correctly,
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
05
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human health.
Dispose of the battery according
to your local law(s) or regulation.
Immobilizer System
(if equipped)
The immobilizer system protects your
vehicle from theft. If an improperly
coded key (or other device) is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
When the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position, the immobilizer system
indicator should come on briefly, then
go off. If the indicator starts to blink, the
system does not recognize the coding of
the key.
Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF
position, then turn the ignition switch to
the ON position again.
In some circumstances, the vehicle may
not recognize your smart key if another
smart key device is nearby or a metal
object such as a key chain is causing
interference with the smart key.
If this occurs, your vehicle may not
start. Remove any metal objects or
additional keys near the smart key before
attempting to start the vehicle again.
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer
unique password and should be kept
confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give years
of trouble-free service, however you
should avoid exposure to moisture,
static electricity and rough handling.
Immobilizer system malfunction could
occur.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the device.
5-11
Convenience Features
DOOR LOCKS
Operating Door Locks from
Outside the Vehicle
Mechanical Key
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
Smart Key
OQX059037N
If you lock the driver’s door with a
mechanical key, all vehicle doors will
lock. If you unlock the driver’s door with
a mechanical key, you can open and
close the driver’s door only.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
OQX059038L
Remote Key
OQX059036N
[A]: Door Lock, [B]: Door Unlock
OQX059138N
To lock the doors, press the Door Lock
button (1) on the remote key.
Press the Door Unlock button (2) on the
remote key, the driver’s door will unlock.
If you press the Door Unlock button
on the remote key again within four
seconds, then all the doors will unlock.
5-12
Press the button on the driver’s outside
door handle while carrying the Smart Key
with you or press the Door Unlock button
on the Smart Key, the driver’s door will
unlock.
If you press the button on the front
passenger’s outside door, all doors will
unlock.
Once the doors are unlocked, they may
be opened by pulling the door handle.
When closing the door, push the door by
hand. Make sure that doors are closed
securely.
05
Information
ś In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
ś If the door is locked/unlocked multiple
times in rapid succession with either
the vehicle key or door lock switch, the
system may stop operating temporarily
in order to protect the circuit and
prevent damage to system components.
ś Two press unlock setting can be
changed in the User Settings mode on
the cluster.
Operating Door Locks from
Inside the Vehicle
With the Door Lock Button
OQXI049006
ś If the inner door handle of either
the driver door or passenger door
is pulled when the door lock button
is in the lock position, the button is
unlocked and the door will open.
ś For Key Start Vehicles (w/Remote Key)
The front doors cannot be locked if
the remote key is in the ignition switch
and either of the front doors are open.
ś For Push Button Start Vehicles (Smart
Key)
The doors cannot be locked if the
smart key fob is inside the vehicle and
any of the doors are open.
Information
If a power door lock ever fails to function
while you are in the vehicle try one or
more of the following techniques to exit:
ś Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and
manual) while simultaneously pulling
on the door handle.
ś Operate the other door locks and
handles, front and rear.
ś Lower a front window and use the
mechanical key to unlock the door from
outside.
ś To unlock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Unlock” position.
ś To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the “Lock” position.
ś To open a door, pull the door handle
(2) outward.
5-13
Convenience Features
With the Central Door Lock Switch
WARNING
Do not leave children or animals
unattended in your vehicle. An enclosed
vehicle can become extremely hot,
causing death or serious injury to
unattended children or animals who
cannot escape the vehicle. Children
might operate features of the vehicle
that could injure them, or they could
encounter other harm, possibly from
someone gaining entry to the vehicle.
OQX059035N
The driver side door armrest is equipped
with a central door lock switch. The lock
button is indicated by a ( ) symbol.
The unlock button is indicated by a ( )
symbol.
When the lock button (2) is pressed, all
the vehicle doors will lock.
When the unlock button (1) is pressed, all
the vehicle doors will unlock.
ś For Key Start Vehicles (with remote
key)
If the key is in the ignition switch and
any door is opened, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (2) is
pressed.
ś For Push Button Start Vehicles (Smart
Key)
If the smart key is in the vehicle and
any door is open, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (2) is
pressed.
WARNING
ś The doors should always be fully
closed and locked while the
vehicle is in motion. If the doors
are unlocked, the risk of being
thrown from the vehicle in a crash is
increased.
ś Do not pull the inner door handle of
the driver’s or passenger’s door while
the vehicle is moving.
5-14
WARNING
Always secure your vehicle.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked increases
the potential risk to you or others from
someone hiding in your vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while depressing
the brake, move the shift lever to the
P (Park) position, engage the parking
brake, and place the ignition switch
in the LOCK/OFF position, close all
windows, lock all doors, and always
take the key with you.
CAUTION
Opening a door when something is
approaching may cause damage or
injury. Be careful when opening doors
and watch for vehicles, motorcycles,
bicycles or pedestrians approaching the
vehicle in the path of the door.
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a long time
while the weather is very hot or cold,
there are risks of injuries or danger to
life. Do not lock the vehicle from the
outside when someone is in the vehicle.
05
Automatic Door Lock and Unlock
Features
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks
Your vehicle is equipped with features
that will automatically lock or unlock
your vehicle based on settings you select
in the LCD cluster display.
Auto LOCK - Enable on Speed
When this feature is set in the LCD
cluster display, all the doors will be
locked automatically when the vehicle
exceeds 9 mph (15 kph).
Auto LOCK - Enable on Shift
When this feature is set in the LCD
cluster display, all the doors will be
locked automatically when the vehicle is
shifted out of P (PARK) while the engine
is running.
Auto UNLOCK - Enable on Shift
When this feature is set in the LCD
cluster display, all the doors will be
unlocked automatically when the vehicle
is shifted back into P (PARK).
For more information on these features,
refer to the LCD Display section later in
this chapter.
Additional Unlock Safety Feature Air Bag Deployment
As an additional safety feature, all doors
will be automatically unlocked when an
impact causes the air bags to deploy.
OQXI049008
The child safety lock is provided to help
prevent children seated in the rear from
accidentally opening the rear doors. The
rear door safety locks should be used
whenever children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on the
edge of each rear door. When the child
safety lock is in the lock position, the
rear door will not open if the inner door
handle is pulled.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a
small flat blade tool (like a screwdriver or
similar) (1) into the slot and turn it to the
lock position as shown.
To allow a rear door to be opened from
inside the vehicle, unlock the child safety
lock.
WARNING
If children accidently open the rear
doors while the vehicle is in motion,
they could fall out of the vehicle. The
rear door safety locks should always
be used whenever children are in the
vehicle.
5-15
Convenience Features
7+()7ǘ$/$506<67(0
This system helps to protect your vehicle
and valuables. The horn will sound and
the hazard warning lights will blink
continuously if any of the following
occur:
- A door is opened without using the
remote key or smart key.
- The liftgate is opened without using
the remote key or smart key.
- The engine hood is opened.
The alarm continues for 30 seconds, then
the system resets. To turn off the alarm,
unlock the doors with the remote key or
smart key.
The Theft Alarm System automatically
sets 30 seconds after you lock the
doors and the liftgate. For the system to
activate, you must lock the doors and
the liftgate from outside the vehicle
with the remote key or smart key or by
pressing the button on the outside of the
door handle with the smart key in your
possession.
The hazard warning lights will blink and
the chime will sound once to indicate the
system is armed.
Once the security system is set, opening
any door, the liftgate, or the hood
without using the remote key or smart
key will cause the alarm to activate.
The Theft Alarm System will not set if the
hood, the liftgate, or any door is not fully
closed. If the system will not set, check
the hood, the liftgate, or the doors are
fully closed.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it.
5-16
Information
ś Do not lock the doors until all
passengers have left the vehicle. If the
remaining passenger leaves the vehicle
when the system is armed, the alarm
will be activated.
ś If the vehicle is not disarmed with the
remote key or smart key, open the
doors by using the mechanical key
and place the ignition switch in the
ON position (for remote key) or start
the engine (for smart key) by directly
pressing the ignition switch with the
smart key.
ś If the system is disarmed by unlocking
the vehicle, but neither a door or the
liftgate is opened within 30 seconds, the
doors will relock and the system will
rearm automatically.
05
STEERING WHEEL
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
The system assists you with steering the
vehicle. If the vehicle is turned off or
if the power steering system becomes
inoperative, you may still steer the
vehicle, but it will require increased
steering effort.
Also, the steering effort becomes heavier
as the vehicle’s speed increases and
becomes lighter as the vehicle’s speed
decreases for better control of the
steering wheel.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
CAUTION
ś If the Electric Power Steering System
does not operate normally, the
warning light ( ) will illuminate
on the instrument cluster. You may
steer the vehicle, but it will require
increased steering efforts. Take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
as soon as possible.
ś When an abnormality is detected
in the electric power steering
system, to prevent a an accident, the
steering assist function may become
inoperative. At this time, the warning
light turns on or blinks on the cluster.
The steering wheel may become
difficult to control or operate. Have
your vehicle checked immediately,
after moving the vehicle to a safe
area.
Information
The following symptoms may occur during
normal vehicle operation:
ś The steering effort may be high
immediately after placing the ignition
switch in the ON position.
This happens as the system performs
the EPS system diagnostics. When the
diagnostics are completed, the steering
wheel effort will return to its normal
condition.
ś When the battery voltage is low, you
might have to put more steering effort.
However, it is a temporary condition so
that it will return to normal condition
after charging the battery.
ś A click noise may be heard from the
EPS relay after the ignition switch is in
the ON or LOCK/OFF position.
ś Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at a stop or at a low driving
speed.
ś When you operate the steering wheel
in low temperatures, abnormal noise
may occur. If the temperature rises, the
noise will disappear. This is a normal
condition.
ś When an error is detected from the
EPS, the steering effort assist function
may become inoperative in order to
prevent fatal accidents. Instrument
cluster warning lights may be on or the
steering effort may be high. If these
symptoms occur, drive the vehicle to
a safe area as soon as it is safe to do
so. Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
5-17
Convenience Features
Tilt Steering / Telescope Steering
When adjusting the steering wheel to a
comfortable position, adjust the steering
wheel so that it points toward your chest,
not toward your face. Make sure you can
see the instrument cluster warning lights
and gauges. After locking the lever, push
the steering wheel both up and down to
be certain it is locked in position. Always
adjust the position of the steering wheel
before driving.
WARNING
NEVER adjust the steering wheel while
driving. This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
OQX069059L
To adjust the steering wheel angle and
height:
1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1).
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the
desired angle (2) and distance
forward/back (3).
3. Pull up the lock-release lever to lock
the steering wheel in place.
5-18
Information
Sometimes the lock release lever may not
engage completely. This may occur when
the gears of the locking mechanism do
not completely mesh. If this occurs, pull
down on the lockrelease lever, readjust the
steering wheel again, and then pull back
up on the release lever to lock the steering
wheel in place.
CAUTION
While adjusting the steering wheel
height, please do not push or pull it
hard since the fixture can be damaged.
05
0,55256
Horn
Inside Rearview Mirror
Before driving your vehicle, check to
see that your inside rearview mirror is
properly positioned. Adjust the rearview
mirror so that the view through the rear
window is properly centered.
WARNING
OQXI049023
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel (see illustration). The
horn will operate only when this area is
pressed.
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist. Do not
press on the horn with a sharp-pointed
object.
Make sure your line of sight is not
obstructed. Do not place objects in the
rear seat, cargo area, or behind the rear
head restraints which could interfere
with your vision through the rear
window.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during an
accident or deployment of the air bag,
do not modify the rearview mirror and
do not install a wide mirror.
WARNING
NEVER adjust the mirror while driving.
This may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
NOTICE
When cleaning the mirror, use a paper
towel or similar material dampened
with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass
cleaner directly on the mirror as this
may cause the liquid cleaner to enter
the mirror housing.
5-19
Convenience Features
Day/night Rearview Mirror
The right side view mirror is convex.
Objects seen in the mirror are closer than
they appear.
Use the inside rear view mirror or look
back directly to determine the actual
distance of other vehicles prior to
changing lanes.
WARNING
OQXI049024
[A] : Day/night lever, [B] : Day
Make this adjustment before you start
driving and while the day/night lever is in
the day position.
Pull the day/night lever towards you to
reduce glare from the headlamps of the
vehicles behind you during night driving.
Remember that you lose some rearview
clarity in the night position.
Side View Mirrors
OQX059147N
Make sure to adjust the side view mirrors
to your desired position before you begin
driving.
Your vehicle is equipped with both
left-hand and right-hand side view
mirrors. The mirrors can be adjusted
remotely with the remote switch. The
side view mirrors can be folded to help
prevent damage when going through
an automatic car wash or when passing
through a narrow street.
5-20
Do not adjust or fold the side view
mirrors while driving. This may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
NOTICE
ś Do not scrape ice off the mirror face;
this may damage the surface of the
glass.
ś If the mirror is jammed with ice, do
not adjust the mirror by force. Use an
approved spray de-icer (not radiator
antifreeze) spray, or a sponge or soft
cloth with very warm water, or move
the vehicle to a warm place and
allow the ice to melt.
05
Side View Mirror Adjustment
OQX059016N
Adjusting the side view mirrors:
1. Press either the L (driver’s side) or R
(passenger’s side) button (1) to select
the side view mirror you would like to
adjust.
2. Use the mirror adjustment control
switch to position the selected mirror
up, down, left or right.
3. After adjustment, put the button into
neutral (center) position to prevent
inadvertent adjustment.
Folding the side View Mirrors
OQXI049026
To fold the side view mirrors, grasp the
housing of the mirror and then fold it
inwards.
NOTICE
ś The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting
angles, but the motor continues to
operate while the switch is pressed.
Do not press the switch longer than
necessary, because this can damage
the motor.
ś Do not attempt to adjust the side
view mirrors by hand, because this
can damage the motor.
5-21
Convenience Features
WINDOWS
OQX059013N
(1) Driver’s door power window switch
(2) Front passenger’s door power
window switch
(3) Rear door (left) power window switch
(4) Rear door (right) power window
switch
5-22
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window
(7) Power window lock switch
05
Power Windows
The ignition switch must be in the
ON position to be able to raise or
lower the windows. Each door has a
Power Window switch to control that
door’s window. The driver has a Power
Window Lock switch which can block
the operation of passenger windows.
The power windows will operate for
approximately 30 seconds after the
ignition switch is placed in the ACC or
LOCK/OFF position. However, if the front
doors are opened, the Power Windows
will not operate even within the 30
second period.
WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death, do not
extend your head, arms or body outside
the windows while driving.
Information
ś In cold and wet climates, power
windows may not work properly due to
freezing conditions.
ś While driving with the rear windows
down or with the sunroof (if equipped)
opened (or partially opened), your
vehicle may demonstrate a wind
buffeting or pulsation noise. This
noise is normal and can be reduced
or eliminated by taking the following
actions. If the noise occurs with one
or both of the rear windows down,
partially lower both front windows
approximately one inch. If you
experience the noise with the sunroof
open, slightly close the sunroof.
Window Opening and Closing
OQX059133L
To open:
Press the window switch down to the
first detent position (5). Release the
switch when you want the window to
stop.
To close:
Pull the window switch up to the first
detent position (5). Release the window
switch when you want the window to
stop.
Auto Down Window (if equipped)
Pressing the power window switch
down momentarily to the second
detent position (6) completely lowers
the window even when the switch is
released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up or press down and
release the switch.
Auto Up/down Window (if
equipped)
Pressing or pulling up the power window
switch momentarily to the second
detent position (6) completely lowers or
lifts the window even when the switch
is released. To stop the window at the
desired position while the window is in
operation, pull up or press down and
release the switch.
5-23
Convenience Features
To Reset the Power Windows
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window
system must be reset as follows:
1. Place the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. Close the window and continue
pulling up on the power window
switch for at least one second.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
The automatic reverse feature doesn’t
activate while resetting the power
window system. Make sure body parts
or other objects are safely out of the
way before closing the windows to
avoid injuries or vehicle damage.
Automatic Reverse (if equipped)
OLF044032
If a window senses any obstacle while it
is closing automatically, it will stop and
lower approximately 12 inches (30 cm) to
allow the object to be cleared.
If the window detects the resistance
while the power window switch is
pulled up continuously, the window
will stop upward movement then lower
approximately 1 inch (2.5 cm).
If the power window switch is pulled
up continuously again within 5 seconds
after the window is lowered by the
automatic window reverse feature,
the automatic window reverse will not
operate.
Information
The automatic reverse feature is only
active when the “Auto Up” feature is used
by fully pulling up the switch to the second
detent.
WARNING
Make sure body parts or other objects
are safely out of the way before closing
the windows to avoid injuries or vehicle
damage.
Objects less than 0.16 inch (4 mm) in
diameter caught between the window
glass and the upper window channel
may not be detected by the automatic
reverse window and the window will
not stop and reverse direction.
5-24
05
NOTICE
Do not install any accessories on the
windows. The automatic reverse
feature may not operate.
Power Window Lock Switch
WARNING
Do not allow children to play with the
power windows. Keep the driver’s
door power window lock switch in the
LOCK position. Serious injury or death
can result from unintentional window
operation by a child.
NOTICE
OQX059017L
The driver can disable the power window
switches on the rear passenger doors by
pressing the power window lock switch.
When the power window lock switch is
pressed:
ś The rear passenger control will not
be able to operate the rear passenger
power window
ś Note that the front passenger control
is still able to operate the front
passenger window, and that the driver
master control can still operate all the
power windows.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
power window system, do not open
or close two windows or more at the
same time. This will also ensure the
longevity of the fuse.
ś Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver’s door and the
individual door window switch in
opposite directions at the same time.
If this is done, the window will stop
and cannot be opened or closed.
5-25
Convenience Features
681522)ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
If your vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, you can slide or tilt your sunroof
with the sunroof control switch located
on the overhead console.
Type A
WARNING
ś Never adjust the sunroof or sunshade
while driving. This could result in
loss of control and an accident that
may cause death, serious injury, or
property damage.
ś Do not extend your head, arms or
body outside the sunroof while
driving, to avoid serious injury.
ś Do not sit on the top of the vehicle. It
may cause injury or vehicle damage.
NOTICE
OQX059018L
Type B
OQX059075
The sunroof can only be operated when
the ignition switch or Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ON or START position.
The sunroof can be operated for
approximately 30 seconds after the
ignition switch or Engine Start/Stop
button is in the ACC or LOCK/OFF
position.
5-26
Do not operate the sunroof when roof
bars are installed on the vehicle or
when there is luggage on the roof.
05
Sunshade
Tilt Open/close
OCN7050029
Use the sunshade to block direct sunlight
coming through the sunroof glass.
Open or close the sunshade by hand.
Information
The sunshade opens automatically when
the sunroof glass is opened, but the
sunshade does not close automatically
when the sunroof glass is closed. Also, only
the sunshade cannot be closed when the
sunroof glass is opened.
NOTICE
Do not pull the sunshade up or down,
or apply excessive force as such action
may damage the sunshade or cause it
to malfunction.
OQX051201
ś Push the sunroof switch upward, the
sunroof glass tilts open.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward when
the sunroof glass is tilt opened, the
sunroof glass closes.
The sunroof glass tilts open or closes
while the switch is pushed.
Information
The sunroof glass cannot slide open and
tilt open at the same time. You cannot tilt
the sunroof glass open while the sunroof
glass is slide open. Also, you cannot slide
the sunroof glass open while the sunroof
is tilt open. Slide open or tilt open the
sunroof glass when the sunroof glass is
completely closed.
5-27
Convenience Features
Sunroof Opening and Closing
Automatic Reversal
OQX051200
ś Push the sunroof switch rearward,
the sunshade and sunroof glass slide
open.
Push the sunroof switch forward, only
the sunroof glass closes.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward or
rearward to the first detent position,
the sunroof glass moves until the
switch is released.
ś Push the sunroof switch forward
or rearward to the second detent
position, the sunroof glass operates
automatically (auto slide feature). To
stop the sunroof movement at any
point, push the sunroof switch in any
direction.
ś The sunroof glass stops halfway
(first detent position) before it is fully
opened. To fully open the sunroof
glass, push the sunroof switch
rearward once more. At this time, the
sunroof glass opens only while the
switch is pushed.
Information
To reduce wind noise while driving,
we recommend that you drive at the
recommended position (first detent
position) before the maximum slide open
position.
5-28
ODH043039
If the sunroof glass senses any obstacle
while it is closing automatically, it will
reverse direction then stop at a certain
position.
The auto reverse function may not
work if an object thin or soft is caught
between the sliding sunroof glass and
sunroof sash.
WARNING
ś Make sure heads, hands, arms or
any other body parts or objects are
out of the way before operating the
sunroof. Body parts or objects may
get caught causing injuries or vehicle
damage.
ś Never deliberately use your body
parts to test the automatic reversal
function. The sunroof glass may
reverse direction, but there is a risk
of injury.
05
NOTICE
ś Do not continue to push the sunroof
switch after the sunroof is fully
opened, closed, or tilted. Damage to
the sunroof motor could occur.
ś Continuous operations such as slide
open/close, tilt open/close, etc. may
cause the motor or sunroof system to
malfunction.
ś Regularly remove any accumulated
dust on the sunroof rail.
ś Dust accumulated between the
sunroof and roof panel can make
noise Open the sunroof and remove
dust regularly using a clean cloth.
ś Do not try to open the sunroof when
the temperature is below freezing
or when the sunroof is covered
with snow or ice. The sunroof may
not work properly and may break if
opened by force.
ś Do not open or drive with the sunroof
glass open immediately after rain or
washing the vehicle. Water may wet
the interior of the vehicle.
ś Do not extend any luggage outside
the sunroof while driving. Vehicle
damage may occur if the vehicle
suddenly stops.
WARNING
Do not extend your head, arms, body
parts or objects outside the sunroof
while driving. Injuries may occur if the
vehicle suddenly stops.
Front Lamps
Type A
OQX059018L
Type B
OQX059075
In some circumstances resetting the
sunroof operation may need to be
performed. Some instances where
resetting the sunroof may be required
include:
ś When the 12-volt battery is either
disconnected or discharged
ś When the sunroof fuse is replaced
ś If the sunroof one-touch AUTO OPEN/
CLOSE operation is not functioning
properly
5-29
Convenience Features
Sunroof resetting procedure:
1. It is recommended to perform the
reset procedure with the vehicle
engine running. Start the vehicle in P
(Park).
2. Make sure the sunroof glass is in the
fully closed position. If the sunroof
glass is open, push the switch forward
until the sunroof glass is fully closed.
3. Release the switch when the sunroof
glass is fully closed.
4. Push the switch forward until the
sunroof glass moves slightly. Then
release the switch.
5. Once again push and hold the sunroof
switch forward until the sunroof glass
slides open and close. Do not release
the switch until the operation is
completed.
If you release the switch during
operation, start the procedure again
from step 2.
Information
If the sunroof is not reset when the vehicle
battery is disconnected or discharged, or
the sunroof fuse is blown, the sunroof may
not operate normally.
5-30
Sunroof Open Warning
OQX049015L
If the driver turns off the engine when
the sunroof is not fully closed, the
warning chime will sound for several
seconds and the sunroof open warning
will appear on the cluster LCD display.
Close the sunroof securely when leaving
your vehicle.
CAUTION
Make sure the sunroof is closed fully
when leaving your vehicle. If the
sunroof is left open, rain or snow may
wet the interior of the vehicle. Also,
leaving the sunroof open when the
vehicle is unattended may invite theft.
05
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Hood
Opening the Hood
OQXI059023N
OQX059020L
1. Park the vehicle and set the parking
brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch the
hood. The hood should pop open
slightly.
4. Pull out the support rod and hold the
hood open with the support rod.
WARNING
The support rod must be inserted
completely into the hole provided
whenever you inspect the engine
compartment. This will prevent the
hood from becoming dislodged and
falling and causing potential injury.
Closing the Hood
OQX059080N
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise the
hood slightly, push up the secondary
latch (1) inside of the hood center and
lift the hood (2).
1. Before closing the hood, check in and
around the engine compartment to
ensure the following:
- Any tools or other loose objects are
removed from the engine room area
or hood opening area
- All glove, rags, or other combustible
material is removed from the engine
compartment
- All filler caps are tightly and
correctly installed
2. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 12 inches (30 cm) from
the closed position) and push down
to securely lock in place. Then double
check to be sure the hood is secure.
If the hood can be raised slightly, it is
not securely locked. Open it again and
close it with more force.
5-31
Convenience Features
Closing the Liftgate
WARNING
ś Before closing the hood, ensure
all obstructions are removed from
around the hood opening.
ś Always double check to be sure that
the hood is firmly latched before
driving away. Check there is no
hood open warning light or message
displayed on the instrument cluster.
Driving with the hood opened may
cause a total loss of visibility, which
might result in an accident.
ś Do not move the vehicle with the
hood in the raised position, as vision
is obstructed, which might result in
an accident, and the hood could fall
or be damaged.
Liftgate
OQX059148N
Lower the liftgate lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the liftgate lid is
securely fastened, always check by trying
to pull it up again without pressing the
liftgate handle button.
Information
Opening the Liftgate
In cold and wet climates, door lock and
door mechanisms may not work properly
due to freezing conditions.
WARNING
The liftgate swings upward. Make sure
no objects or people are near the rear of
the vehicle when opening the liftgate.
OQXI049009
Before attempting to open the liftgate,
make sure the vehicle is in PARK (P). To
open the liftgate, perform the following.
1. Unlock the vehicle using either the
remote key fob (Key Start vehicles),
the Smart Key (Push Button Start
vehicles), or the Unlock button on the
driver side armrest.
2. From outside the vehicle, press the
liftgate handle
5-32
NOTICE
Make certain that you close the liftgate
before driving your vehicle. Possible
damage may occur to the liftgate struts
and mounting hinges if the liftgate is
not closed prior to driving.
05
To unlock and open the liftgate manually
from inside the luggage compartment,
perform the following steps:
1. Insert the mechanical key from the
key fob or a small screwdriver into the
slot at the bottom of the liftgate inside
the luggage compartment.
2. Slide the key or screwdriver to the
right to engage the safety release
lever.
3. Push the liftgate outward and upward.
WARNING
OQX059134L
Do not hold on to or try to pull on
the liftgate strut. Be aware that the
deformation of the liftgate strut may
cause vehicle damage and risk of injury.
Emergency Liftgate Safety Release
WARNING
ś Be aware of the location of the
emergency liftgate safety release
lever in your vehicle and know how
to open the liftgate using the safety
release lever.
ś No one should be allowed to occupy
the luggage compartment of the
vehicle at any time. The luggage
compartment is a very dangerous
location in the event of a crash.
ś Use the release lever for emergencies
only. Use extreme caution, especially
while the vehicle is in motion.
OQX059135L
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emergency liftgate safety release lever
located on the bottom of the liftgate
inside the vehicle.
5-33
Convenience Features
Fuel Filler Door
Information
Opening the Fuel Filler Door
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break the
ice and release the door. Do not pry on the
door. If necessary, spray around the door
with an approved deicer fluid (do not use
radiator antifreeze) or move the vehicle to
a warm place and allow the ice to melt.
Closing the Fuel Filler Door
OQX059021L
The fuel filler door is opened from inside
the vehicle using the fuel filler door
release lever.
1. Turn the engine off. Locate the fuel
filler door release lever on the floor on
the left side of the driver seat.
2. Pull up on the release lever.
OQXI049021
3. Pull the fuel filler door (1) outward to
access the fuel tank cap.
4. To remove the fuel tank cap (2), turn
it counterclockwise. You may hear a
hissing noise as the pressure inside
the tank equalizes.
5. Place the cap on the fuel filler door.
5-34
1. To install the fuel tank cap, turn it
clockwise until it “clicks” one time.
2. Close the fuel filler door until it is
latched securely.
WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and
explosive. Failure to follow these
guidelines may result in SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
ś Read and follow all warnings posted
at the gas station.
ś Before refueling, note the location of
the Emergency Gasoline Shut-Off, if
available, at the gas station.
ś Before touching the fuel nozzle, you
should eliminate the potential buildup of static electricity by touching
a metal part of the vehicle, a safe
distance away from the fuel filler
neck, nozzle, or other gas source,
with your bare hand.
ś Do not use cellular phones while
refueling. Electric current and/or
electronic interference from cellular
phones can potentially ignite fuel
vapors and cause a fire.
05
ś Do not get back into a vehicle
once you have begun refueling.
You can generate a buildup of
static electricity by touching,
rubbing or sliding against any item
or fabric capable of producing
static electricity. Static electricity
discharge can ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire. If you must re-enter
the vehicle, you should once again
eliminate potentially dangerous
static electricity discharge by
touching a metal part of the vehicle,
away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle
or other gasoline source, with your
bare hand.
ś When using an approved portable
fuel container, be sure to place the
container on the ground prior to
refueling. Static electricity discharge
from the container can ignite fuel
vapors causing a fire.
Once refueling has begun, contact
between your bare hand and the
vehicle should be maintained until
the filling is complete.
ś Use only approved portable plastic
fuel containers designed to carry and
store gasoline.
ś When refueling, always move the
shift lever to the P (Park) position (for
Intelligent variable transmission),
set the parking brake, and place
the ignition switch to the LOCK/
OFF position. Sparks produced by
electrical components related to the
engine can ignite fuel vapors causing
a fire.
ś Do not use matches or a lighter and
do not smoke or leave a lit cigarette
in your vehicle while at a gas station,
especially during refueling.
ś Do not over-fill or top-off your
vehicle tank, which can cause
gasoline spillage.
ś If a fire breaks out during refueling,
leave the vicinity of the vehicle, and
immediately contact the manager
of the gas station and then contact
the local fire department. Follow any
safety instructions they provide.
ś If pressurized fuel sprays out, it can
cover your clothes or skin and thus
subject you to the risk of fire and
burns. Always remove the fuel cap
carefully and slowly. If the cap is
venting fuel or if you hear a hissing
sound, wait until the condition stops
before completely removing the cap.
ś Always check that the fuel cap is
installed securely to prevent fuel
spillage in the event of an accident.
Information
Make sure to refuel your vehicle according
to the “Fuel Requirements” suggested in
the Introduction chapter.
NOTICE
ś Do not spill fuel on the exterior
surfaces of the vehicle. Any type of
fuel spilled on painted surfaces may
damage the paint.
ś If the fuel filler cap requires
replacement, use only a genuine
HYUNDAI cap or the equivalent
specified for your vehicle. An
incorrect fuel filler cap can result
in a serious malfunction of the fuel
system or emission control system.
5-35
Convenience Features
LIGHTING
Exterior Lights
Lighting Control
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of the
following positions:
OOS047404N
1.
2.
3.
4.
OFF position
AUTO headlamp position
Parking lamp position
Headlamp position
Cornering lamp (if equipped)
While driving a corner, for greater
visibility and safety, either the left or
right side cornering lamp will turn on
automatically. The cornering lamp
will turn on when one of the following
conditions occur.
ś Vehicle speed is less than 6 mph (10
km/h) and steering wheel angle is
turned approximately 80 degrees with
the low beam on.
ś Vehicle speed is between 6 mph
(10 km/h) to 56 mph (90 km/h)
and steering wheel angle is turned
approximately 35 degrees with the
low beam on.
ś When the vehicle is in reverse with
one of the conditions above satisfied,
the light opposite to the direction the
steering wheel is turned will turn on.
Daytime running light (DRL) (if equipped)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can
make it easier for others to see the front
of your vehicle during the day, especially
after dawn and before sunset.
The DRL system will turn the dedicated
lamp OFF when:
ś The headlamps are ON.
ś The parking lamps are ON.
ś The vehicle is turned off.
ś The parking brake is engaged.
5-36
OQX049021L
AUTO headlamp position (if equipped)
The parking lamp and headlamp will
be turned ON or OFF automatically
depending on the amount of daylight as
measured by the ambient light sensor on
the center dash (1).
Even with the AUTO headlamp feature
in operation, it is recommended to
manually turn ON the headlamps when
driving at night or in a fog, driving in the
rain, or when you enter dark areas, such
as tunnels and parking facilities.
05
NOTICE
ś Do not cover or spill anything on
the sensor (1) located in front of the
instrument panel.
ś Do not clean the sensor using
a window cleaner, the cleanser
may leave a light film which could
interfere with sensor operation.
ś If your vehicle has window tint or
other types of metallic coating on
the front windshield, the AUTO
headlamp system may not work
properly.
Information
The ignition switch must be in the ON
position to turn on the headlamp.
High Beam Operation
OIG046415
OIG046412
Parking lamp position (
)
The parking lamp, license plate lamp and
instrument panel lamp are turned ON.
To turn on the high beam headlamp,
push the lever away from you. The lever
will return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light when
the headlamp high beams are switched
on.
To turn off the high beam headlamp, pull
the lever towards you. The low beams
will turn on.
WARNING
Do not use high beam when there are
other vehicles approaching you. Using
high beam could obstruct the other
driver’s vision.
OIG046413
Headlamp position ( )
The headlamp, parking lamp, license
plate lamp and instrument panel lamp
are turned ON.
5-37
Convenience Features
OIG046414
To flash the high beam headlamp, pull
the lever towards you, then release the
lever. The high beams will remain ON as
long as you hold the lever towards you.
High Beam Assist (HBA) (if equipped)
OOS047409N
High Beam Assist (HBA) is a system that
automatically adjusts the headlamp
range (switches between high beam and
low beam) according to the brightness of
other vehicles and road conditions.
5-38
Operating condition
1. Place the headlamp switch in the
AUTO position.
2. Turn on the high beam by pushing the
lever away from you.
The High Beam Assist ( ) indicator
will illuminate.
3. High Beam Assist system will turn on
when vehicle speed is above 25 mph
(40 km/h).
śIf the headlamp switch is pushed
away when the High Beam Assist
system is operating, High Beam
Assist system will turn off and the
high beam will be on continuously.
śIf the headlamp switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam
is OFF, the high beam will turn ON
without High Beam Assist system
canceled. When you let go of the
light switch, the lever will move to
the middle and the high beam will
turn OFF.
śIf the headlamp switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam is
on by High Beam Assist system, the
low beam will be on and the High
Beam Assist system will turn OFF.
śIf the headlamp switch is placed
to the headlamp ON position,
High Beam Assist system will turn
off and the low beam will be on
continuously.
05
When High Beam Assist system is
operating, the high beam switches to low
beamif any of the following conditions
occur:
- When the headlamp of an on-coming
vehicle is detected.
- When the tail lamp of a vehicle in front
is detected.
- When the headlamp or tail lamp of a
motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.
- When the surrounding ambient light is
bright enough that high beams are not
required.
- When streetlights or other lights are
detected.
- When the headlamp switch is not in
the AUTO position.
- When High Beam Assist system is off.
- When vehicle speed is below 22MPH
(35 km/h).
OIK047132N
Warning light and message
When High Beam Assist system is not
working properly, the Check High Beam
Assist warning message will come on
for a few second. After the message
disappears, the master warning light ( )
will illuminate. Take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked.
CAUTION
The system may not operate normally if
any of the following conditions should
occur:
1. When the illumination from an oncoming vehicle or a vehicle in front is
dim. Such examples may include:
śWhen the headlamps of an oncoming vehicle or the tail lamps of
a vehicle in front is covered with
dust, snow, or water.
śWhen the headlamps on an oncoming vehicle are OFF, but the
fog lamps are ON.
5-39
Convenience Features
2. When the High Beam Assist camera
is adversely affected by an external
condition. Such examples may
include:
śWhen the vehicle’s headlamps
have been damaged or not
repaired properly.
śWhen the vehicle headlamps are
not aimed properly.
śWhen the vehicle is driven on a
narrow curved road or rough road
śWhen the vehicle is driven on an
uphill road or downhill road
śWhen only part of the vehicle in
front is visible on a crossroad or
curved road.
śWhen there is a traffic light,
reflecting sign, flashing sign or
mirror.
śWhen the road conditions are bad
such as being wet or covered with
snow.
śWhen a vehicle suddenly appears
from a curve.
śWhen the vehicle is tilted from a
flat tire or being towed.
śWhen the Lane Keeping Assist
system warning light illuminates.
śWhen the light from the on-coming
or front vehicle is not detected
because of exhaust fume, smoke,
fog, snow, etc.
śWhen the front window is covered
with foreign matters such as ice,
dust, fog, or is damaged.
3. When the forward visibility is poor.
Such examples may include:
śWhen the headlamps of an oncoming vehicle or a vehicle in front
is not detected due to poor outside
visibility (smog, smoke, dust, fog,
heavy rain, snow, etc.).
śWhen the windshield visibility is
poor.
5-40
WARNING
ś Do not attempt to disassemble
the front view camera without the
assistance of an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer technician. If the front camera
is removed for any reason, the
system may need to be re-calibrated.
Have the system inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś If the windshield of your vehicle is
replaced, most likely the front view
camera will need to be re-calibrated.
If this occurs, have your vehicle
inspected and have the system recalibrated by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Be careful that water doesn’t get into
High Beam Assist unit and do not
remove or damage related parts of
High Beam Assist system.
ś Do not place objects on the crash
pad that reflect light such as mirrors,
white paper, etc. The system may
malfunction if sunlight is reflected.
ś At times, High Beam Assist system
may not work properly. The system
is for your convenience only. It is the
responsibility of the driver for safe
driving practices and always check
the road conditions for your safety.
ś When the system does not operate
normally, change the headlamp
position manually between the high
beam and low beam.
05
Turn Signals And Lane Change
Signals
OIG046417
To signal a turn, push down on the lever
for a left turn or up for a right turn in
position (A).
If an indicator stays on and does not flash
or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn
signal bulbs may be burned out and will
require replacement.
Onetouch turn signal function
To activate the One Touch Turn Signal
function, push the turn signal lever up or
down to position (B) and then release it.
The lane change signals will blink 3, 5 or
7 times.
You can activate or deactivate the One
Touch Turn Signal function or choose
the number of blinks (3, 5, or 7) from the
User Settings mode in the LCD display.
For more information, refer to the “LCD
Display” section in this chapter.
Battery Saver Function
The purpose of this feature is to prevent
the battery from being discharged.
The system automatically turns off the
parking lamp when the driver turns the
vehicle off and opens the driver-side
door.
With this feature, the parking lamps will
turn off automatically if the driver parks
on the side of road at night.
However, the position lamps stay ON
even when the driver-side door is opened
if the headlamp switch is turned to the
position lamp OFF or AUTO position after
the engine is turned off.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on
turn the position lamps OFF and ON
again using the headlamp switch on
the steering column after the engine is
turned off.
Headlamp Delay Function
If the key is removed from the ignition
switch or placed in the ACC position
or the LOCK/OFF position with the
headlamps ON, the headlamps (and/
or parking lamps) remain on for about
5 minutes. However, if the driver’s door
is opened and closed, the headlamps
are turned off after 15 seconds. Also,
with the engine off if the driver’s door is
opened and closed, the headlamps (and/
or parking lamps) are turned off after 15
seconds.
The headlamps (and/or parking lamps)
can be turned off by pressing the lock
button on the remote key or smart key
twice or turning the headlamp switch to
the OFF or AUTO position.
You can activate or deactivate the
Headlamp Delay function from the User
Settings Mode in the LCD display.
For more information, refer to the “LCD
Display” section in this chapter.
5-41
Convenience Features
NOTICE
Front Lamps
If the driver exits the vehicle through
another door besides the driver
door, the battery saver function
does not operate and the headlamp
delay function does not turn OFF
automatically.
This may cause the battery to
discharge. To avoid battery discharge,
turn OFF the headlamps manually from
the headlamp switch before exiting the
vehicle.
Type A
Interior Lights
Type B
OQX059041L
WARNING
Do not use the interior lights when
driving in the dark. The interior lights
may obscure your view and cause an
accident.
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the vehicle is
turned off or the battery will discharge.
Interior Lamp AUTO Cut
The interior lamps will automatically go
off approximately 20 minutes after the
engine is turned off and the doors are
closed. If a door is opened, the lamp
will go off 40 minutes after the engine is
turned off. If the doors are locked by the
remote key or smart key and the vehicle
enters the armed stage of the theft
alarm system, the lamps will go off five
seconds later.
5-42
OQX059023L
Front Map Lamp (1):
Press either lenses to turn the map lamp
on or off. This light produces a spot
beam for convenient use as a map lamp
at night or as a personal lamp for the
driver and the front passenger.
05
Front Door Lamp (2) (
):
The front or rear room lamps come on
when the front or rear doors are opened
if the engine is running or not. When
doors are unlocked by the remote key or
smart key, the front and rear lamps come
on for approximately 30 seconds as long
as any door is not opened. The front and
rear room lamps go out gradually after
approximately 30 seconds when the door
is closed. However, if the ignition switch
is in the ON position or all doors are
locked, the front and rear lamps will turn
off. If a door is opened with the ignition
switch in the ACC position or the OFF
position, the front and rear lamps stay on
for about 20 minutes.
Front room lamp
(3):
ś
Press the button to turn ON the room
lamp for the front/rear seats.
(4):
ś
Press the button to turn OFF the
room lamp for the front/rear seats
regardless of front or rear door open
position.
Rear Lamp
Type A
OOS047321
Type B
OQX059024L
Rear Room Lamp (
):
Press this switch to turn the rear room
lamp on and off.
5-43
Convenience Features
(1): The room lamp for the rear seats
is automatically turned ON for
approximately 30 seconds,
when a door is opened.
The room lamp for the rear
seats is automatically turned ON
for approximately 15 seconds,
when the remote key (smart
key) unlocks the doors. The
room lamp fades out, when the
ignition switch is placed to the
ON position in 15 seconds. The
room lamp remains ON up to 20
minutes, when a door is opened
with the ignition switch in the
either the ACC or OFF position.
(2): With the Rear Room Lamp in
this position, the rear room lamp
remain on at all times.
(3): With the Rear Room Lamp in
this position the rear room lamp
remain off at all times.
NOTICE
Do not leave the lamp switches on for
an extended period of time when the
engine is turned off.
Luggage Compartment Lamp
OQX059025L
The luggage compartment lamp comes
on when the liftgate is opened.
NOTICE
The luggage compartment lamp comes
on as long as the liftgate is open.To
prevent unnecessary battery system
drain, close the liftgate securely after
using the luggage compartment.
Vanity Mirror Lamp
OQX059001L
Push the switch to turn the light on or off.
: The lamp will turn on if this
ś
button is pressed.
: The lamp will turn off if this
ś
button is pressed.
NOTICE
5-44
Always have the switch in the off
position when the vanity mirror lamp
is not in use. If the sunvisor is closed
without the lamp off, it may discharge
the battery or damage the sunvisor.
05
:,3(56$1':$6+(56
Windshield Wipers
Front windshield wiper/washer
OTLE045161
Rear windshield wiper/washer
Operates as follows when the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
MIST: For a single wiping cycle, push
the lever upward and release. The
wipers will operate continuously if
the lever is held in this position.
OFF: Wiper is not in operation.
INT: Wiper operates intermittently at
the same wiping intervals. To vary
the speed setting, move the speed
control lever. The top most setting
will run the wipers most frequently
(for more rain). The bottom setting
will run the wipers the least
frequently (for less rain).
LO: The wiper runs at a lower speed.
HI: The wiper runs at a higher speed.
Information
OTLE045508
A. Wiper speed control
śMIST – Single wipe
śOFF – Off
śINT – Intermittent wipe
śLO– Low wiper speed
śHI – High wiper speed
B. Intermittent control wipe time
adjustment
C. Wash with brief wipes
(pull lever towards you)
D. Rear wiper/washer control
śHI – High wiper speed
śLO – Low wiper speed
śOFF – Off
E. Wash with brief wipes (rear)
(push lever away from you)
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or until
the snow and/or ice is removed before
using the windshield wipers to ensure
proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or ice
before using the wiper and washer, it may
damage the wiper and washer system.
5-45
Convenience Features
Windshield Washers
Rear Window Wiper and Washer
OTLE045164
In the OFF position, pull the lever gently
toward you to spray washer fluid on the
windshield and to run the wipers 1-3
cycles. The spray and wiper operation
will continue until you release the lever. If
the washer does not work, you may need
to add washer fluid to the washer fluid
reservoir.
OTLE045165
The rear window wiper and washer
switch is located at the end of the wiper
and washer switch lever. Turn the switch
to the desired position to operate the
rear wiper and washer.
HI – High wiper speed
LO – Low wiper speed
OFF – Off
WARNING
When the outside temperature is below
freezing, ALWAYS warm the windshield
using the defroster to help prevent
the washer fluid from freezing on the
windshield and obscuring your vision
which could result in an accident and
serious injury or death.
NOTICE
ś To prevent possible damage to the
washer pump, do not operate the
washer when the fluid reservoir is
empty.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
wipers or windshield, do not operate
the wipers when the windshield is
dry.
ś To prevent damage to the wiper
arms and other components, do
not attempt to move the wipers
manually.
ś To prevent possible damage to the
wipers and washer system, use antifreezing washer fluids in the winter
season or cold weather.
5-46
OTLE045166
Push the lever away from you to spray
rear washer fluid and to run the rear
wipers 1~3 cycles. The spray and wiper
operation will continue until you release
the lever.
Auto Rear Wiper
The rear wiper will operate while the
vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper
ON by selecting the function on the LCD
display.
*RWRœ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ&RQYHQLHQFHƟ
Auto Rear Wiper (in R)’.
05
5($59,(:021,7256<67(0
WARNING
OQX051204
ś Never rely solely on the Rear View
Monitor when backing up.
ś ALWAYS look around your vehicle
to make sure there are no objects or
obstacles before moving the vehicle
in any direction to prevent a collision.
ś Always pay close attention when the
vehicle is driven close to objects,
particularly pedestrians, and
especially children.
NOTICE
OQX059082L
The Rear View Monitor will activate when
the engine is running and the shift lever
is in the R (Reverse) position.
This is a supplemental system that helps
provide a view of the area behind the
vehicle through the audio display while
the vehicle is in the R (Reverse) position.
ś Do not spray the camera or its
surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Shock applied from
high pressure water may cause the
device not to operate normally.
ś Do not use any cleanser containing
acid or alkaline detergents when
cleaning the lens. Use only a mild
soap or neutral detergent, and rinse
thoroughly with water.
ś Always keep the camera lens clean.
The camera may not work normally
if the lens is covered with dirt, water
or snow.
WARNING
The Rear View Monitor is not a safety
device. It only serves to assist the driver
in identifying objects directly behind
the middle of the vehicle. The camera
does NOT cover the complete area
behind the vehicle.
5-47
Convenience Features
0$18$/&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OQX059100L
1.
2.
3.
4.
Mode selection knob
Fan speed control knob
Temperature control knob
Air intake control button
(recirculated air position or outside
(fresh) air position)
5-48
5. Rear window defroster button
(if equipped)
6. A/C (Air conditioning) button
05
Heating and Air Conditioning
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select the mode
according to the following:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode or recirculation mode position.
5. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the
air conditioning system on.
Mode Selection (1)
OQX051156
The mode selection knob controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation
system. Air can be directed to the floor, dashboard outlets, or windshield. Five symbols
are used to represent Face, Bi-Level, Floor, Floor-Defrost and Defrost air position.
5-49
Convenience Features
Face-Level (B, D)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor-Level (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and side
window defrosters.
Floor & Defrost (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Defrost-Level (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
5-50
OQX059102L
MAX A/C-Level (B, D)
The MAX A/C mode is used to cool the
inside of the vehicle faster. Air flow is
directed toward the upper body and
face.
In this mode, the A/C button and the
Recirculation mode button cannot be
selected. Turn the fan speed mode to
adjust.
After the interior cabin has cooled
sufficiently, move the temperature knob
away from the MAX A/C setting and
adjust the knob to the desired position.
If you wish to continue using A/C
ON, make sure the A/C button LED is
illuminated.
05
Instrument Panel Vents
Air Intake Control (4)
OQX059103L
The instrument panel vent air flow can be
directed up/down or left/right using the
vent adjustment lever.
The air flow can also be CLOSED
using the vent adjustment lever. The
instrument panel air vents are the “clickto-close” type.
To CLOSE the instrument panel vents
perform the following:
- For the driver side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the left until
it clicks.
- For the passenger side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the right until
it clicks.
Temperature Control (3)
OQXI049309
The air intake control button is used to
select either Fresh mode (outside air) or
Recirculation mode (cabin air).
Recirculation mode
When Recirculation mode
is selected, air from the
passenger compartment will
be recirculated through the
system and heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
Fresh mode
When Fresh mode is selected,
air enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
Information
OQX059102L
The temperature will increase by turning
the knob to the right.
The temperature will decrease by turning
the knob to the left.
Using the system primarily in Fresh mode
and Recirculation mode only when needed
is recommended for best results.
Prolonged operation of the heater in
Recirculation mode and without the A/C
ON can cause fogging of the windshield.
In addition, prolonged use of the A/C
ON in Recirculation mode may result in
excessively dry, dehumidified air in the
cabin.
5-51
Convenience Features
NOTICE
WARNING
ś Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode for a prolonged period of
time may cause drowsiness to the
occupants in the cabin. This may lead
to loss of vehicle control which may
lead to an accident.
ś Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode with the A/C OFF may allow
humidity to increase inside the
cabin. This may cause condensation
to accumulate on the windshield and
obscure visibility.
ś Do not sleep in your vehicle or
remain parked in your vehicle with
the windows up and either the
heater or the air conditioning ON for
prolonged periods of time. Doing so
may increase the levels of carbon
dioxide in the cabin which may lead
to serious injury or death.
Operating the fan speed when the
ignition switch is in the ON position
could cause the battery to discharge.
Operate the fan speed when the engine
is running.
Fan Speed Control (2)
Cooling / Ventilation
Air Conditioning (6)
OQX059104L
Push the A/C button to turn the system
on (indicator light will illuminate) and off.
System Operation
1. Select the Face Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
OQXI049310
Turn the knob to the right to increase
the fan speed and airflow. Turn the knob
to the left to decrease fan speed and
airflow.
Setting the fan speed control knob to the
“0” position turns off the fan.
5-52
05
Heating
Air Conditioning
1. Select the Floor Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning ON
with the temperature control knob set
to heat in order to dehumidify the air
before it enters into the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the Floor
mode or press the Front
& Defrost
mode.
Defrost
Your HYUNDAI vehicle air conditioning
system is filled with R-134a refrigerant.
1. Start the engine.
2. Press the air conditioning button.
3. Set the mode to the Face Level
mode.
4. Set the air intake control to
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly. When
the desired temperature in the cabin
is reached, change the air intake
control back to Fresh mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
When maximum cooling is desired, set
the temperature control to the MAX A/C
position, then set the fan speed control
to the highest setting.
Operation Tips
ś To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the vehicle through the
ventilation system, temporarily set
the air intake control to recirculation
mode. Return the control to Fresh
mode when the unpleasant air outside
has diminished. This will help keep the
driver alert and comfortable.
ś To help prevent the inside of the
windshield from fogging, set the air
intake control to fresh mode and fan
speed to the desired position, turn
on the air conditioning system, and
adjust the temperature control to the
desired temperature.
NOTICE
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the engine temperature gauge
closely while driving up hills or in heavy
traffic when outside temperatures are
high. Air conditioning system operation
when climbing a steep grade or in high
outside ambient temperatures can
cause engine overheating.
Continue to use the fan, but turn the air
conditioning system off if the engine
temperature gauge indicates engine
overheating.
5-53
Convenience Features
Air conditioning system operation tips
ś If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
ś After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from the
recirculated air to the fresh outside air
position.
ś To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
ś Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system
performance.
ś If you operate air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield
to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In
this case, set the mode selection knob
position and fan
or button to the
speed control to the lower speed.
System Maintenance
Cabin Air Filter
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Cabin air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle through
the heating and air conditioning system.
Have the cabin air filter replaced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to
the maintenance schedule. If the vehicle
is being driven in severe conditions such
as dusty or rough roads, more frequent
cabin air filter inspections and changes
are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
the system should be checked at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Checking the Amount of Air
Conditioner Refrigerant and
Compressor Lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the
performance of the air conditioning
system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, have the system inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-54
05
NOTICE
Example
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
WARNING
OHCM059040
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Since the refrigerant is
operated at very high
pressure, the air conditioning
system should only be
serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
Each symbols and specification on
the air conditioning refrigerant label is
represented as below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of Compressor lubricant
4. Caution
5. Service manual
OQX089050N
Air conditioning refrigerant label
You can find out which air conditioning
refrigerant is applied to your vehicle on
the label located underside of the hood.
5-55
Convenience Features
$8720$7,&&/,0$7(&21752/6<67(0
OQX059105L
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Fan speed control knob
Temperature control knob
AUTO (automatic control) button
OFF button
Mode selection button
5-56
6. Recirculation mode/Fresh mode
7. Rear window defroster button
(if equipped)
8. Front windshield defroster button
9. A/C (Air conditioning) button
10. Climate control screen
05
Automatic Temperature Control
Mode
The Automatic Climate Control System
is controlled by setting the desired
temperature.
1. Press the AUTO button (3).
The modes, fan speeds, air intake and
air-conditioning will be controlled
automatically by the temperature
setting you select.
2. Turn the temperature control knob
(2) to the desired temperature. If
the temperature is set to the lowest
setting (Lo), the air conditioning
system will operate continuously.
After the interior has cooled
sufficiently, adjust the knob to
a higher temperature set point
whenever possible.
To turn the automatic operation off,
select any button of the following:
- Mode selection button
- Front windshield defroster button
(Press the button one more time
to deselect the front windshield
defroster function. The ‘AUTO’ sign
will illuminate on the information
display once again.)
- Fan speed control button
The selected function will be controlled
manually while other functions operate
automatically.
For your convenience and to improve the
efficiency of the climate control, use the
AUTO button and set the temperature to
72°F (22°C).
To change the temperature unit from °F
to °C or °C to °F:
Press and hold the AUTO and OFF
buttons on the climate control unit for 3
seconds.
OQX059097
NOTICE
Never place anything near the ambient
light/solar sensor to ensure better
control of the heating and cooling
system.
5-57
Convenience Features
Manual Temperature Control
Mode
The heating and cooling system can be
controlled manually by pushing buttons
other than the AUTO button. In this case,
the system works sequentially according
to the order of buttons selected.
When pressing any button except the
AUTO button while using automatic
operation, the functions not selected will
be controlled automatically.
1. Start the engine.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
To improve the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select the mode
according to the following:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
Set the air intake control to Fresh
mode position.
Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
If air conditioning is desired, turn the
air conditioning system on.
Press the AUTO button to convert to
full automatic control of the system.
Mode Selection (5)
OQX051156
5-58
05
The mode selection button controls
the direction of the air flow through the
ventilation system.
Instrument Panel Vents
The air flow outlet direction is cycled as
follows:
Face-Level (B, D)
OQX059103L
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each outlet
can be controlled to direct the air
discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D)
Air flow is directed towards the face and
the floor.
Floor & Defrost (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
The instrument panel vent air flow can be
directed up/down or left/right using the
vent adjustment lever.
The air flow can also be CLOSED
using the vent adjustment lever. The
instrument panel air vents are the “clickto-close” type.
To CLOSE the instrument panel vents
perform the following:
- For the driver side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the left until
it clicks.
- For the passenger side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the right until
it clicks.
Floor-Level (A, C, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and side
window defrosters.
Defrost-Level (A, D) (8)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
5-59
Convenience Features
Temperature Control (2)
Information
Using the system primarily in Fresh mode
and Recirculation mode only when needed
is recommended for best results.
Prolonged operation of the heater in
Recirculation mode and without the A/C
ON can cause fogging of the windshield.
In addition, prolonged use of the A/C
ON in Recirculation mode may result in
excessively dry, dehumidified air in the
cabin.
OQX059106L
Turn the knob to the right to increase the
temperature. Turn the knob to the left to
decrease temperature.
The temperature will increase or
decrease by 1°F/0.5°C for each
incremental location. When set to the
lowest temperature setting, the air
conditioning will operate continuously.
Air Intake Control (6)
The air intake control button is used to
select either Fresh mode (outside air) or
Recirculation mode (cabin air).
Recirculation mode
When Recirculation mode
is selected, air from the
passenger compartment will
be recirculated through the
system and heated or cooled
according to the function
selected
Fresh mode
When Fresh mode is selected,
air enters the vehicle from
outside and is heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
5-60
WARNING
ś Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode for a prolonged period of
time may cause drowsiness to the
occupants in the cabin. This may lead
to loss of vehicle control which may
lead to an accident.
ś Continued use of the climate control
system operation in Recirculation
mode with the A/C OFF may allow
humidity to increase inside the
cabin. This may cause condensation
to accumulate on the windshield and
obscure visibility.
ś Do not sleep in your vehicle or
remain parked in your vehicle with
the windows up and either the
heater or the air conditioning ON for
prolonged periods of time. Doing so
may increase the levels of carbon
dioxide in the cabin which may lead
to serious injury or death.
05
Fan Speed Control (1)
Air Conditioning (9)
OQX059117L
The fan speed can be set as desired by
pushing the fan speed control button.
More air is delivered with higher fan
speeds.
Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.
OQX059111L
Push the A/C button to manually turn the
system on (indicator light will illuminate)
and off.
OFF Mode (4)
Information
For better sound quality, fan speed may
automatically slow down for a couple
of minutes when you activate voice
recognition or hands free.
NOTICE
Operating the fan when the ignition
switch is in the ON position could cause
the battery to discharge. Operate the
fan when the engine is running.
OQX059110L
Push the OFF button to turn the climate
control system off. You can still operate
the mode and air intake buttons as
long as the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
5-61
Convenience Features
System Operation
Cooling / Ventilation
1. Select the Face Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
1. Select the Floor Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning ON
with the temperature control knob set
to heat in order to dehumidify the air
before it enters into the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the Floor
mode or press the Front
& Defrost
mode.
Defrost
Operation Tips
ś To keep dust or unpleasant fumes
from entering the car through the
ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculation
mode. Return the control to the to
Fresh mode when the unpleasant air
outside has diminished. This will help
keep the driver alert and comfortable.
ś To help prevent the inside of the
windshield from fogging, set the air
intake control to fresh mode and the
fan speed to the desired position, turn
on the air conditioning system, and
adjust the temperature control to the
desired temperature.
5-62
Air Conditioning
Your HYUNDAI vehicle air conditioning
system is filled with R-134a refrigerant.
1. Start the engine.
2. Press the air conditioning button.
3. Set the mode to the Face Level
mode.
4. Set the air intake control to
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly. When
the desired temperature in the cabin
is reached, change the air intake
control back to Fresh mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
When maximum cooling is desired, set
the temperature control to the MAX A/C
position, then set the fan speed control
to the highest setting.
NOTICE
When using the air conditioning system,
monitor the engine temperature gauge
closely while driving up hills or in heavy
traffic when outside temperatures.
Air conditioning system operation
when climbing a steep grade or in
high outside ambient temperatures
can cause engine overheating.
Continue to use the fan, but turn the air
conditioning system off if the engine
temperature gauge indicates engine
overheating.
05
Air conditioning system operation tips
ś If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
ś After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from the
recirculated air to the fresh outside air
position.
ś To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows
and sunroof closed.
ś Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system
performance.
ś If you operate air conditioner
excessively, the difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield
to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In
this case, set the mode selection knob
position and fan
or button to the
speed control to the lower speed.
System Maintenance
Cabin Air Filter
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Cabin air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle through
the heating and air conditioning system.
Have the The cabin air filter replaced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
according to the maintenance schedule.
If the vehicle is being driven in severe
conditions such as dusty or rough roads,
more frequent cabin air filter inspections
and changes are required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases,
the system should be checked at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-63
Convenience Features
Checking the Amount of Air
Conditioner Refrigerant and
Compressor Lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is low,
the performance of the air conditioning
is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the
performance of the air conditioning
system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, have the system inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
It is important that the correct type and
amount of oil and refrigerant is used.
Otherwise, damage to the compressor
and abnormal system operation may
occur. To prevent damage, the air
conditioning system in your vehicle
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
OQX089050N
Air conditioning refrigerant label
You can find out which air conditioning
refrigerant is applied to your vehicle on
the label located underside of the hood.
Example
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-134a
Since the refrigerant is
operated at very high
pressure, the air conditioning
system should only be
serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
All refrigerants should be reclaimed
with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to the
atmosphere is harmful to individuals
and environment. Failure to heed these
warnings can lead to serious injuries.
5-64
OHCM059040
Each symbols and specification on
the air conditioning refrigerant label is
represented as below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of Compressor lubricant
4. Caution
5. Service manual
05
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
WARNING
Windshield heating
or
position
Do not use the
during cooling operation in extremely
humid weather. The difference between
the temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause the
outer surface of the windshield to fog
up, causing loss of visibility could cause
an accident resulting in serious injury
or death. In this case, set the mode
selection knob or button to the
position and fan speed control knob or
button to a lower speed.
ś For maximum defrost performance,
set the temperature control knob
to the highest temperature setting
(rotated all the way to the right) and
the fan speed control to the highest
setting.
ś If warm air to the floor is desired while
defrosting or defogging, set the mode
to the floor-defrost position.
ś Before driving, clear all snow and ice
from the windshield, rear window,
side view mirrors, and all side
windows.
ś Clear all snow and ice from the
hood and air inlet in the cowl grill
to improve heater and defroster
efficiency and to reduce the
probability of fogging up the inside of
the windshield.
Manual Climate Control System
OQXI049321
To defog inside windshield
1. Select any fan speed except “0”
position.
2. Select the desired temperature.
3. Select the
or
position.
4. Fresh mode will be selected
automatically. Additionally, the
air conditioning will automatically
operate if the mode is selected to the
position.
Check to make sure the A/C is ON. If the
A/C ON LED is not illuminated, press
the A/C button once to turn the air
conditioner ON.
NOTICE
If you start the vehicle when the
weather is cold, more adequate way to
heat the cabin is described below.
1. Turn off or lower the blower, right
after engine starting, because
engine temperature is still low and
the air flow is cold.
2. After few minutes of engine warm
up, turn the blower to low to medium
speed and set the temperature
control to Hot.
5-65
Convenience Features
Check to make sure the air intake control
is in Fresh mode. If the air intake control
LED is illuminated, press the button once
to enable Fresh mode (LED OFF).
Check to make sure the air intake
control is in Fresh mode. If the air intake
control LED for Recirculation mode is
illuminated, press the button for Fresh
mode until its LED is not illuminated
(OFF).
position is selected, the fan
If the
speed is automatically increased.
OQXI049322
To defrost outside windshield
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
setting (knob rotated all the way to
the right).
2. Set the temperature control to the
highest temperature setting.
position.
3. Select the
4. Fresh mode (Recirculation OFF) and
A/C ON will automatically be selected.
Automatic Temperature Control
System (if equipped)
OQX059113L
To defog inside windshield
1. Select the desired fan speed.
2. Select the desired temperature.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. Fresh mode will be selected
automatically.
5-66
OQX059112L
To defrost outside windshield
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
(extreme right) position.
2. Set the temperature to the extreme
hot (HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button ( ).
4. The outside (fresh) air position will be
selected automatically.
position is selected, lower fan
If the
speed is adjusted to a higher fan speed.
05
Rear Window Defroster
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the rear window
defroster conducting elements bonded
to the inside surface of the rear window,
never use sharp instruments or window
cleaners containing abrasives to clean
the window.
If you want to defrost and defog
the front windshield, refer to the
“Windshield Defrosting and Defogging”
section in this chapter.
Manual climate control system
ś To activate the rear window defroster,
press the rear window defroster
button located in the center control
panel. The indicator on the rear
window defroster button illuminates
when the defroster is ON.
ś To turn off the defroster, press the rear
window defroster button again.
Information
ś If there is heavy accumulation of snow
on the rear window, brush it off before
operating the rear defroster.
ś The rear window defroster
automatically turns off after
approximately 20 minutes or when the
ignition switch is in the LOCK/OFF
position.
Side View Mirror Defroster
(if equipped)
OQX059114L
If your vehicle is equipped with the side
view mirror defrosters, they will operate
at the same time you turn on the rear
window defroster.
Automatic climate control system
OQX059115L
The defroster heats the window to
remove frost, fog and thin ice from the
interior and exterior of the rear window,
while the engine is running.
5-67
Convenience Features
6725$*(&203$570(17
Sliding Armrest (if equipped)
WARNING
Never store cigarette lighters, propane
cylinders, or other flammable/explosive
materials in the vehicle. These items
may catch fire and/or explode if the
vehicle is exposed to hot temperatures
for extended periods.
WARNING
ALWAYS keep the storage compartment
covers closed securely while driving.
Items inside your vehicle are moving as
fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the
items may fly out of the compartment
and may cause an injury if they strike
the driver or a passenger.
NOTICE
To avoid possible theft, do not leave
valuables in the storage compartments.
Center Console Storage
To move the armrest rearward:
Grab the front portion of the armrest (1)
then push the armrest rearward.
WARNING
Do not grab the front portion of the
armrest (1) when moving the armrest
rearward. You may pinch your fingers.
OQXI049052
To open:
Grab and hold the latch (1) on the arm
rest then lift the lid.
5-68
OQXI049053
To move the armrest forward:
Grab the front portion of the armrest (1)
then pull it forward.
05
INTERIOR FEATURES
Glove Box
Cup Holder
OQX051205
To open:
Pull the lever (1).
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box door after
use.
An open glove box door can cause
serious injury to the passenger in an
accident, even if the passenger is
wearing a seat belt.
OQX059009L
Cups or small beverages cups may be
placed in the cup holders.
WARNING
ś Avoid abrupt starting and braking
when the cup holder is in use to
prevent spilling your drink. If hot
liquid spills, you could be burned.
Such a burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Do not place uncovered or unsecured
cups, bottles, cans, etc., in the cup
holder containing hot liquid while
the vehicle is in motion. Injuries may
result in the event of a sudden stop
or collision.
ś Only use soft cups in the cup holders.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
WARNING
Keep cans or bottles out of direct sun
light and do not put them in a hot
vehicle. It may explode.
5-69
Convenience Features
NOTICE
Power Outlet
ś Keep your drinks sealed while driving
to prevent spilling your drink. If liquid
spills, it may get into the vehicle’s
electrical/electronic system and
damage electrical/electronic parts.
ś When cleaning spilled liquids do not
use hot air to blow out or dry the cup
holder. This may damage the interior.
Sunvisor
OQX050040N
The power outlet is designed to provide
power for mobile telephones or other
devices designed to operate with vehicle
electrical systems. The devices should
draw less than 180 W with the engine
running.
WARNING
OOS047062
To use the sunvisor, pull it downward.
To use the sunvisor to block the sun
from the side window, pull it downward,
release it from the bracket (1) and swing
it to the side (2) towards the window.
To use the vanity mirror, pull down the
sunvisor and slide the mirror cover (3).
Adjust the sunvisor forward or backward
(4) as needed (if equipped).
NOTICE
Close the vanity mirror cover securely
and return the sunvisor to its original
position after use.
WARNING
For your safety, do not block your view
when using the sunvisor.
NOTICE
Do not put several tickets in the ticket
holder at one time. This could cause
damage to the ticket holder.
5-70
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not place
your fingers or foreign objects (pin, etc.)
into a power outlet or touch the power
outlet with a wet hand.
05
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the Power
Outlets:
ś Use the power outlet only when the
engine is running and remove the
accessory plug after use. Using the
accessory plug for prolonged periods
of time with the engine off could
cause the battery to discharge.
ś Only use 12V electric accessories
which are less than 180 W in electric
capacity.
ś Adjust the air-conditioner or heater
to the lowest operating level when
using the power outlet.
ś Close the cover when not in use.
ś Some electronic devices can
cause electronic interference
when plugged into a vehicle’s
power outlet. These devices may
cause excessive audio static and
malfunctions in other electronic
systems or devices used in your
vehicle.
ś Push the plug in as far as it will go. If
good contact is not made, the plug
may overheat and the fuse may open.
ś Plug in battery equipped electrical/
electronic devices with reverse
current protection. The current
from the battery may flow into the
vehicle’s electrical/electronic system
and cause system malfunction.
USB Charger (if equipped)
OQX050010N
The USB charger is designed to recharge
batteries of small size electrical devices
using a USB cable.
The electrical devices can be recharged
when the ignition switch or the Engine
Start/Stop button is in the ACC, ON or
START position.
The battery charging state may be
monitored on the electrical device.
Disconnect the USB cable from the USB
port after use.
ś A smart phone or a tablet PC may
get warmer during the re-charging
process. It does not indicate any
malfunction with the charging system.
ś A smart phone or a tablet PC, which
adopts a different re-charging
method, may not be properly recharged. In this case, use an exclusive
charger of your device.
ś The charging terminal is only to
recharge a device. Do not use the
charging terminal either to turn ON an
audio or to play media on the AVN.
5-71
Convenience Features
Clock
Clothes Hanger
WARNING
Do not attempt to adjust the clock
while driving. Doing so may result in
distracted driving which may lead to
an accident involving personal injury or
death.
Vehicles with Audio System
Select the [SETUP] button on the audio
V\VWHPƟ6HOHFW>'DWH7LPH@
ś Set time: Set the time displayed on
the audio screen.
ś Time format: Choose between 12hour
and 24-hour time formats.
OTM048095
These hangers are not designed to hold
large or heavy items.
WARNING
Vehicles with Navigation System
Select the Settings menu on the
1DYLJDWLRQV\VWHPƟ6HOHFW>'DWH7LPH@
ś GPS time: Displays time according to
the received GNSS time.
ś 24-hour: Switches to 12 hour or 24
hour.
OQX059137L
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects except
clothes. Also, do not put heavy, sharp
or breakable objects in the clothes
pockets. In an accident or when the
curtain air bag is inflated, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal injury.
5-72
05
Floor Mat Anchor(s)
OQX059145N
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors to
attach the front floor mats to the vehicle.
The anchors on the front floor carpet
keep the floor mats from sliding forward.
ś Do not use ANY floor mat that cannot
be firmly attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchors.
ś Do not stack floor mats on top of one
another (e.g. all-weather rubber mat
on top of a carpeted floor mat). Only
a single floor mat should be installed
in each position.
IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver’s side floor
mat anchors that are designed to
securely hold the floor mat in place.
To avoid any interference with pedal
operation, HYUNDAI recommends that
the HYUNDAI floor mat designed for use
in your vehicle be installed.
Luggage Net Holder
WARNING
Do not overlay additional mats or liners
over the floor mats. If using All Weather
mats, remove the carpeted floor mats
before installing them. Only use floor
mats designed to connect to the
anchors.
WARNING
The following must be observed when
installing ANY floor mat to the vehicle.
ś Ensure to remove a protective
film attached on the carpet
before attaching a floor mat on
the front floor carpet. Otherwise,
the floor mat may move freely on
the protective film and it could
result in unintentional braking or
accelerating.
ś Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle’s
floor mat anchor(s) before driving
the vehicle.
OQX059045L
To keep items from shifting in the
luggage compartment, you can use the 4
holders located in the luggage board to
attach the luggage net.
Make sure the luggage net is securely
attached to the holders in the luggage
board.
5-73
Convenience Features
WARNING
WARNING
Avoid eye injury. DO NOT overstretch
the luggage net. ALWAYS keep your
face and body out of the luggage net’s
recoil path. DO NOT use the luggage net
when the strap has visible signs of wear
or damage.
Use the luggage net to keep only light
items from shifting in the luggage
compartment.
Cargo Area Cover
ś Do not place objects on the cargo
area cover while driving. Such
objects may be thrown about inside
the vehicle and possibly injure
vehicle occupants during an accident
or when braking.
ś Never allow anyone to ride in the
luggage compartment. It is designed
for luggage only.
ś Maintain balance of the vehicle and
locate the weight as far forward as
possible.
OQX059084L
Use the cover to hide items stored in
the cargo area. The cargo area cover
will lift when the liftgate is opened.
Disconnect the strap (1) from the holder
if you want to return the cover to the
original position. To remove the cargo
area cover completely, pull the cover
backward and out from the rail. To secure
a wider space, pull the cargo area cover
backward slightly and push down it.
NOTICE
Since the cargo area cover may be
damaged or deformed, do not put
luggage on it when it is being used.
5-74
OQX059153
ś Fully insert the hinges (A) on both
sides of the cargo area cover into
position (B). If not fully inserted, the
cargo area cover can be damaged.
05
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Roof Side Rails (if equipped)
WARNING
ś The following specification is the
maximum weight that can be loaded
onto the roof side rails. Distribute the
load as evenly as possible onto the
roof side rails and secure the load
firmly.
Loading cargo or luggage in excess
of the specified weight limit on the
roof side rails may damage your
vehicle.
OQXI049063
If your vehicle comes equipped with roof
side rails, then roof side rails crossbars
can be installed on top of your vehicle.
The roof side rails crossbars are an
accessory and are available at your local
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, be sure not to position cargo
onto the roof side rails in such a way
that it could interfere with sunroof
operation.
NOTICE
ś When carrying cargo on the roof side
rails, take the necessary precautions
to make sure the cargo does not
damage the roof of the vehicle.
ś When carrying large objects on the
roof side rails, make sure they do
not exceed the overall roof length or
width.
ROOF SIDE
RAILS
220 lbs. (100 kg) EVENLY
DISTRIBUTED
ś The vehicle center of gravity will be
higher when items are loaded onto
the roof side rails. Avoid sudden
starts, braking, sharp turns, abrupt
maneuvers or high speeds that may
result in loss of vehicle control or
rollover resulting in an accident.
ś Always drive slowly and turn corners
carefully when carrying items on the
roof side rails. Severe wind updrafts,
caused by passing vehicles or natural
causes, can cause sudden upward
pressure on items loaded on the
roof side rails. This is especially true
when carrying large, flat items such
as wood panels or mattresses. This
could cause the items to fall off the
roof side rails and cause damage to
your vehicle or others around you.
ś To prevent damage or loss of cargo
while driving, check frequently
before or while driving to make sure
the items on the roof side rails are
securely fastened.
5-75
Convenience Features
,1)27$,10(176<67(0
NOTICE
Antenna
ś If you install an aftermarket HID
head lamp, your vehicle’s audio and
electronic devices may not function
properly.
ś Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand
cleaner, and air freshener from
contacting the interior parts
because they may cause damage or
discoloration.
Shark Fin Antenna
USB and IPod® Port
OQXI049067
The shark fin antenna receives
transmitted data. (for example: AM/FM,
SXM, GPS, LTE)
OQX051206
You can use an USB cable to connect
audio devices to the vehicle USB port.
Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise may
occur during playback. If this happens,
use the portable audio device’s power
source.
à iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc.
5-76
05
Steering Wheel Audio Control
Type A
VOLUME (VOL + / -) (1)
ś Press the VOLUME switch up to
increase volume.
ś Press the VOLUME switch down to
decrease volume.
SEEK/PRESET (
OQXI049068L
Type B
OQXI049069L
Type C
/
) (2)
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down and held for 0.8 second or more,
it will function in the following modes:
ś RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK
select button. It will SEEK until you
release the button.
ś MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/RW button.
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up
or down, it will function in the following
modes:
ś RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION
UP/DOWN button.
ś MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/
DOWN button.
MODE (
) (3)
Press the MODE button to toggle
through Radio, SXM, or AUX modes.
MUTE (
OQX059012N
NOTICE
Do not operate multiple audio remote
control buttons simultaneously.
) (4)
ś Press the MUTE button to mute the
sound.
ś Press the MUTE button again to
activate the sound.
Information
Detailed information for audio control
buttons are described in a separately
supplied manual with the vehicle.
5-77
Convenience Features
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
Hands-Free
Audio (Display Audio) / Video /
Navigation System (AVN)
(if equipped)
Detailed information for the AVN system
is described in the Vehicle Infotainment
User’s Manual.
OQXI049071
With the Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
in the vehicle, you can use the phone
wireless.
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
Detailed information for the Bluetooth®
Wireless Technology hands-free is
described in the Vehicle Infotainment
User’s Manual.
5-78
6. While Driving
Before Driving ................................................................................................... 6-5
Before Entering the Vehicle .........................................................................................6-5
Before Starting .............................................................................................................6-5
Ignition Switch ..................................................................................................6-6
Key Ignition Switch...................................................................................................... 6-6
Engine Start/Stop Button ........................................................................................... 6-9
Manual Transmission ....................................................................................... 6-12
Manual Transmission Operation................................................................................ 6-12
Good Driving Practices .............................................................................................. 6-14
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) ...........................................................6-15
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) Operation.................................................... 6-15
Good Driving Practices .............................................................................................. 6-19
Brake System ................................................................................................... 6-20
Power Brakes ............................................................................................................. 6-20
Disc Brakes Wear Indicator....................................................................................... 6-20
Rear Drum Brakes ..................................................................................................... 6-20
Parking Brake .............................................................................................................. 6-21
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)....................................................................................6-22
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) .............................................................................6-24
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) .......................................................................6-26
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)................................................................................... 6-27
Good Braking Practices ............................................................................................. 6-27
Drive Mode Integrated Control System......................................................... 6-28
LCD Display Message................................................................................................ 6-30
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) ..............................................................6-31
System Description .................................................................................................... 6-31
System Setting............................................................................................................6-32
Warning and System Control.....................................................................................6-33
Detecting Sensor ........................................................................................................6-34
Limitations of the System ......................................................................................... 6-36
6
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY .................................................................. 6-39
The Radio Frequency Components (Rear Corner Radar) Complies: ......................6-39
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) ...............................................6-40
System Description ................................................................................................... 6-40
System Setting and Operation ................................................................................. 6-40
Warning and System Control.................................................................................... 6-42
Detecting Sensor ....................................................................................................... 6-43
Limitations of the System ......................................................................................... 6-44
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) System .......................................6-48
System Setting and Activation ................................................................................. 6-48
FCA Warning Message and System Control ............................................................ 6-50
FCA Sensor .................................................................................................................6-52
System Malfunction ...................................................................................................6-53
Limitations of the System ......................................................................................... 6-54
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) System-Sensor Fusion..............6-59
System Setting and Activation ................................................................................. 6-59
FCA Warning Message and System Control ............................................................. 6-61
FCA Sensor ................................................................................................................ 6-63
System Malfunction .................................................................................................. 6-65
Limitations of the System ......................................................................................... 6-66
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) ............................................................................... 6-71
6
LKA System Operation ............................................................................................... 6-72
Warning Light and Message ...................................................................................... 6-75
Limitations of the System ..........................................................................................6-76
LKA System Function Change ................................................................................... 6-77
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) .................................................................... 6-78
System Setting and Activation ..................................................................................6-78
Resetting the System .................................................................................................6-79
System Standby ..........................................................................................................6-79
System Malfunction ...................................................................................................6-79
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert ............................................................................... 6-81
6. While Driving
Cruise Control .................................................................................................6-82
Cruise Control Operation .......................................................................................... 6-82
Special Driving Conditions .............................................................................6-85
Hazardous Driving Conditions ................................................................................. 6-85
Rocking the Vehicle .................................................................................................. 6-85
Smooth Cornering ..................................................................................................... 6-86
Driving at Night ......................................................................................................... 6-86
Driving in the Rain ..................................................................................................... 6-86
Driving in Flooded Areas........................................................................................... 6-86
Highway Driving .........................................................................................................6-87
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover ................................................................................6-87
Winter Driving .................................................................................................6-88
Snow or Icy Conditions ............................................................................................. 6-88
Winter Precautions.................................................................................................... 6-89
Vehicle Load Limit ...........................................................................................6-91
Tire Loading Information Label ................................................................................. 6-91
Trailer Towing ..................................................................................................6-95
6
While Driving
WARNING
Carbon monoxide (CO) gas is toxic. Breathing CO can cause unconsciousness and
death.
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide which cannot be seen or smelled.
Do not inhale engine exhaust.
If at any time you smell engine exhaust inside the vehicle, open the windows
immediately. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and death by asphyxiation.
Be sure the exhaust system does not leak.
The exhaust system should be checked whenever the vehicle is raised to change the
oil or for any other purpose. If you hear a change in the sound of the exhaust or if you
drive over something that strikes the underneath side of the vehicle, have the exhaust
system checked as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not run the engine in an enclosed area.
Letting the engine idle in your garage, even with the garage door open, is a hazardous
practice. Run the engine only long enough to start the engine and to move the vehicle
out of the garage.
Avoid idling the engine for prolonged periods with people inside the vehicle.
If it is necessary to idle the engine for a prolonged period with people inside the
vehicle, be sure to do so only in an open area with the air intake set at "Fresh" and fan
control set to high so fresh air is drawn into the interior.
Keep the air intakes clear.
To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes
located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you must drive with the liftgate open:
Close all windows.
Open instrument panel air vents.
Set the air intake control at "Fresh", the air flow control at "Floor" or "Face", and the fan
control set to high.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING
Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components including
components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or emit harmful
chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California
to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.
6-4
06
BEFORE DRIVING
Before Entering the Vehicle
ś Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s),
and outside lights are clean and
unobstructed.
ś Remove frost, snow, or ice.
ś Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
ś Check under the vehicle for any sign
of leaks.
ś Be sure there are no obstacles behind
you if you intend to back up.
Before Starting
ś Make sure the hood, the liftgate, and
the doors are securely closed and
locked.
ś Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
ś Adjust the inside and outside rearview
mirrors.
ś Verify all the lights work.
ś Fasten your seatbelt. Check that
all passengers have fastened their
seatbelts.
ś Check the gauges and indicators
in the instrument panel and the
messages on the instrument display
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position.
ś Check that any items you are carrying
are stored properly or fastened down
securely.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
ś ALWAYS wear your seat belt. All
passengers must be properly belted
whenever the vehicle is moving.
For more information, refer to "Seat
Belts" in chapter 3.
ś Always drive defensively. Assume
other drivers or pedestrians may be
careless and make mistakes.
ś Stay focused on the task of driving.
Driver distraction can cause
accidents.
ś Leave plenty of space between you
and the vehicle in front of you.
WARNING
NEVER drink alcohol or take drugs and
drive.
Drinking alcohol or taking drugs and
driving is dangerous and may result in
an accident and SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number one
contributor to the highway death
toll each year. Even a small amount
of alcohol will affect your reflexes,
perceptions and judgment. Just
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions and
emergencies and your reaction time
gets worse with each additional drink.
Driving while under the influence
of drugs is as dangerous or more
dangerous than driving under the
influence of alcohol.
You are much more likely to have a
serious accident if you drink or take
drugs and drive. If you are drinking or
taking drugs, don't drive. Do not ride
with a driver who has been drinking
or taking drugs. Choose a designated
driver or call a taxi.
6-5
While Driving
IGNITION SWITCH
Key Ignition Switch (if equipped)
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH, take the following precautions:
ś NEVER allow children or any person
who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the ignition switch or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur.
ś NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the ignition switch, or any
other control, while the vehicle is in
motion. The presence of your hand
or arm in this area may cause a loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
OIB054010
6-6
WARNING
NEVER turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK or ACC position while the vehicle
is in motion except in an emergency.
This will result in the engine turning
off and loss of power assist for the
steering and brake systems. This may
lead to loss of directional control and
braking function, which could cause an
accident.
Before leaving the driver's seat, always
make sure the shift lever is in P (Park,
for intelligent variable transmission
vehicle) position, apply the parking
brake, and turn ignition switch to the
LOCK position.
Unexpected vehicle movement may
occur if these precautions are not
followed.
06
Key Ignition Switch Positions
Switch
Position
Action
LOCK
To turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK position, put the key in at
the ACC position and turn the key
towards the LOCK position.
The ignition key can be removed in
the LOCK position.
(The shift lever must be in the P
(Park) position for intelligent variable
transmission)
ACC
Electrical accessories are usable.
The steering wheel unlocks.
ON
This is the normal key position when
the engine has started.
All features and accessories are
usable.
The warning lights can be checked
when you turn the ignition switch
from ACC to ON.
Do not leave the ignition switch in
the ON position when the engine is
not running in order to prevent the
battery from discharging.
START
To start the engine, turn the ignition
switch to the START position. The
switch returns to the ON position
when you let go of the key.
The engine will crank until you
release the key.
Notice
6-7
While Driving
Starting the Engine
WARNING
Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle.
Unsuitable shoes, such as high heels,
ski boots, sandals, flip-flops, etc., may
interfere with your ability to use the
brake and accelerator pedals.
Vehicle with manual transmission:
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in neutral.
3. Depress the clutch and brake pedals.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 seconds) until the engine starts and
release it.
Information
Depress the brake pedal and clutch pedal
until the engine starts.
Vehicle with intelligent variable
transmission:
1. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
2. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
3. Depress the brake pedal.
4. Turn the ignition switch to the START
position. Hold the key (maximum of
10 seconds) until the engine starts and
release it.
6-8
Information
ś It is best to maintain a moderate engine
speed until the vehicle engine comes
up to normal operating temperature.
Avoid harsh or abrupt acceleration or
deceleration while the engine is still
cold.
ś Whether the engine is cold or warm,
always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not rev the engine while warming
it up.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
ś Do not hold the ignition key in the
START position for more than 10
seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before
trying again.
ś Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
06
Engine Start/Stop Button
(if equipped)
OQX069064L
Whenever the front door is opened, the
Engine Start/Stop button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the door
is closed.
WARNING
To reduce risk of serious injury or death,
NEVER allow children or any person
who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the Engine Start/Stop button or
related parts. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur.
WARNING
ś NEVER press the Engine Start/Stop
button while the vehicle is in motion
except in an emergency. This will
result in the engine turning off and
loss of power assist for the steering
and brake systems.
This may lead to loss of directional
control and braking function, which
could cause an accident.
ś Before leaving the driver's seat,
always make sure the shift lever is in
the P (Park) position, set the parking
brake, press the Engine Start/Stop
button to the OFF position, and take
the Smart Key with you. Unexpected
vehicle movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
ś NEVER reach through the steering
wheel for the Engine Start/Stop
button or any other control while the
vehicle is in motion. The presence
of your hand or arm in this area
may cause a loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
WARNING
To turn the engine off in an emergency:
Press and hold the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than two seconds OR
rapidly press and release the Engine
Start/Stop button three times (within
three seconds).
If the vehicle is still moving, you can
restart the engine without depressing
the brake pedal by pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button with the shift lever in
the N (Neutral) position.
6-9
While Driving
Engine Stop/Start Button Positions
Button
Position
Action
Notice
OFF
To turn off the engine, press the
Engine Start/Stop button with shift
lever in P (Park).
When you press the Engine Start/
Stop button without the shift lever
in P (Park), the Engine Start/Stop
button does not turn to the OFF
position, but turns to the ACC
position.
ACC
Press the Engine Start/Stop button
when the button is in the OFF
position without depressing the
brake pedal.
Electrical accessories are usable.
If you leave the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ACC position for more
than one hour, the battery power will
turn off automatically to prevent the
battery from discharging.
ON
Press the Engine Start/Stop button
while it is in the ACC position
without depressing the brake pedal.
The warning lights can be checked
before the engine is started.
Do not leave the Engine Start/Stop
button in the ON position when the
engine is not running to prevent the
battery from discharging.
To start the engine, depress the
brake pedal and press the Engine
Start/Stop button with the shift lever
in the P (Park) or in the N (Neutral)
position.
For your safety, start the engine
with the shift lever in the P (Park)
position.
If you press the Engine Start/Stop
button without depressing the brake
pedal, the engine does not start
and the Engine Start/Stop button
changes as follows:
2))Ɵ$&&Ɵ21Ɵ2))RU$&&
However, the engine may start if you
depress the brake pedal within 0.5
second after pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button from the OFF
position.
START
6-10
06
Starting the Engine
WARNING
ś Always wear appropriate shoes when
operating your vehicle.
Unsuitable shoes, such as high heels,
ski boots, sandals, flip-flops, etc.,
may interfere with your ability to use
the brake and accelerator pedals.
ś Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed. The
vehicle can move and lead to an
accident.
ś Wait until the engine rpm is normal.
The vehicle may suddenly move if
the brake pedal is released when the
rpm is high.
Information
ś The engine will start by pressing the
Engine Start/Stop button, only when
the smart key is in the vehicle.
ś Even if the smart key is in the vehicle,
if it is far away from the driver, the
engine may not start.
ś When the Engine Start/Stop button
is in the ACC or ON position, if any
door is open, the system checks for the
smart key. If the smart key is not in the
” indicator will blink
vehicle, the “
and the warning "Key not in vehicle"
will come on and if all doors are closed,
the chime will also sound for about
5 seconds. Keep the smart key in the
vehicle when using the ACC position or
if the vehicle engine is ON.
Vehicle with manual transmission:
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift lever is in neutral.
4. Depress the clutch and brake pedals.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
Information
Depress the brake pedal and clutch pedal
until the engine starts.
Vehicle with intelligent variable
transmission:
1. Always carry the smart key with you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the Engine Start/Stop button.
Information
ś Do not wait for the engine to warm up
while the vehicle remains stationary.
Start driving at moderate engine
speeds. (Aggressive accelerating and
decelerating should be avoided.)
ś Always start the vehicle with your foot
on the brake pedal. Do not depress the
accelerator while starting the vehicle.
Do not rev the engine while warming
it up.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
ś If the engine stalls while you are in
motion, do not attempt to move the
shift lever to the P (Park) position.
If traffic and road conditions permit,
you may put the shift lever in the N
(Neutral) position while the vehicle
is still moving and press the Engine
Start/Stop button in an attempt to
restart the engine.
ś Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
6-11
While Driving
MANUAL TRANSMISSION
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
When the stop lamp switch fuse is
blown, you can't start the engine
normally. Replace the fuse with a new
one. If you are not able to replace
the fuse, you can start the engine by
pressing and holding the Engine Start/
Stop button for 10 seconds with the
Engine Start/Stop button in the ACC
position.
Do not press the Engine Start/Stop
button for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp switch fuse is
blown.
For your safety always depress the
brake pedal before starting the engine.
OQX069077N
The shift lever can be moved without
pressing the button (1).
The button (1) must be pressed while
moving the shift lever to R (Reverse).
Manual Transmission Operation
The manual transmission has 6
forward gears. The transmission is fully
synchronized in all forward gears so
shifting to either a higher or a lower gear
can be easily accomplished.
WARNING
OQX069067
Information
If the smart key battery is weak or the
smart key does not work correctly, you
can start the engine by pressing the Engine
Start/Stop button with the smart key in
the direction of the picture above.
Before leaving the driver's seat, always
make sure the shift lever is in 1st gear
when the vehicle is parked on a uphill
and in R (Reverse) on a downhill, set the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position.
Unexpected vehicle movement may
occur if these precautions are not
followed.
To shift to R (Reverse), make sure the
vehicle has completely stopped, and
then move the shift lever to neutral
before moving into R (Reverse).
When you've come to a complete stop
and it's hard to shift into 1st gear or R
(Reverse):
1. Put the shift lever in neutral and
release the clutch pedal.
2. Depress the clutch pedal, and then
shift into 1 (first) or R (Reverse) gear.
6-12
06
NOTICE
During cold weather, shifting may be
difficult until the transmission lubricant
has warmed up.
Using the Clutch
The clutch pedal should be depressed all
the way before:
- Starting the engine
The engine will not start without
depressing the clutch pedal.
- Shifting into gear, up shifting to the
next higher gear, or down shifting to
the next lower gear.
When releasing the clutch pedal, release
it slowly. The clutch pedal should always
be fully released while driving.
CAUTION
To prevent unnecessary wear or
damage to the clutch:
ś Do not rest your foot on the clutch
pedal while driving.
ś Do not hold the vehicle with the
clutch on an incline, while waiting for
the traffic light, etc.
ś Always depress the clutch pedal
down fully to prevent noise or
damage.
ś Do not depress the clutch pedal
again until it is fully released.
ś Do not start in 2nd (second) gear
except when you are in slippery road
conditions.
ś Do not drive with cargo loaded more
than required loading capacity.
Downshifting
Down shift to a lower gear when slowing
down in heavy traffic or driving up a
steep hill to prevent high engine loads.
Also, downshifting reduces the chance
of stalling and helps reaccelerate the
vehicle when you need to increase your
speed.
When the vehicle is going downhill,
downshifting helps maintain safe speed
by providing engine braking (brake
power from the engine) and results in
less wear on the brakes.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the engine,
clutch and transmission:
ś When downshifting from 5th
gear to 4th gear, be careful not to
inadvertently push the shift lever
sideways engaging the 2nd gear. A
drastic downshift may cause the
engine speed to increase to the
point the tachometer will enter
the redzone and may cause engine
damage.
ś Do not downshift more than two
gear at a time or downshift the gear
when the engine is running at high
speed (5,000 RPM or higher).
Such down shifting may damage the
engine, clutch and the transmission.
6-13
While Driving
Good Driving Practices
ś Never take the vehicle out of gear and
coast down a hill. This is extremely
dangerous.
ś Don't "ride" the brakes. This can
cause the brakes and related parts to
overheat and malfunction.
When you are driving down a long hill,
slow down and shift to a lower gear.
Engine braking will help slow down
the vehicle.
ś Slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. This will help avoid over-revving
the engine, which can cause damage.
ś Slow down when you encounter cross
winds. This gives you much better
control of your vehicle.
ś Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you shift into R
(Reverse) to prevent damage to the
transmission.
ś Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
WARNING
Do not use aggressive engine braking
(shifting from a higher gear to a lower
gear) on slippery roads. This could
cause the tires to slip and may result in
an accident.
6-14
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś ALWAYS wear your seat belt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
ś Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
ś Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
ś The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
ś Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
ś In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
ś HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
06
,17(//,*(179$5,$%/(75$160,66,21ǣ,97Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Shift lever
Manual
shift mode
OQX069001L
Press the shift button, then move shift lever.
Depress the brake pedal, press the shift button, and then move shift lever.
Move shift lever.
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) Operation
The Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) automatically shifts depending on speed,
accelerate pedal position. The individual speeds are selected automatically, depending
on the position of the shift lever.
6-15
While Driving
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious injury or
death:
ś ALWAYS check the surrounding
areas near your vehicle for people,
especially children, before shifting a
vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
ś Before leaving the driver's seat,
always make sure the shift lever
is in the P (Park) position, then set
the parking brake, and place the
ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position. Unexpected and sudden
vehicle movement can occur if these
precautions are not followed.
ś When using Manual Shift Mode, do
not use aggressive engine braking
(shifting from a higher gear to a
lower gear) on slippery roads. This
could cause the tires to slip and may
result in an accident.
Transmission Ranges
The indicator in the instrument cluster
displays the shift lever position when the
ignition switch is in the ON position.
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into P (Park).
To shift from P (Park), you must depress
firmly on the brake pedal and make sure
your foot is off the accelerator pedal.
If you have done all of the above and still
cannot shift the lever out of P (Park), see
"Shift-Lock Release" in this section.
The shift lever must be in P (Park) before
turning the engine off.
6-16
WARNING
ś Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
ś Do not use the P (Park) position in
place of the parking brake. Always
make sure the shift lever is latched
in the P (Park) position and set the
parking brake fully.
ś Never leave a child unattended in a
vehicle.
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
NOTICE
Always come to a complete stop before
shifting into or out of R (Reverse); you
may damage the transmission if you
shift into R (Reverse) while the vehicle is
in motion.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and transmission are not
engaged.
Use N (Neutral) if you need to restart a
stalled engine. Shift into P (Park) if you
need to leave your vehicle for any reason.
Always depress the brake pedal when
you are shifting from N (Neutral) to
another gear.
WARNING
Do not shift into gear unless your foot is
firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into
gear when the engine is running at high
speed can cause the vehicle to move
very rapidly. You could lose control of
the vehicle and hit people or objects.
06
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position. The
transmission will automatically shift,
providing the best fuel economy and
power.
For extra power when passing another
vehicle or driving uphill depress the
accelerator pedal further until you feel
the transmission downshift to a lower
gear.
The DRIVE MODE switch, located on the
shift lever console, allows the driver to
switch from NORMAL mode to SPORT
mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive Mode
Integrated Control System" later in this
chapter.
(UP)
(DOWN)
OQX069002L
Manual shift mode
Whether the vehicle is stationary or in
motion, manual shift mode is selected by
pushing the shift lever from the D (Drive)
position into the manual gate. To return
to D (Drive) range operation, push the
shift lever back into the main gate.
In manual shift mode, moving the shift
lever backwards and forwards will allow
you to select the desired range of gears
for the current driving conditions.
+ (Up): Push the lever forward once to
shift up one gear.
- (Down): Pull the lever backwards once
to shift down one gear.
Information
ś Only the eight forward gears can be
selected. To reverse or park the vehicle,
move the shift lever to the R (Reverse)
or P (Park) position as required.
ś Downshifts are made automatically
when the vehicle slows down. When the
vehicle stops, 1st gear is automatically
selected.
ś When the engine rpm approaches the
red zone the transmission will upshift
automatically.
ś If the driver presses the lever to + (Up)
or - (Down) position, the transmission
may not make the requested gear
change if the next gear is outside of the
allowable engine rpm range. The driver
must execute upshifts in accordance
with road conditions, taking care to
keep the engine rpms below the red
zone.
ś When accelerating from a stop on
a slippery road, push the shift lever
forward into the + (Up) position. This
allows the transmission to shift into the
2nd gear which is better for smooth
driving on a slippery road. Push the
shift lever to the - (Down) side to shift
back to the 1st gear.
ś When driving in Manual Shift Mode,
slow down before shifting to a lower
gear. Otherwise, the lower gear may
not be engaged if the engine rpms are
outside of the allowable range.
6-17
While Driving
Shift-lock System
For your safety, the Intelligent Variable
Transmission (IVT) has a shift-lock
system which prevents shifting the
transmission from P (Park) into R
(Reverse) unless the brake pedal is
depressed.
To shift the transmission from P (Park)
into R (Reverse):
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the engine or place the ignition
switch in the ON position.
3. Move the shift lever.
Shift-lock Release
6. Remove the tool from the shift-lock
override access hole then install the
cap.
If you need to use the shift-lock release,
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer immediately.
Parking
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Move the shift lever into the P (Park)
position, apply the parking brake, and
place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position. Take the Key with you
when exiting the vehicle.
WARNING
OQX060004N
If the shift lever cannot be moved from
the P (Park) position into R (Reverse)
position with the brake pedal depressed,
continue depressing the brake, and then
do the following:
1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK/
OFF position.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Carefully remove the cap (1) covering
the shift-lock release access hole.
4. Insert a tool (e.g. flathead screwdriver)
into the access hole and press down
on the tool (2).
5. Move the shift lever.
6-18
ś When you stay in the vehicle with
the engine running, be careful not
to depress the accelerator pedal for
a long period of time. The engine or
exhaust system may overheat and
start a fire.
ś The exhaust gas and the exhaust
system are very hot. Keep away from
the exhaust system components.
ś Do not stop or park over flammable
materials, such as dry grass, paper
or leaves. They may ignite and cause
a fire.
06
Good Driving Practices
ś Never move the shift lever from P
(Park) or N (Neutral) to any other
position with the accelerator pedal
depressed.
ś Never move the shift lever into P
(Park) when the vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
ś Do not move the shift lever to N
(Neutral) when driving. Doing so may
result in an accident because of a loss
of engine braking.
ś Driving uphill or downhill, always shift
to D (Drive) when driving forward or to
R (Reverse) when driving backwards,
and check the gear position indicated
on the cluster before driving. If you
drive in the opposite direction of the
selected gear, the engine will turn
off and a serious accident might be
occurred due to the degraded brake
performance.
ś Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can result
in the brakes overheating, brake wear
and possibly even brake failure.
ś Do not hold the vehicle on the incline
with the accelerator pedal. This can
cause the transmission to overheat.
Always use the brake pedal or parking
brake.
ś Depressing both accelerator
and brake pedals at the same
time can trigger logic for engine
power reduction to assure vehicle
deceleration. Vehicle acceleration
will resume after the brake pedal is
released.
ś Always apply the parking brake when
leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on
placing the transmission in P (Park) to
keep the vehicle from moving.
ś Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the drive
wheels to lose traction and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
ś Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH:
ś ALWAYS wear your seat belt. In a
collision, an unbelted occupant
is significantly more likely to be
seriously injured or killed than a
properly belted occupant.
ś Avoid high speeds when cornering or
turning.
ś Do not make quick steering wheel
movements, such as sharp lane
changes or fast, sharp turns.
ś The risk of rollover is greatly
increased if you lose control of your
vehicle at highway speeds.
ś Loss of control often occurs if two or
more wheels drop off the roadway
and the driver over steers to reenter
the roadway.
ś In the event your vehicle leaves
the roadway, do not steer sharply.
Instead, slow down before pulling
back into the travel lanes.
ś HYUNDAI recommends you follow all
posted speed limits.
6-19
While Driving
BRAKE SYSTEM
Power Brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes
that adjust automatically through normal
usage.
If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the brakes will not work. You can still
stop your vehicle by applying greater
force to the brake pedal than typical.
The stopping distance, however, will be
longer than with power brakes.
When the engine is not running, the
reserve brake power is partially depleted
each time the brake pedal is applied.
Do not pump the brake pedal when the
power assist has been interrupted.
Only pump the brakes on slippery
surfaces if the power assist has been
interrupted to maintain steering control.
Do not pump the brakes on slippery
surfaces if the brakes are operating
normally.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
ś Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. This will create
abnormal high brake temperatures,
excessive brake lining and pad wear,
and increased stopping distances.
ś When descending down a long or
steep hill, move the gear shift lever
to Manual Shift Mode and manually
downshift to a lower gear in order
to control your speed without using
the brake pedal excessively. Applying
the brakes continuously will cause
the brakes to overheat and could
result in a temporary loss of braking
performance.
6-20
ś Wet brakes may impair the vehicle's
ability to safely slow down; the
vehicle may also pull to one side
when the brakes are applied.
Applying the brakes lightly will
indicate whether they have been
affected in this way. Always test your
brakes in this fashion after driving
through deep water. To dry the
brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to
heat up the brakes while maintaining
a safe forward speed until brake
performance returns to normal.
Avoid driving at high speeds until the
brakes function correctly.
Disc Brakes Wear Indicator
When your brake pads are worn and new
pads are required, you will hear a high
pitched warning sound from your front
or rear brakes. You may hear this sound
come and go or it may occur whenever
you depress the brake pedal.
Note that some driving conditions or
climates may cause a brake squeal
when you first apply (or lightly apply)
the brakes. This is normal and does not
indicate a problem with your brakes.
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do not
continue to drive with worn brake pads.
Information
Always replace brake pads as complete
front or rear axle sets.
Rear Drum Brakes (if equipped)
Your rear drum brakes do not have wear
indicators. Therefore, have the rear brake
linings inspected if you hear a rear brake
rubbing noise. Also have your rear brakes
inspected each time you change or
rotate your tires and when you have the
front brakes replaced.
06
Parking Brake
OQX069006L
OQX069005L
Always set the parking brake before
leaving the vehicle. To apply the parking
brake:
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
Pull up the parking brake lever as far as
possible.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH, do not operate the parking
brake while the vehicle is moving
except in an emergency situation. It
could damage the brake system and
lead to an accident.
To release:
Firmly depress the brake pedal.
While pressing the release button (1),
slightly pull up on the parking brake lever
then lower the parking brake lever (2).
If the parking brake does not release
or does not release all the way, have
your vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
ś Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the
brake pedal. Move the shift lever
into P (Park) position, then apply the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position.
Vehicles with the parking brake not
fully engaged are at risk for moving
inadvertently and causing injury to
yourself or others.
ś When parking on an incline, block
the wheels to prevent the vehicle
from rolling down.
ś NEVER allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch
the parking brake. If the parking
brake is released unintentionally,
serious injury may occur.
ś Only release the parking brake when
you are seated inside the vehicle
with your foot firmly on the brake
pedal.
6-21
While Driving
NOTICE
ś Do not apply the accelerator pedal
while the parking brake is engaged.
If you depress the accelerator pedal
with the parking brake engaged, a
warning will sound. Damage to the
parking brake may occur.
ś Driving with the parking brake on
can overheat the braking system and
cause premature wear or damage to
brake parts. Make sure the parking
brake is released and the Brake
Warning Light is off before driving.
Check the Parking Brake
Warning Light by placing
the ignition switch to the
ON position (do not start the
engine).
This light will be illuminated when the
parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the START or ON position.
Before driving, be sure the parking brake
is released and the Brake Warning Light
is OFF.
If the Parking Brake Warning Light
remains on after the parking brake
is released while engine is running,
there may be a malfunction in the
brake system. Immediate attention is
necessary.
If at all possible, cease driving the vehicle
immediately. If that is not possible,
use extreme caution while operating
the vehicle and only continue to drive
the vehicle until you can reach a safe
location.
6-22
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
An Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) or
an Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system will not prevent accidents
due to improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle
control is improved during emergency
braking, always maintain a safe
distance between you and objects
ahead of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during extreme
road conditions. The braking distance
for cars equipped with ABS or ESC
may be longer than for those without
these systems in the following road
conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced speeds
during the following conditions:
ś Rough, gravel or snow-covered
roads.
ś On roads where the road surface is
pitted or has different surface height.
ś Tire chains are installed on your
vehicle.
The safety features of an ABS or ESC
equipped vehicle should not be tested
by high speed driving or cornering. This
could endanger the safety of yourself or
others.
ABS is an electronic braking system that
helps prevent a braking skid. ABS allows
the driver to steer and brake at the same
time.
06
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your brake
pressure and do not try to pump your
brakes. Depress your brake pedal as hard
as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your ABS is active.
ABS does not reduce the time or distance
it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that results
from sudden changes in direction, such
as trying to take a corner too fast or
making a sudden lane change. Always
drive at a safe speed for the road and
weather conditions.
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability.
Always steer moderately when braking
hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel
movement can still cause your vehicle to
veer into oncoming traffic or off the road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system
may result in a longer stopping distance
than for vehicles equipped with a
conventional brake system.
The ABS warning light ( ) will stay on
for several seconds after the ignition
switch is in the ON position. During
that time, the ABS will go through selfdiagnosis and the light will go off if
everything is normal. If the light stays on,
you may have a problem with your ABS.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
as soon as possible.
WARNING
If the ABS warning light ( ) is on and
stays on, you may have a problem with
the ABS. Your power brakes will work
normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, contact your HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
CAUTION
When you drive on a road having poor
traction, such as an icy road, and apply
your brakes continuously, the ABS will
be active continuously and the ABS
warning light ( ) may illuminate. Pull
your car over to a safe place and turn
the engine off.
Restart the engine. If the ABS warning
light is off, then your ABS system is
normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem
with your ABS system. Contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
Information
When you jump start your vehicle because
of a drained battery, the ABS warning
light ( ) may turn on at the same
time. This happens because of the low
battery voltage. It does not mean your
ABS is malfunctioning. Have the battery
recharged before driving the vehicle.
6-23
While Driving
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
ESC Operation
ESC ON condition
When the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds. After both
lights go off, the ESC is enabled.
When operating
When the ESC is in operation,
the ESC indicator light blinks:
OQX059026L
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system helps to stabilize the vehicle
during cornering maneuvers. ESC checks
where you are steering and where the
vehicle is actually going. ESC applies
braking pressure to any one of the
vehicle's brakes and intervenes in the
engine management system to assist the
driver with keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. It is not a substitute for
safe driving practices. Always adjust your
speed and driving to the road conditions.
WARNING
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions or too quickly when
cornering. The ESC system will not
prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns, abrupt
maneuvers, and hydroplaning on wet
surfaces can result in severe accidents.
6-24
ś When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the wheels,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in
the brake pedal. This is normal and it
means your ESC is active.
ś When the ESC activates, the engine
may not respond to the accelerator as
it does under routine conditions.
ś If the Cruise Control was in use when
the ESC activates, the Cruise Control
automatically disengages. The Cruise
Control can be reengaged when the
road conditions allow. See "Cruise
Control System" later in this chapter.
(if equipped)
ś When moving out of the mud or
driving on a slippery road, the engine
RPM (revolutions per minute) may
not increase even if you press the
accelerator pedal deeply. This is to
maintain the stability and traction of
the vehicle and does not indicate a
problem.
06
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation:
ś State 1
Press the ESC OFF button briefly. The
ESC OFF indicator light and message
"Traction Control disabled" will
illuminate. In this state, the traction
control function of ESC (engine
management) is disabled, but the
brake control function of ESC (braking
management) still operates.
ś State 2
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds.
The ESC OFF indicator light and message
"Traction and Stability Control disabled"
illuminates and a warning chime sounds.
In this state, both the traction control
function of ESC (engine management)
and the brake control function of ESC
(braking management) are disabled.
If the ignition switch is placed to the
LOCK/OFF position when ESC is off, ESC
remains off. Upon restarting the engine,
the ESC will automatically turn on again.
Indicator Lights
Ŷ ESC indicator light (blinks)
Ŷ ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
When the ignition switch is placed to
the ON position, the ESC indicator light
illuminates, then goes off if the ESC
system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever
the ESC is operating.
If ESC indicator light stays on, your
vehicle may have a malfunction with
the ESC system. When this warning light
illuminates have your vehicle checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes on
when the ESC is turned off.
WARNING
When the ESC is blinking, this indicates
the ESC is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt to
accelerate. NEVER turn the ESC off
while the ESC indicator light is blinking
or you may lose control of the vehicle
resulting in an accident.
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before replacing
tires, make sure all four tires and wheels
are the same size. Never drive the
vehicle with different sized wheels and
tires installed.
6-25
While Driving
ESC OFF Usage
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be used
briefly to help free the vehicle if stuck in
snow by temporarily stopping operation
of the ESC to maintain wheel torque.
To turn ESC off while driving, press the
ESC OFF button while driving on a flat
road surface.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the transmission:
ś Do not allow wheel(s) of one axle to
spin excessively while the ESC, ABS,
and parking brake warning lights
are displayed. The repairs would not
be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce engine power and do not
spin the wheel(s) excessively while
these lights are displayed.
ś When operating the vehicle on
a dynamometer, make sure the
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
Information
Turning the ESC off does not affect ABS
or standard brake system operation.
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM)
The Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)
is a function of the Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system. It helps ensure the
vehicle stays stable when accelerating
or braking suddenly on wet, slippery and
rough roads where traction over the four
tires can suddenly become uneven.
6-26
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using the Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM):
ś ALWAYS check the speed and the
distance to the vehicle ahead. The
VSM is not a substitute for safe
driving practices.
ś Never drive too fast for the road
conditions. The VSM system will not
prevent accidents. Excessive speed
in bad weather, slippery and uneven
roads can result in severe accidents.
VSM Operation
VSM ON condition
The VSM operates when:
ś The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
is on.
ś Vehicle speed is approximately above
9 mph (15 km/h) on curve roads.
ś Vehicle speed is approximately above
12 mph (20 km/h) when the vehicle is
braking on rough roads.
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate the ESC,
you may hear sounds from the brakes,
or feel a corresponding sensation in the
brake pedal. This is normal and it means
your VSM is active.
NOTICE
The VSM does not operate when:
ś Driving on a banked road such as
gradient or incline.
ś Driving rearward.
ś ESC OFF indicator light is on.
ś EPS (Electric Power Steering)
warning light ( ) is on or blinks.
06
WARNING
If ESC indicator light ( ) or EPS
warning light ( ) stays on or blinks,
your vehicle may have a malfunction
with the VSM system. When the
warning light illuminates, have your
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC system
to malfunction. Before replacing tires,
make sure all four tires and wheels are
the same size. Never drive the vehicle
with different sized tires and wheels
installed.
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
The Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
helps prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards when starting a vehicle from
a stop on a hill. The system operates the
brakes automatically for approximately
2 seconds and releases the brake after 2
seconds or when the accelerator pedal is
depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting off on
a incline. The HAC activates only for
approximately 2 seconds.
NOTICE
ś The HAC does not operate when the
shift lever is in P (Park) or N (Neutral)
ś The HAC activates even though the
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
off but does not activate when the
ESC has malfunctioned.
Good Braking Practices
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete
stop and continue to depress the brake
pedal. Move the shift lever into P (Park)
position, then apply the parking brake,
and place the ignition switch in the
LOCK/OFF position.
Vehicles parked with the parking brake
not applied or not fully engaged may
roll inadvertently and may cause injury
to the driver and others. ALWAYS apply
the parking brake before exiting the
vehicle.
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it
is washed. Your vehicle will not stop as
quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet brakes
may cause the vehicle to pull to one side.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns to
normal, taking care to keep the vehicle
under control at all times. If the braking
action does not return to normal, stop
as soon as it is safe to do so and call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting on
the brake pedal. Even light, but constant
pedal pressure can result in the brakes
overheating, brake wear, and possibly
even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving,
apply the brakes gently and keep the
vehicle pointed straight ahead while you
slow down. When you are moving slowly
enough for it to be safe to do so, pull off
the road and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal
when the vehicle is stopped to prevent
the vehicle from rolling forward.
6-27
While Driving
'5,9(02'(,17(*5$7('&21752/6<67(0ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
OQX060079N
OQX049037N
OQX049038N
The drive mode may be selected
according to the driver's preference or
road condition.
The system resets to be in the NORMAL
mode, when the engine is restarted.
Information
If there is a problem with the instrument
cluster, the drive mode will be in
NORMAL mode and may not change to
SPORT mode.
The mode changes, as below, whenever
the DRIVE MODE button is pressed.
NORMAL
6-28
SPORT
SNOW
OQX049039N
NORMAL Mode
In NORMAL mode the engine and
transmission control logic work
together to provide regular daily driving
performance with some fuel efficiency.
ś When NORMAL mode is selected, it
is not displayed on the instrument
cluster.
06
SPORT Mode
SPORT mode manages
the driving dynamics by
automatically adjusting
the steering effort, and the
engine and transmission
control logic for enhanced
driving performance.
ś When SPORT mode is selected by
pressing the DRIVE MODE button, the
SPORT indicator will illuminate.
ś Whenever the engine is restarted,
the Drive Mode will revert back to
NORMAL mode. If SPORT mode is
desired, re-select SPORT mode from
the DRIVE MODE button.
ś When SPORT mode is activated:
- The engine rpm will tend to remain
a little higher for a brief time even
after releasing the accelerator. This
is a typical when the SPORT mode is
activated.
- Upshifts are delayed when
accelerating
SNOW Mode
SNOW mode offers special
traction tuning for snow
optimizing available traction
in adverse conditions. Snow
mode adjusts left and right
wheel slip control, engine
torque and shift patterns
according to available
traction levels.
WARNING
Snow mode is designed base on 2WD (2
Wheel Drive), Do not drive in condition
that exceed the vehicles intended
design.
Invalid mode selection can lead to loss
of traction and skidding, particularly
on slippery roads, this can cause you to
lose control of the vehicle, which can
lead to accidents and serious injuries.
Information
In SPORT mode, the fuel efficiency may
decrease.
6-29
While Driving
LCD Display Message
Transmission Hot! Park with Engine
On
OJS058137L
OJS058138L
6-30
ś Under certain conditions, such as
harsh driving conditions (mud or sand
road), the transmission temperatures
will increase excessively. Finally the
transmission could be overheated.
ś If the vehicle continues to be driven
and the transmission temperatures
reach the maximum temperature
limit, the "Transmission hot! Park with
engine On" warning will be displayed.
When this occurs the transmission is
disabled until the transmission cools
to normal temperatures.
ś The warning will display a time to wait
for the transmission to cool.
ś If this occurs, pull over to a safe
location, stop the vehicle with the
engine running, apply the brakes and
shift the vehicle to P (Park), and allow
the transmission to cool.
ś When the message "Transmission
cooled down. Resume driving"
appears you can continue to drive
your vehicle.
ś When possible, drive the vehicle
smoothly.
06
%/,1'ǘ6327&2//,6,21:$51,1*ǣ%&:Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
System Description
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)
system uses radar sensors in the rear
bumper to monitor and warn the driver
of an approaching vehicle in the driver's
blind spot area.
1. Blind-Spot Area
WARNING
ś Always be aware of road conditions
while driving and be alert for
unexpected situations even though
Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
is operating.
ś Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
is supplemental systems to assist
you. Do not entirely rely on the
systems. Always pay attention, while
driving, for your safety.
ś Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
is not a substitute for proper and safe
driving. Always drive safely and use
caution when changing lanes.
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system may not detect every object
alongside the vehicle.
OQX059143N
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to vehicle speed.
Note that if your vehicle is traveling
much faster than the vehicles around
you, the warning will not occur.
2. Closing at high speed
OQX059060L
Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
will alert you when it detects a vehicle is
approaching in an adjacent lane at a high
rate of speed. If the driver activates the
turn signal when the system detects an
oncoming vehicle, the system sounds an
audible alert.
6-31
While Driving
System Setting
OQX069078N
OTMA058088MX
ś Setting Blind-Spot Safety function
The driver can activate the system
by placing the ignition switch to the
ON position and by selecting 'User
6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ%OLQG
Spot Safety'.
- BCW turns on and gets ready to
be operated when 'Warning Only'
is selected. Then, if a vehicle
approaches the driver's blind spot
area a warning sounds.
- The system is deactivated and the
indicator on the BCW button is
extinguished when 'Off' is selected.
ś Selecting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time in the
User Settings in the LCD display by
VHOHFWLQJ 8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJ
ś The options for the initial BlindSpot Collision Warning includes the
following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Blind-Spot Collision Warning
is activated normally. If this setting
feels sensitive change the option to
‘Late’.
The warning activation time may
feel late if a vehicle at the side or
rear abruptly accelerates.
- Late:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving in a low speed.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before changing
the warning timing.
6-32
06
Warning and System Control
Left side
Blind-Spot Collision Warning System
Left side
OQX069035L
Right side
OQX069036L
Right side
OQX069009L
[A] : Warning sound
OQX069008L
First stage alert
If a vehicle is detected within the
boundary of the system, a yellow
warning light will illuminate on the outer
side view mirror.
If the detected vehicle is no longer within
the blind spot area, the warning will turn
off according to the driving conditions of
the vehicle.
Second stage alert
A warning chime to alert the driver will
activate when:
1. A vehicle has been detected in the
blind spot area by the radar system
AND.
2. The turn signal is applied (same
side as where the vehicle is being
detected).
When this alert is activated, the warning
light on the outer side view mirror. Will
also blink. And a warning chime will
sound.
If you turn off the turn signal indicator,
the second stage alert will be
deactivated.
If the detected vehicle is no longer within
the blind spot area, the warning will turn
off according to the driving conditions of
the vehicle.
6-33
While Driving
WARNING
ś The warning light on the outer side
view mirror will illuminate whenever
a vehicle is detected at the rear side
by the system.
To avoid accidents, do not focus only
on the warning light and neglect to
see the surroundings of the vehicle.
ś Drive safely even though the vehicle
is equipped with Blind-Spot Collision
Warning system. Do not solely
rely on the system but check your
surroundings before changing lanes
or backing the vehicle up.
ś The system may not alert the driver
in some situations due to system
limitations so always check your
surroundings while driving.
CAUTION
ś Always pay attention to road and
traffic conditions while driving,
whether or not the warning light
on the outside rearview mirror
illuminates or there is a warning
alarm.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing Blind-Spot Collision
Warning system warning sounds.
ś If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, Blind-Spot Collision
Warning system warning may not
sound.
6-34
Detecting Sensor
OQX069011L
The rear corner radars are located inside
the rear bumper for detecting the side and
rear areas. Always keep the rear bumper
clean for proper operation of the system.
NOTICE
ś The system may not work properly
when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper has
been replaced or repaired.
ś The sensing range differs somewhat
according to the width of the road.
When the road is narrow, the system
may detect other vehicles in the next
lane.
ś The system may turn off if interfered
by electromagnetic waves.
ś Always keep the sensors clean.
ś NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact on
the sensor component.
ś Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not be
displayed. Have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not apply foreign objects such as
a bumper sticker or a bumper guard
near the radar sensor or apply paint
to the sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of
the sensor.
06
Warning Message
OAD058169L
OIK057092L
Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
disabled. Radar blocked
This warning message may appear when:
- One or both of the sensors on the rear
bumper is blocked by dirt or snow or a
foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle for an
extended period of time.
- When there is inclement weather such
as heavy snow or rain.
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system
If there is a problem with BCW system,
a warning message will appear and the
light on the switch will turn off. The
system will turn off automatically. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If any of these conditions occur, the light
on the BCW switch and the system will
turn off automatically.
When BCW canceled warning message
is displayed in the cluster, check to make
sure that the rear bumper is free from
any dirt or snow in the areas where the
sensor is located. Remove any dirt, snow,
or foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed, the
system should operate normally after
about 10 minutes of driving the vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-35
While Driving
Limitations of the System
The driver must be cautious in the below
situations because the system may not
detect other vehicles or objects in certain
circumstances:
ś The vehicle is driven in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or snow.
ś The sensor is polluted with rain, snow,
mud, etc.
ś The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
ś The rear bumper is damaged, or the
sensor is out of the original default
position.
ś The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
liftgate, abnormal tire pressure, etc.
ś When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
ś When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
ś The vehicle is driven on a curved road.
ś The vehicle is driven through a
tollgate.
ś The road pavement (or the peripheral
ground) abnormally contains metallic
components (i.e. possibly due to
subway construction).
ś There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
ś While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
6-36
ś Driving on a narrow road where trees
or grass or overgrown.
ś Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle or
structure for an extended period of
time.
ś Driving on a wet road.
ś Driving on a road where the guardrail
or wall is in double structure.
ś A big vehicle is near such as a bus or
truck.
ś When the other vehicle approaches
very close.
ś When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
ś While changing lanes.
ś If the vehicle has started at the same
time as the vehicle next to you and
has accelerated.
ś When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you OR
when the vehicle two lanes away
moves to the next lane from you.
ś A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
ś A flat trailer is near.
ś If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
ś If there is a low height vehicle such as
a sports car.
ś Temperature is extremely low around
the vehicle.
06
OQX069012L
ś Driving on a curve
The system may not operate properly
when driving on a curved road. In
certain instances, the system may not
detect the vehicle in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OQX069037L
ś Driving where the road is merging/
dividing
The system may not operate properly
when driving where the road is
merging/dividing. In certain instances,
the system may not detect the vehicle
in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OQX069013L
The system may not operate properly
when driving on a curved road. In
certain instances, the system may
recognize a vehicle in the same lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OQX069038L
ś Driving on a slope
The system may not operate properly
when driving on a slope. In certain
instances, the system may not detect
the vehicle in the next lane.
Also, in certain instances the system
may wrongly recognize the ground or
structures.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
6-37
While Driving
OQX069014L
ś Driving where the heights of the lanes
are different
The system may not operate properly
when driving where the heights of the
lanes are different.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle on a road with
different lane heights (i.e. underpass
joining section, grade separated
intersections, etc.).
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OQX069015L
[A] : noise barrier, [B] : guardrail
ś Driving where there is a structure
beside the road
The system may not operate properly
when driving where there is structure
beside the road.
In certain instances, the system may
wrongly recognize the structures
(i.e. noise barriers, guardrail, double
guardrail, median strip, bollard, street
light, road sign, tunnel wall, etc.)
beside the road.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
6-38
06
'(&/$5$7,212)&21)250,7<ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
The Radio Frequency
Components (Rear Corner
Radar) Complies:
- For USA
OANATEL002
OANATEL003
6-39
While Driving
5($5&5266ǘ75$)),&&2//,6,21:$51,1*ǣ5&&:Ǥ
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
System Description
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
System
OOS057068
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system uses radar sensors to monitor the
approaching cross traffic from the left
and right side of the vehicle when your
vehicle is in reverse.
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to the approaching vehicle
speed.
WARNING
ś Always be aware of road and traffic
conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations even
though Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning system is operating.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system is a supplemental system to
assist you. Do not entirely rely on the
systems. Always pay attention, while
driving, for your safety.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system is not a substitute for proper
and safe driving. Always drive safely
and use caution when backing up the
vehicle.
6-40
System Setting and Operation
System Setting
ś The driver can activate the system
by placing the ignition switch to the
ON position and by selecting “User
6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ
6DIHW\Ɵ5HDU&URVV7UDIILF6DIHW\Ŗ
RCCW turns on when ‘Rear CrossTraffic safety’ is selected.
ś When the engine is turned off then on
again, the system will be activated.
ś When the system is initially turned
on and when the engine is turned
off then on again, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outside rearview mirror.
06
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before changing
the warning timing.
OQX069078N
ś Setting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial warning
activation time in the User Settings in the
/&'GLVSOD\E\VHOHFWLQJœ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ
'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJŔ
The options for initial Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this condition is selected, initial
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning is
activated normally. If this setting feels
sensitive, change the option to ‘Late’.
The warning activation time may feel
late if a vehicle at the side or rear
abruptly accelerates.
- Late:
Select this warning activation time
when driving at a low speed or when
Normal feels too sensitive.
The driver can select the warning volume
of Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
E\VHOHFWLQJœ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ9ROXPHƟ+LJK
Medium/Low’.
Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change. Always be aware before changing
the warning volume.
Operating Conditions
To operate:
*RWRWKHŕ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
DVVLVWDQFHƟ3DUNLQJ6DIHW\Ɵ5HDU
&URVV7UDIILF6DIHW\ŖRQWKH/&'GLVSOD\
The system will turn on and standby to
activate.
The system will activate when vehicle
speed is below 7 MPH (10 km/h) and with
the shift lever in R (Reverse).
à The system will not activate when
the vehicle speed exceeds 7 MPH (10
km/h). The system will activate again
when the speed is below 5 MPH (8
km/h).
The system’s detecting range is
approximately 1 ~ 65 ft (0.5 ~ 20 m). An
approaching vehicle will be detected if
their vehicle speed is within 5 ~ 22.5 MPH
(8 ~ 36 km/h).
Note that the detecting range and
operating speed may vary under certain
conditions. As always, use caution and
pay close attention to your surroundings
when backing up your vehicle.
6-41
While Driving
Warning and System Control
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
System
Left
OQX069017L
Right
OQX069016L
If the vehicle detected by the sensors
approaches from the rear left/right side
of your vehicle, the warning chime will
sound, the warning light on the outside
rearview mirror will blink and a message
will appear on the LCD display. If the
rear view monitor system is in activation,
a message will also appear on the
infotainment system screen.
The warning will stop when:
- The detected vehicle moves out of the
sensing area or
- when the vehicle is right behind your
vehicle or
- when the vehicle is not approaching
your vehicle or
- when the other vehicle slows down.
- The vehicle’s approaching speed is
decreased.
6-42
CAUTION
ś When the operation condition of
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system is satisfied, the warning
will occur every time a vehicle
approaches the side or rear of your
stopped (0 MPH vehicle speed)
vehicle.
ś The system's warning may not
operate properly if the left or right of
your vehicle's rear bumper is blocked
by a vehicle or obstacle.
ś Always pay attention to road and
traffic conditions while driving,
whether or not the warning light
on the outside rearview mirror
illuminates or there is a warning
alarm.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system's warning
sounds.
ś If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning system warning
may not sound.
06
WARNING
ś Drive safely even though the vehicle
is equipped with Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning system. Do not
solely rely on the system but check
your surrounding when backing the
vehicle up.
ś The driver is responsible for accurate
brake control.
ś Always pay extreme caution while
driving. Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning system may not operate
properly or unnecessarily operate
depending on traffic and driving
conditions.
ś Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system is not a substitute for safe
driving practices, but a convenience
function only. It is the responsibility
of the driver to always drive
cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
Detecting Sensor
OQX069011L
The rear corner radars are located inside
the rear bumper for detecting the side
and rear areas. Always keep the rear
bumper clean for proper operation of the
system.
NOTICE
ś The system may not work properly
when the bumper has been
damaged, or if the rear bumper has
been replaced or repaired.
ś The system may turn off if interfered
by electromagnetic waves.
ś Always keep the sensors clean.
ś NEVER disassemble the sensor
component or apply any impact on
the sensor component.
ś Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Do not apply foreign objects such as
a bumper sticker or a bumper guard
near the radar sensor or apply paint
to the sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of
the sensor.
6-43
While Driving
Warning Message
OAD058169L
OIK057092L
Blind-Spot Collision Warning system
disabled. Radar blocked
This warning message may appear when:
- One or both of the sensors on the rear
bumper is blocked by dirt or snow or a
foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle for an
extended period of time.
- When there is inclement weather such
as heavy snow or rain.
If any of these conditions occur, the light
on BCW switch and the system will turn
off automatically.
When BCW canceled warning message
is displayed in the cluster, check to make
sure that the rear bumper is free from
any dirt or snow in the areas where the
sensor is located. Remove any dirt, snow,
or foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed, the
system should operate normally after
about 10 minutes of driving the vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-44
Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system
If there is a problem with BCW system,
a warning message will appear and the
light on the switch will turn off. The
system will turn off automatically. RCCW
will not operate also if BCW system
turns off due to a malfunction. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Limitations of the System
The driver must be cautious in the below
situations because the system may not
detect other vehicles or objects in certain
circumstances:
ś The vehicle is driven in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or snow.
ś The sensor is polluted with rain, snow,
mud, etc.
ś The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
ś The rear bumper is damaged, or the
sensor is out of the original default
position.
ś The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
liftgate, abnormal tire pressure, etc.
ś When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
ś When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
06
ś The vehicle is driven on a curved road.
ś The road pavement (or the peripheral
ground) abnormally contains metallic
components (i.e. possibly due to
subway construction).
ś There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
ś While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
ś Driving on a narrow road where trees
or grass are overgrown.
ś Driving in rural areas where the sensor
does not detect another vehicle for an
extended period of time.
ś Driving on a wet road.
ś Driving on a road where the guardrail
or wall is in double structure.
ś An oversized vehicle is near such as a
bus or truck.
ś When another vehicle approaches
very closely.
ś When another vehicle passes very
quickly.
ś While changing lanes.
ś If the vehicle has started at the same
time as the vehicle next to you and
has accelerated.
ś When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you OR
when the vehicle two lanes away
moves the lane next to you.
ś A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
ś A flat trailer is near.
ś If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
ś If there is a low height vehicle such as
a sports car.
ś Temperature is extremely low around
the vehicle.
OQX069018L
[A] : Structure
ś Driving where there is a vehicle or
structure near
The system may not operate properly
when driving where there is a vehicle
or structure near.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from behind and the warning may not
operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
6-45
While Driving
OQX069019L
ś When the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment.
In certain instances, the system may
not be able to exactly determine the
risk of collision for the vehicles which
are parking or pulling out near your
vehicle (e.g. a vehicle escaping beside
your vehicle, a vehicle parking or
pulling out in the rear area, a vehicle
approaching your vehicle making a
turn, etc.).
If this occurs, the warning may not
operate properly.
OQX069020L
[A] : Vehicle
ś When the vehicle is parked diagonally
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is parked diagonally.
In certain instances, when the
diagonally parked vehicle is pulled out
of the parking space, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right of your vehicle.
In this case, the warning may not
operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
OQX069021L
ś When the vehicle is on/near a slope
The system may not operate properly
when the vehicle is on/near a slope.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right and the
warning may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your
surrounding while driving.
6-46
06
OQX069023L
[A] : Structure, [B] : Wall
ś Pulling into the parking space where
there is a structure
The system may not operate properly
when pulling in the vehicle to the
parking space where there is a
structure at the back or side of your
vehicle.
In certain instances, when backing
into the parking space, the system
may not detect the vehicle moving in
front of your vehicle. In this case, the
warning may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to the parking
space while driving.
OQX069022L
ś When the vehicle is parked rearward
If the vehicle is parked rearward and
the sensor detects the another vehicle
in the rear area of the parking space,
the system warning may not work
properly. Always pay attention to the
parking space while driving.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
6-47
While Driving
)25:$5'&2//,6,21ǘ$92,'$1&($66,67ǣ)&$Ǥ6<67(0
ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system is designed to help detect and
monitor the vehicle ahead in the roadway
through camera recognition to warn the
driver that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system helps detect the vehicle ahead in
the roadway through camera.
System Setting and Activation
System Setting
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system:
ś This system is only a supplemental
system and it is not intended to,
nor does it replace the need for
extreme care and attention of
the driver. The sensing range and
objects detectable by the sensors
are limited. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
ś NEVER drive too fast in accordance
with the road conditions or while
cornering.
ś Always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. FCA does not stop
the vehicle completely but helps
apply emergency braking to reduce
speed when necessary.
6-48
OTMA058186
ś Setting Forward Safety function
The driver can activate FCA by placing
the ignition switch to the ON position
and by selecting:
œ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ
Forward Safety’
- ,I\RXVHOHFWŕ$FWLYH$VVLVWŖ)&$
system activates. FCA produces
warning messages and warning
alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. Braking assist will
be applied in accordance with the
collision risk.
- If you select ‘Warning Only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. Braking assist
will not be applied in this setting.
- If you select ‘Off’, FCA system
deactivates.
06
The warning light illuminates
on the LCD display, when you
cancel FCA system.
The driver can monitor FCA ON/OFF
status on the LCD display. Also, the
warning light illuminates when the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) is turned
off. If the warning light remains ON
when FCA is activated, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The options for the initial Forward
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Forward Collision Warning is for
normal driving conditions. If you feel
the warning activates too early, set the
Forward Collision Warning to ‘Late’.
Even though, ‘Normal’ is selected if
the front vehicle suddenly stops the
initial warning activation time may not
seem fast.
- Late:
When this option is selected, the initial
Forward Collision Warning is activated
later than normal. This setting reduces
the amount of distance between
the vehicle ahead before the initial
warning occurs.
Select ‘Late’ when traffic is light and
when driving speed is slow.
OQX069078N
ś Setting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time on the LCD
display.
*RWRWKHœ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJƟ
Normal/Late’.
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before changing
the warning timing.
6-49
While Driving
Prerequisite for Activation
Prerequisite for activation FCA gets ready
to be activated, when ‘Active Assist’ or
‘Warning Only’ under Forward Safety is
selected in on the LCD display, and when
the following prerequisites are satisfied.
- The ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
is on.
- Vehicle speed is over 6 MPH (10
km/h).
- The system detects a vehicle in front,
which may collide with your vehicle.
(FCA may not be activated or may
sound a warning alarm in accordance
with the driving situation or vehicle
condition.)
FCA Warning Message and
System Control
FCA produces warning messages and
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels, such as abrupt
stopping of the vehicle in front or
insufficient braking distance. Also, it
controls the brakes in accordance with
the collision risk levels.
Collision Warning (First Warning)
WARNING
ś Completely stop the vehicle on a safe
location before operating the switch
on the steering wheel to activate/
deactivate FCA system.
ś FCA automatically activates upon
placing the POWER button to the ON
position. The driver can deactivate
FCA by canceling the system setting
on the LCD display.
ś FCA automatically deactivates
upon canceling the ESC (Electronic
Stability Control). When the ESC is
canceled, FCA cannot be activated
on the LCD display. FCA warning light
will illuminate which is normal.
6-50
OQX059029L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the engine
management system to help decelerate
the vehicle.
- Your vehicle speed may decelerate
moderately.
- FCA system has limited controls of
the brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision.
- If you select ‘Warning only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. You should
control the brake directly because
FCA system does not control the
brake.
06
Emergency Braking
(Second Warning)
CAUTION
OQX059030L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs to help decelerate
the vehicle.
- FCA system has limited controls of
the brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision. The brake control
is maximized just before a collision.
- If you select ‘Warning only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. You should
control the braking directly because
the FCA system will not control the
brakes for you.
Brake Operation
ś In an urgent situation, the braking
system enters into the ready status for
prompt reaction against the driver’s
depressing the brake pedal.
ś FCA provides additional braking
power for optimum braking
performance, when the driver
depresses the brake pedal.
ś The braking control is automatically
deactivated, when the driver sharply
depresses the accelerator pedal, or
when the driver abruptly operates the
steering wheel.
ś FCA brake control is automatically
canceled, when risk factors disappear.
The driver should always use extreme
caution while operating the vehicle,
whether or not there is a warning
message or alarm from FCA system.
ś After the brake control is activated,
the driver must immediately depress
the brake pedal and check the
surroundings. The brake activation
by the system lasts for about 2
seconds.
ś If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system
warning may not sound.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system warning
sounds.
WARNING
The FCA braking control cannot
completely stop the vehicle nor avoid
all collisions. The driver holds the
responsibility to safely drive and control
the vehicle.
WARNING
FCA system logic operates within
certain parameters, such as the
distance from the vehicle ahead,
the speed of the vehicle ahead, and
the driver's vehicle speed. Certain
conditions such as inclement weather
and road conditions may affect the
operation of FCA system.
WARNING
Never deliberately drive dangerously to
activate the system.
6-51
While Driving
NOTICE
FCA Sensor
Front camera
OQX059031L
In order for FCA system to operate
properly, always make sure the front
view camera is clean and free of dirt,
snow, and debris. Dirt, snow, or foreign
substances on the surface may adversely
affect the sensing performance of the
camera.
NOTICE
ś Always keep the front view camera
sensor clean and free of dirt and
debris.
ś Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the front view camera
sensor. If the sensor is forcibly
moved out of proper alignment, FCA
system may not operate correctly.
In this case, a warning message may
not be displayed. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Use only genuine HYUNDAI parts to
repair or replace a damaged sensor.
6-52
ś NEVER install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, nor
tint the front windshield.
ś NEVER locate any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the system.
ś Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera out of water.
ś NEVER disassemble the camera
assembly, nor apply any impact on
the camera assembly.
If the sensor is forcibly moved out
of proper alignment, FCA system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. Have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may offset the system
warning sounds.
Information
Have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer when:
ś The windshield glass is replaced.
ś The front view camera or related parts
are repaired or removed.
06
Warning Message And Warning
Light
System Malfunction
OQX069053L
OQX069054L
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system disabled. Camera obscured
When the sensor is contaminated due
to external environment such as snow,
rain or foreign substances, FCA system
operation may stop temporarily. If this
occurs, a warning message will appear
on the LCD display. In order for FCA
system to operate properly, remove
any dirt, snow or debris and clean the
camera sensor cover before the system
operation.
FCA may not properly operate in an area
(e.g. open terrain), where any substances
are not detected after turning ON the
engine.
WARNING
Depending on the driving, traffic, road
or weather condition, FCA system
may not activate properly without the
warning message displayed.
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system
ś When FCA is not working properly,
FCA warning light ( ) will illuminate
and the warning message will appear
for a few seconds. After the message
disappears, the master warning light
( ) will illuminate. In this case, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś FCA warning message may appear
along with the illumination of the
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
warning light and FCA is automatically
deactivated.
WARNING
ś FCA is only a supplemental system
for the driver's convenience. The
driver should hold the responsibility
to control the vehicle operation. Do
not solely depend on FCA system.
Rather, maintain a safe braking
distance, and, if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce the driving
speed.
ś In certain instances and under
certain driving conditions, FCA
system may activate unintentionally.
This initial warning message appears
on the LCD display with a warning
chime.
6-53
While Driving
ś
ś
ś
ś
ś
ś
ś
Also, in certain instances the front
view camera recognition system
may not detect the vehicle ahead.
FCA system may not activate and
the warning message will not be
displayed.
If there is a malfunction with FCA
system, the Forward Collision
avoidance assist system is not
applied even though the braking
system is operating normally.
If the vehicle in front stops suddenly,
you may have less control of the
brake system. Therefore, always keep
a safe distance between your vehicle
and the vehicle in front of you.
FCA system may activate during
braking and the vehicle may stop
suddenly shifting loose objects
toward the passengers. Always keep
loose objects secured.
FCA system may not activate if the
driver applies the brake pedal to
avoid a collision.
The brake control may be
insufficient, possibly causing a
collision, if a vehicle in front abruptly
stops. Always pay extreme caution.
Occupants may get injured, if the
vehicle abruptly stops by activated
FCA system. Pay extreme caution.
Even if there is any problem in FCA
system's brake control function,
general braking performance will
operate normally. In this case,
the brake control function which
operates when the collision is
imminent will not activate.
6-54
WARNING
ś FCA system operates only to detect
vehicles in front of the vehicle.
ś FCA system does not operate when
the vehicle is in reverse.
ś FCA system is not designed to detect
other objects on the road such as
animals.
ś FCA system does not detect vehicles
in the opposite lane.
ś FCA system does not detect cross
traffic vehicles that are approaching.
ś FCA system cannot detect the
driver approaching the side view of
a parked vehicle (for example on a
dead end street.)
In these cases, you must maintain a
safe braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce the
driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance.
Limitations of the System
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system is designed to monitor the
vehicle ahead in the roadway through
camera recognition to warn the driver
that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
In certain situations, the camera may
not be able to detect the vehicle ahead.
In these cases, FCA system may not
operate normally. The driver must
pay careful attention in the following
situations where FCA operation may be
limited.
06
Detecting Vehicles
The sensor may be limited when:
ś The camera is blocked with a foreign
object or debris
ś The camera lens is contaminated due
to tinted, filmed or coated windshield,
damaged glass, or stuck of foreign
matter (sticker, bug, etc.) on the glass
ś Inclement weather such as heavy rain
or snow obscures the field of view of
the camera
ś The camera sensor recognition is
limited
ś The camera does not recognize the
entire vehicle in front.
ś The camera is damaged.
ś It is dark outside such as when the
headlamps are not on at night or the
vehicle is going through a tunnel.
ś There is a shadow is on the road by a
median strip, trees, etc.
ś The vehicle drives through a tollgate.
ś The rear part of the vehicle in front is
not normally visible. (the vehicle turns
in other direction or the vehicle is
overturned.)
ś The vehicle in front is too small to be
detected (for example a motorcycle or
a bicycle, etc.)
ś The vehicle in front is an oversized
vehicle or trailer that is too big to be
detected by the camera recognition
system (for example a tractor trailer,
etc.)
ś The camera's field of view is not well
illuminated (either too dark or too
much reflection or too much backlight
that obscures the field of view)
ś The vehicle in front does not have
their rear lights properly turned ON or
their rear lights are unusually located.
ś The outside brightness changes
suddenly, for example when entering
or exiting a tunnel
ś When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road
ś The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare
ś The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
ś The vehicle in front is driving
erratically
ś The vehicle is on unpaved or uneven
rough surfaces, or road with sudden
gradient changes.
ś The vehicle drives inside a building,
such as a basement parking lot
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
ś The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a speed
bump
ś The vehicle in front is moving
vertically to the driving direction
ś The vehicle in front is stopped
vertically
ś The vehicle in front is driving towards
your vehicle or reversing
ś You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front circles
6-55
While Driving
OQX069051
ś Driving on a curve
The performance of FCA system may
be limited when driving on a curved
road.
On curved roads, the other vehicle
on the same lane is not recognized
and FCA system's performance may
be degraded. This may result in
unnecessary alarm or braking or no
alarm or braking when necessary.
Also, in certain instances the front
camera recognition system may not
detect the vehicle traveling on a
curved road.
In these cases, the driver must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
6-56
OQX069052
FCA system may recognize a vehicle
in the next lane when driving on a
curved road.
In this case, the system may
unnecessarily alarm the driver and
apply the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving. If
necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
Also, when necessary depress
the accelerator pedal to prevent
the system from unnecessarily
decelerating your vehicle.
Check to be sure that the road
conditions permit safe operation of
FCA.
06
OQX059032L
ś Driving on a slope
The performance of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may be
decreased while driving upward or
downward on a slope.
The front camera recognition may not
detect the vehicle or pedestrian in
front.
This may result in unnecessary alarm
and braking when necessary.
When FCA suddenly recognizes the
vehicle in front while passing over
a slope, you may experience sharp
deceleration.
Always keep your eyes forward while
driving upward or downward on a
slope, and, if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain a safe
distance.
OQX059033L
ś Changing lanes
When a vehicle changes lanes in
front of you, FCA system may not
immediately detect the vehicle,
especially if the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
OQX059034L
When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a stopped vehicle in front of you
merges out of the lane, FCA system
may not immediately detect the new
vehicle that is now in front of you. In
this case, you must maintain a safe
braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
6-57
While Driving
WARNING
OQX061085
ś Detecting the vehicle in front of you
If the vehicle in front of you has cargo
that extends rearward from the cab,
or when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance, additional
special attention is required. FCA
system may not be able to detect the
cargo extending from the vehicle. In
these instances, you must maintain
a safe braking distance from the
rearmost object, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
ś Use extreme caution when the
vehicle in front of you has cargo that
extends rearward from the cab, or
when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance.
ś FCA system is designed to help
detect and monitor the vehicle ahead
in the roadway through camera
recognition. It is not designed to
detect bicycles, motorcycles, or
smaller wheeled objects such as
luggage bags, shopping carts, or
strollers.
ś Never try to test the operation of FCA
system. Doing so may cause severe
injury or death.
ś Have your vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer when
the windshield glass or camera is
replaced.
Information
In some instances, FCA system
may be cancelled when subjected to
electromagnetic interference.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
6-58
06
)25:$5'&2//,6,21ǘ$92,'$1&($66,67ǣ)&$Ǥ6<67(0ǘ
6(1625)86,21ǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system is designed to help detect and
monitor the vehicle ahead or detect a
pedestrian (if equipped) in the roadway
through front view camera recognition
and front radar signals to warn the
driver that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
System Setting and Activation
System Setting
WARNING
Take the following precautions when
using Forward Collision-avoidance
Assist system:
ś This system is only a supplemental
system and it is not intended to,
nor does it replace the need for
extreme care and attention of
the driver. The sensing range and
objects detectable by the sensors
are limited. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
ś NEVER drive too fast in accordance
with the road conditions or while
cornering.
ś Always drive cautiously to prevent
unexpected and sudden situations
from occurring. Forward CollisionAvoidance system may not always
stop the vehicle completely and
is only intended to help mitigate a
collision that is imminent.
OTMA058186
ś Setting Forward Safety function
The driver can activate FCA by placing
the ignition switch to the ON position
and by selecting:
œ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFHƟ
Forward Safety’
- ,I\RXVHOHFWŕ$FWLYH$VVLVWŖ)&$
system activates. FCA produces
warning messages and warning
alarms in accordance with the
collision risk levels. Braking assist will
be applied in accordance with the
collision risk.
- If you select ‘Warning Only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. Braking assist
will not be applied in this setting.
- If you select ‘Off’, FCA system
deactivates.
6-59
While Driving
The warning light illuminates
on the LCD display, when you
cancel FCA system.
The driver can monitor FCA ON/OFF
status on the LCD display. Also, the
warning light illuminates when the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) is turned
off. If the warning light remains ON
when FCA is activated, we recommend
that you have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The options for the initial Forward
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal:
When this option is selected, the
initial Forward Collision Warning is
activated sensitively. If you feel the
warning activates too early, set the
Forward Collision Warning to ‘Late’.
Even though, ‘Normal’ is selected if
the front vehicle suddenly stops the
initial warning activation time may not
seem fast.
- Late:
When this option is selected, the initial
Forward Collision Warning is activated
later than normal. This setting reduces
the amount of distance between
the vehicle ahead before the initial
warning occurs.
Select ‘Late’ when traffic is light and
when driving speed is slow.
OQX069078N
ś Setting Warning Timing
The driver can select the initial
warning activation time on the LCD
display.
*RWRWKHœ8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
$VVLVWDQFHƟ:DUQLQJ7LPLQJƟ
Normal/Late’.
6-60
Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before changing
the warning timing.
06
Prerequisite for Activation
Prerequisite for activation FCA gets ready
to be activated, when ‘Active Assist’ or
‘Warning Only’ under Forward Safety is
selected in on the LCD display, and when
the following prerequisites are satisfied.
- The ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
is on.
- Driving speed exceeds approximately
6 MPH (10 km/h). (FCA is only
activated within a certain speed
range.)
- The system detects a pedestrian or
a vehicle in front, which may collide
with your vehicle. (FCA may not be
activated or may sound a warning
alarm in accordance with the driving
situation or vehicle condition.)
FCA Warning Message and
System Control
FCA produces warning messages
and warning alarms in accordance
with the collision risk levels, such
as abrupt stopping of the vehicle in
front, insufficient braking distance, or
pedestrian detection. Also, it controls the
brakes in accordance with the collision
risk levels.
Collision Warning (First Warning)
WARNING
ś Completely stop the vehicle on a safe
location before operating the switch
on the steering wheel to activate/
deactivate FCA system.
ś FCA automatically activates upon
placing the ignition switch to the ON
position. The driver can deactivate
FCA by canceling the system setting
on the LCD display.
ś FCA automatically deactivates
upon canceling the ESC (Electronic
Stability Control). When the ESC is
canceled, FCA cannot be activated
on the LCD display.
OQX069081L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the engine
management system to help decelerate
the vehicle.
- Your vehicle speed may decelerate
moderately.
- FCA system limitedly controls the
brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision.
- If you select ‘Warning only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. You should
control the brakes directly because
The FCA system will not control the
brakes.
6-61
While Driving
Emergency Braking
(Second Warning)
CAUTION
OQX059030L
This warning message appears on the
LCD display with a warning chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the engine
management system to help decelerate
the vehicle.
- FCA system limitedly controls the
brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision. The brake control
is maximized just before a collision.
- If you select ‘Warning only’, FCA
system activates and produces only
warning alarms in accordance with
the collision risk levels. You should
control the brakes directly because
The FCA system will not control the
brakes.
Brake Operation
ś In an urgent situation, the braking
system enters into the ready status for
prompt reaction against the driver’s
depressing the brake pedal.
ś FCA provides additional braking
power for optimum braking
performance, when the driver
depresses the brake pedal.
ś The braking control is automatically
deactivated, when the driver sharply
depresses the accelerator pedal, or
when the driver abruptly operates the
steering wheel.
ś FCA braking control is automatically
canceled, when risk factors disappear.
6-62
The driver should always use extreme
caution while operating the vehicle,
whether or not there is a warning
message or alarm from FCA system.
ś After the brake control is activated,
the driver must immediately depress
the brake pedal and check the
surroundings. The brake activation
by the system lasts for about 2
seconds.
ś If any other warning sound such as
seat belt warning chime is already
generated, Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system
warning may not sound.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may prevent occupants
from hearing the system warning
sounds.
WARNING
The FCA braking control cannot
completely stop the vehicle nor avoid
all collisions. The driver should hold the
responsibility to safely drive and control
the vehicle.
WARNING
FCA system logic operates within
certain parameters, such as the
distance from the vehicle or pedestrian
ahead, the speed of the vehicle ahead,
and the driver's vehicle speed. Certain
conditions such as inclement weather
and road conditions may affect the
operation of FCA system.
WARNING
Never deliberately drive dangerously to
activate the system.
06
NOTICE
FCA Sensor
Front view camera
OQX059031L
Front radar
OQX051144
In order for FCA system to operate
properly, always make sure the sensor
cover or sensor is clean and free of dirt,
snow, and debris.
Dirt, snow, or foreign substances on the
sensor cover or sensor may adversely
affect the sensing performance of the
sensor.
ś Do not apply license plate frame or
foreign objects such as a bumper
sticker or a bumper guard near the
radar sensor. Doing so may adversely
affect the sensing performance of
the radar.
ś Always keep the radar sensor and
cover clean and free of dirt and
debris.
ś Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized
water directly on the sensor or
sensor cover.
ś Be careful not to apply unnecessary
force on the radar sensor or sensor
cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved
out of proper alignment, FCA system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around the
radar sensor, FCA system may not
operate properly. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Use only genuine HYUNDAI parts to
repair or replace a damaged sensor
or sensor cover. Do not apply paint to
the sensor cover.
6-63
While Driving
NOTICE
ś NEVER install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, nor
tint the front windshield.
ś NEVER locate any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the system.
ś Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera out of water.
ś NEVER disassemble the camera
assembly, nor apply any impact on
the camera assembly.
If the sensor is forcibly moved out
of proper alignment, FCA system
may not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may not
be displayed. Have the vehicle be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
ś Playing the vehicle audio system at
high volume may offset the system
warning sounds.
Information
Have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer when:
ś The windshield glass is replaced.
ś The sensor cover or sensor gets
damaged or replaced.
6-64
Warning Message And Warning
Light
OOS057080L
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system disabled. Radar blocked
When the sensor cover is blocked
with dirt, snow, or debris, FCA system
operation may stop temporarily. If this
occurs, a warning message will appear
on the LCD display. Remove any dirt,
snow, or debris and clean the radar
sensor cover before operating FCA
system.
FCA may not properly operate in an area
(e.g. open terrain), where any substances
are not detected after turning ON the
engine.
06
System Malfunction
WARNING
OQX069053L
Check Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system
ś When FCA is not working properly,
FCA warning light ( ) will illuminate
and the warning message will appear
for a few seconds. After the message
disappears, the master warning light
( ) will illuminate. In this case, have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś FCA warning message may appear
along with the illumination of the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) warning
light.
ś FCA is only a supplemental system
for the driver’s convenience. The
driver should hold the responsibility
to control the vehicle operation. Do
not solely depend on the FCA system.
Rather, maintain a safe braking
distance, and, if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce the driving
speed.
ś In certain instances and under
certain driving conditions, FCA
system may activate prematurely.
This initial warning message appears
on the LCD display with a warning
chime.
Also, in certain instances the front
radar sensor or camera recognition
system may not detect the vehicle
or pedestrian ahead. FCA system
may not activate and the warning
message will not be displayed.
ś If there is a malfunction with FCA
system, the Forward Collision
avoidance assist system is not
applied even though the braking
system is operating normally.
ś If the vehicle in front stops suddenly,
you may have less control of the
brake system. Therefore, always keep
a safe distance between your vehicle
and the vehicle in front of you.
ś FCA system may activate during
braking and the vehicle may stop
suddenly shifting loose objects
toward the passengers. Always keep
loose objects secured.
6-65
While Driving
ś FCA system may not activate if the
driver applies the brake pedal to
avoid a collision.
ś The brake control may be
insufficient, possibly causing a
collision, if a vehicle in front abruptly
stops. Always pay extreme caution.
ś Occupants may get injured, if the
vehicle abruptly stops by activated
FCA system. Pay extreme caution.
WARNING
ś FCA system operates only to detect
vehicles or pedestrians in front of the
vehicle.
ś FCA system does not operate when
the vehicle is in reverse.
ś FCA system is not designed to detect
other objects on the road such as
animals.
ś FCA system does not detect vehicles
in the opposite lane.
ś FCA system does not detect cross
traffic vehicles that are approaching.
ś FCA system cannot detect the
driver approaching the side view of
a parked vehicle (for example on a
dead end street.)
In these cases, you must maintain a
safe braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce the
driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance.
6-66
Limitations of the System
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system is designed to help monitor
the vehicle ahead or a pedestrian on
the roadway through radar signals and
camera recognition to warn the driver
that a collision is imminent, and if
necessary, apply emergency braking.
In certain situations, the radar sensor or
the camera may not be able to detect
the vehicle or pedestrian ahead. In these
cases, FCA system may not operate
normally. The driver must pay careful
attention in the following situations
where the FCA operation may be limited.
Detecting Vehicles
The sensor may be limited when:
ś The front view camera or radar sensor
is blocked with a foreign object or
debris
ś Inclement weather such as heavy rain
or snow obscures the field of view of
the radar sensor or camera
ś There is interference by
electromagnetic waves
ś There is severe irregular reflection
from the radar sensor
ś The radar/camera sensor recognition
is limited
ś The vehicle in front is too small to be
detected (for example a motorcycle or
a bicycle, etc.)
ś The vehicle in front is an oversize
vehicle or trailer that is too big to be
detected by the camera recognition
system (for example a tractor trailer,
etc.)
06
ś The driver's field of view is not well
illuminated (either too dark or too
much reflection or too much backlight
that obscures the field of view)
ś The vehicle in front does not have
their rear lights properly turned ON
ś The outside brightness changes
suddenly, for example when entering
or exiting a tunnel
ś Light coming from a street light or an
oncoming vehicle is reflected on a wet
road surface such as a puddle in the
road
ś The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare
ś The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
ś The vehicle in front is driving
erratically
ś The vehicle drives through a
construction area, on an unpaved
road, or above metal materials, such
as a railway
ś The vehicle drives inside a building,
such as a basement parking lot
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
ś The vehicle in front is moving
vertically to the driving direction
ś The vehicle in front is stopped
vertically
ś The vehicle in front is driving towards
your vehicle or reversing
OQX069051
ś Driving on a curve
The performance of FCA system may
be limited when driving on a curved
road.
In certain instances on a curved road,
FCA system may activate prematurely.
Also, in certain instances the front
radar sensor or camera recognition
system may not detect the vehicle
traveling on a curved road.
In these cases, the driver must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
6-67
While Driving
OQX069052
FCA system may recognize a vehicle
in the next lane when driving on a
curved road.
In this case, the system may
unnecessarily alarm the driver and
apply the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving. If
necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
Also, when necessary depress
the accelerator pedal to prevent
the system from unnecessarily
decelerating your vehicle.
6-68
OQX059032L
ś Driving on a slope
The performance of Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist system may be
decreased while driving upward or
downward on a slope.
The front camera recognition may not
detect the vehicle or pedestrian in
front.
This may result in unnecessary alarm
and braking when necessary.
When FCA suddenly recognizes the
vehicle in front while passing over
a slope, you may experience sharp
deceleration.
Always keep your eyes forward while
driving upward or downward on a
slope, and, if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain distance.
06
OQX059033L
ś Changing lanes
When a vehicle changes lanes in
front of you, FCA system may not
immediately detect the vehicle,
especially if the vehicle changes
lanes abruptly. In this case, you must
maintain a safe braking distance, and
if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
OQX061086
ś Detecting the vehicle in front of you
If the vehicle in front of you has cargo
that extends rearward from the cab,
or when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance, additional
special attention is required. FCA
system may not be able to detect the
cargo extending from the vehicle. In
these instances, you must maintain
a safe braking distance from the
rearmost object, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
OQX059034L
When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a stopped vehicle in front of you
merges out of the lane, FCA system
may not immediately detect the new
vehicle that is now in front of you. In
this case, you must maintain a safe
braking distance, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
6-69
While Driving
Detecting Pedestrians (if equipped)
The sensor may be limited when:
ś The pedestrian is not fully detected
by the camera recognition system, for
example, if the pedestrian is leaning
over or is not fully walking upright
ś The pedestrian is moving very quickly
or appears abruptly in the camera
detection area
ś The pedestrian is wearing clothing
that easily blends into the
background, making it difficult to be
detected by the camera recognition
system
ś The outside lighting is too bright (e.g.
when driving in bright sunlight or
in sun glare) or too dark (e.g. when
driving on a dark rural road at night)
ś It is difficult to detect and distinguish
the pedestrian from other objects in
the surroundings, for example, when
there is a group of pedestrians or a
large crowd
ś There is an item similar to a person's
body structure
ś The pedestrian is small
ś The pedestrian has impaired mobility
ś The sensor recognition is limited
ś The radar sensor or camera is blocked
with a foreign object or debris
ś Inclement weather such as heavy rain
or snow obscures the field of view of
the radar sensor or camera
ś When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road
ś The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare
ś The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
6-70
Information
In some instances, FCA system
may be canceled when subjected to
electromagnetic interference.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
WARNING
ś Do not use Forward Collisionavoidance Assist (FCA) system when
towing a vehicle. Application of
the FCA system while towing may
adversely affect the safety of your
vehicle or the towing vehicle.
ś Use extreme caution when the
vehicle in front of you has cargo that
extends rearward from the cab, or
when the vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance.
ś FCA system is designed to help
detect and monitor the vehicle
ahead or detect a pedestrian in
the roadway through radar signals
and camera recognition. It is
not designed to detect bicycles,
motorcycles, or smaller wheeled
objects such as luggage bags,
shopping carts, or strollers.
ś Never try to test the operation of FCA
system. Doing so may cause severe
injury or death.
06
/$1(.((3,1*$66,67ǣ/.$Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
WARNING
OQX059031L
Lane Keeping Assist system helps detect
lane markers on the road with a camera
at the front windshield, and assists the
driver's steering to help keep the vehicle
between lanes.
When the system detects the vehicle
straying from its lane, it alerts the driver
with a visual and audible warning, while
applying a slight countersteering torque,
to try to help prevent the vehicle from
moving out of its lane.
WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system is not
a substitute for safe driving practices,
but a convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver to always
be aware of the surrounding and steer
the vehicle.
Take the following precautions when
using Lane Keeping Assist system:
ś Do not steer the steering wheel
suddenly when the steering wheel is
being assisted by the system.
ś LKA system helps to prevent the
driver from moving out of the lane
unintentionally by assisting the
driver's steering. However, the driver
should not solely rely on the system
but always pay attention on the
steering wheel to stay in the lane.
ś The operation of LKA system can
be canceled or not work properly
according to road condition and
surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
ś Do not disassemble LKA system
camera temporarily to tint the
window or attach any types of
coatings and accessories. If you
disassemble the camera and
assemble it again, take your vehicle
to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked for
calibration.
ś When you replace the windshield
glass, LKA system camera or related
parts of the steering wheel, take your
vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and have the system checked
for calibration.
ś The system detects lane lines and
controls the steering wheel by a
camera, therefore, if the lane lines
are hard to detect, the system may
not work properly.
Please refer to "Limitations of the
system".
6-71
While Driving
ś Do not remove or damage the related
parts of LKA system.
ś You may not hear a warning sound
of LKA system because of excessive
audio sound.
ś Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light such as
mirrors, white paper, etc. The system
may malfunction if the sunlight is
reflected.
ś Always have your hands on the
steering wheel while LKA system is
activated. If you continue to drive
with your hands off the steering
wheel after the "Keep hands on
steering wheel" warning message
appears, the system will turn off
automatically.
ś The steering wheel is not
continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher speed
when leaving a lane the vehicle
may not be able to be controlled by
the system. The driver must always
follow the speed limit when using
the system.
ś If you attach objects to the steering
wheel, the system may not assist
steering or the hands off alarm may
not work properly. When you tow a
trailer, make sure that you turn off
LKA system.
6-72
LKA System Operation
OQX069024L
To activate/deactivate LKA system:
With the ignition switch in the ON
position, press LKA system button
located on the instrument panel on the
left hand side of the steering wheel.
The indicator in the cluster display will
initially illuminate white. This indicates
LKA system is in the READY but NOT
ENABLED state.
The color of indicator will
change depending on the
condition of LKA system.
- White: Sensor does not detect lane
lines or vehicle speed is under 40
MPH (64 km/h).
- Green: Sensor detects lane lines and
the system is able to control vehicle
steering.
06
LKA System Operation
Lane marker undetected
OQX069025L
OQX069025L
ś To see LKA system screen on the LCD
display in the cluster, select Drive
Assist mode ( ). For more details,
refer to "LCD Display Modes" in
chapter 4.
ś When both lane lines are detected
and all the conditions to activate LKA
system are satisfied, a green steering
wheel indicator will illuminate and
LKA system indicator light will change
from white to green. This indicates
that LKA system is in the ENABLED
state and the steering wheel will be
able to be controlled.
WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist system is a system
to help prevent the driver from leaving
the lane. However, the driver should
not solely rely on the system but always
check the road conditions when driving.
Lane marker detected
OQX069081L
ś If the system detects a lane line, the
color changes from gray to white.
ś If the system detects the left lane line,
the left lane line color will change
from gray to white.
ś If the system detects the right lane
line, the right lane line color will
change from gray to white.
ś Both lane lines must be detected for
the system to fully activate.
6-73
While Driving
ś If your vehicle speed exceeds 40 MPH
(64 km/h) and LKA system button is
ON, the system is enabled. If your
vehicle departs from the projected
lane in front of you, LKA system
operates as follows:
Left lane departure warning
OAEE056129L
Keep hands on steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds while
LKA system is activated, the system will
warn the driver.
OQX069026L
Information
Right lane departure warning
If the steering wheel is held very lightly
the message may still appear because the
LKA system may not recognize that driver
has their hands on the wheel.
WARNING
OQX069027L
A visual warning appears on the cluster
LCD display. Either the left lane line or
the right lane line in the cluster LCD
display will blink depending on which
direction the vehicle is veering.
If the steering wheel appears, the system
will help control the vehicle’s steering
to prevent the vehicle from crossing the
lane line.
6-74
The warning message may appear
late according to road conditions.
Therefore, always have your hands on
the steering wheel while driving.
06
Warning Light and Message
OOS057083L
Driver's grasp not detected.
LKA system will be disabled temporarily
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message "Keep hands on steering
wheel", the system will not control the
steering wheel and warn the driver only
when the driver crosses the lane lines.
However, if the driver has their hands on
the steering wheel again, the system will
start controlling the steering wheel.
WARNING
ś The driver is responsible for accurate
steering.
ś Turn off the system in below
situations.
- In bad weather
- In bad road condition
- When the steering wheel needs
to be controlled by the driver
frequently.
Information
ś Even though the steering is assisted by
the system, the driver can still steer to
control the steering wheel.
ś The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted by
the system than when it is not.
OQX069028L
Check LKA system
If there is a problem with the system a
message will appear for a few seconds.
If the problem continues LKA system
failure indicator will illuminate.
LKA System Failure Indicator
LKA system failure indicator
(yellow) will illuminate if the
LKA system is not working
properly. Have your vehicle
checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
When there is a problem with the system
do one of the following:
ś Turn the system on after turning the
engine off and on again.
ś Check if the ignition switch is in the
ON position.
ś Check if the system is affected by the
weather. (ex: fog, heavy rain, etc.)
ś Check if there is foreign matter on the
camera lens.
If the problem is not solved, have your
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
6-75
While Driving
LKA system will not be in the ENABLED
state and the steering wheel will not be
assisted when:
ś The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on, the
steering wheel might be controlled.
ś The vehicle is not driven in the middle
of the lane when the system is turned
on or right after changing a lane.
ś ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
activated.
ś The vehicle is driven on a sharp curve.
ś Vehicle speed is below 40 MPH (60
km/h) and over 110 MPH (180 km/h).
ś The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
ś The vehicle brakes suddenly.
ś Only one lane line is detected.
ś The lane is very wide or narrow.
ś There are more than two lane lines on
the road. (e.g. construction area)
ś The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
6-76
Limitations of the System
LKA system may operate prematurely
even if the vehicle does not depart
from the intended lane, OR, LKA system
may not warn you if the vehicle leaves
the intended lane under the following
circumstances:
When the lane and road conditions are
poor
ś It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking from the road surface or the
lane marking is faded or not clearly
marked.
ś There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane line that
is inadvertently being detected by the
camera.
ś The lane line is merged or divided.
(e.g. tollgate)
ś The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
ś There are more than two lane lines on
the road in front of you.
ś The lane line is very thick or thin.
ś The lanes ahead are not visible due
to rain, snow, water on the road,
damaged or stained road surface, or
other factors.
ś The shadow is on the lane marker by a
median strip, trees, etc.
ś The lanes are incomplete or the area is
in a construction zone.
ś There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
ś The lane line in a tunnel is stained with
oil, etc.
06
When external condition is intervened
ś The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel or passing under a
bridge.
ś The brightness outside is too low such
as when the headlamps are not on at
night or the vehicle is going through a
tunnel or passing under a bridge.
ś There is a boundary structure in the
roadway such as a concrete barrier,
guardrail and reflector post that is
inadvertently being detected by the
camera.
ś When light coming from a street light
or an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in
the road.
ś The field of view in front is obstructed
by sun glare.
ś The lane suddenly disappears such as
at the intersection.
ś There is not enough distance between
you and the vehicle in front to be able
to detect the lane line or the vehicle
ahead is driving on the lane line.
ś Driving on a steep grade, over a hill, or
when driving on a curved road.
ś The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
ś The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high due to
direct sunlight.
When front visibility is poor
ś The windshield or the LKA system
camera lens is blocked with dirt or
debris.
ś The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed.
ś Placing objects on the dashboard, etc.
LKA System Function Change
The driver can change LKA to Lane
Departure Warning system or change
LKA system mode between Standard LKA
and Active LKA from the LCD display. Go
WRWKH 8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU$VVLVWDQFH
Ɵ$FWLYH/DQH.HHSLQJ$VVLVW/DQH
Keeping Assist/Lane Departure Warning.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
The Active LKA mode provides more
frequent steering wheel control in
comparison with the LKA mode. Active
LKA can help reduce the driver's fatigue
to assist the steering for maintaining the
vehicle in the middle of the lane.
Lane Keeping Assist
The LKA mode guides the driver to help
keep the vehicle within the lanes. It
rarely controls the steering wheel, when
the vehicle drives well inside the lanes.
However, it starts to control the steering
wheel, when the vehicle is about to
deviate out of the lanes.
Lane Departure Warning
LDW alerts the driver with a visual
warning and a warning alarm when the
system detects the vehicle departing
the lane. The steering wheel will not be
controlled.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
6-77
While Driving
'5,9(5$77(17,21:$51,1*ǣ'$:Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
Driver Attention Warning System is
designed as a safety feature to help
reduce drowsy or inattentive driving.
DAW displays a bar graph that is
intended to represent the driver's
attention and fatigue while driving.
Driver's Attention Level
System off
System Setting and Activation
System Setting
ś Driver Attention Warning system is
set to be on, when your vehicle is first
delivered to you from the factory.
ś To turn ON Driver Attention Warning
system, turn on the engine, and
WKHQVHOHFW 8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYHU
$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYHU$WWHQWLRQ:DUQLQJ
Ɵ,QDWWHQWLYH'ULYLQJ:DUQLQJŔRQWKH
LCD display.
ś The set-up of Driver Attention
Warning system will be maintained,
as selected, when the engine is restarted.
OIK057129N
Attentive driving
OIK057130L
Inattentive driving
OIK057131L
ś The driver can monitor their driving
conditions on the LCD display.
The DAW screen will appear when you
select the Drive Assist mode tab ( )
on the LCD display if the system is
activated. (For more information, refer
to "LCD Display Modes" in chapter 4.)
ś The driver's attention level is displayed
on the scale of 1 to 5. The lower the
number is, the more inattentive the
driver is.
6-78
06
ś The number decreases when the
driver does not take a break for a
certain period of time.
ś The number increases when the driver
attentively drives for a certain period
of time.
ś When the driver turns on the system
while driving, it displays 'Last Break
time' and level.
ś Driver Attention Warning system
operates again, when the driver
restarts driving.
System Standby
Take a Break
OIK057133N
OIK057132L
ś The "Consider taking a break"
message appears on the LCD display
and a warning sounds in order to
suggest the driver to take a break,
when the driver’s attention level is
below 1.
ś Driver Attention Warning system does
not suggest the driver to take a break,
when the total driving time is shorter
than 10 minutes.
Driver Attention Warning system
enters the ready status and displays
the 'Standby' screen in the following
situations.
- The camera does not detect the lanes.
- Driving speed remains over 112 MPH
(180 km/h).
System Malfunction
Resetting the System
ś The last break time is set to 00:00 and
the driver's attention level is set to 5
(very attentive) when the driver resets
Driver Attention Warning system.
ś Driver Attention Warning system
resets in the following situations.
- The engine is turned OFF.
- The driver unfastens the seat belt
and then opens the driver's door.
- The vehicle is stopped for more
than 10 minutes.
OIK057134N
Check Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system
When the warning message appears, the
system is not working properly. In this
case, have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-79
While Driving
WARNING
ś Driver Attention Warning system
is not a substitute for safe driving
practices, but a convenience
function only. It is the responsibility
of the driver to always drive
cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
ś The system may suggest a break
according to the driver's driving
pattern or habits even if the driver
doesn't feel fatigue.
ś The driver, who feels fatigued,
should take a break, even though
there is no break suggestion by
Driver Attention Warning system.
NOTICE
The Driver Attention Warning system
utilizes the camera sensor on the front
windshield for its operation. To keep the
camera sensor in the best condition,
you should observe the followings:
ś NEVER install any accessories or
stickers on the front windshield, nor
tint the front windshield.
ś NEVER locate any reflective objects
(i.e. white paper, mirror) over the
dashboard. Any light reflection
may cause a malfunction of Driver
Attention Warning system.
ś Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera sensor out of water.
ś NEVER arbitrarily disassemble the
camera assembly, nor apply any
impact on the camera assembly.
6-80
CAUTION
Driver Attention Warning system may
not properly operate with limited
alerting in the following situations:
ś The lane detection performance is
limited. (For more information, refer
to "Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)" in this
chapter.)
ś The vehicle is violently driven or
is abruptly turned for obstacle
avoidance (e.g. construction area,
other vehicles, fallen objects, bumpy
road).
ś Forward drivability of the vehicle is
severely undermined (possibly due
to wide variation in tire pressures,
uneven tire wear-out, toe-in/toe-out
alignment).
ś The vehicle drives on a curvy road.
ś The vehicle drives on a bumpy road.
ś The vehicle drives through a windy
area.
ś The vehicle is controlled by the
following driving assist systems:
- Lane Keeping Assist system
- Forward Collision-avoidance Assist
system
CAUTION
Playing the vehicle audio system at high
volume may offset Driver Attention
Warning system warning sounds.
06
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert function
provides the alert whether the leading
vehicle drives away or not, while a stop.
System Setting and Operating
Conditions
ś Selecting Driver Attention Warning
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert can be
activated from Users mode in the cluster
LCD display by following the procedure
below.
1. Set the ignition switch to the ON
position.
2. 6HOHFW 8VHU6HWWLQJVƟ'ULYLQJ
$VVLVWDQFHƟ'ULYHU$WWHQWLRQ:DUQLQJ
Ɵ/HDGLQJ9HKLFOH'HSDUWXUH$OHUW
in cluster LCD display. Deselect the
setting to turn off the system.
ś If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the last
setting.
Alert Announcement
WARNING
ś Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
function is only a convenient
auxiliary for the driver. The system
can’t announce the alarm when a
leading vehicle departs in real time.
ś The driver must check and determine
real conditions and then start to
drive even if the system does not
notify that the leading vehicle is
departing.
CAUTION
ś The Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
function works in conjunction with
the front camera on the vehicle
for better performance. For more
information of the front camera,
refer to "Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)".
ś This system may not provide Vehicle
Departure Alert or not properly
operate in the following situations:
- Leading pedestrian(s) in front of
vehicle
- Leading cut-in vehicle(s)
- Leading vehicle’s quick departure
- Stop on speed bump or steep hill
- Stop on a right-turn junction or a
curved road
- Stop on shoulder road, rest area,
parking lot
OQX069080N
The system notifies the driver with the
alert message and a warning sound
when the leading vehicle drives away
while a stop.
6-81
While Driving
CRUISE CONTROL
Cruise Control Operation
ś Do not use when:
- Driving in heavy traffic or when
traffic conditions make it difficult
to drive at a constant speed
- Driving on rainy, icy, or snowcovered roads
- Driving on hilly or windy roads
- Driving in windy areas
- Driving with limited view (possibly
due to bad weather such as fog,
snow, rain and sandstorm)
OIK057157N
1. Cruise indicator
2. SET indicator
The Cruise Control system allows you to
drive at speeds above 20 MPH (30 km/h)
without depressing the accelerator
pedal.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
ś Always set the vehicle speed under
the speed limit.
ś If the Cruise Control is left on,
(cruise indicator light in the
instrument cluster is illuminated)
the Cruise Control can be activated
unintentionally. Keep the Cruise
Control system off (cruise indicator
light OFF) when the Cruise Control
is not in use, to avoid inadvertently
setting a speed.
ś Use the Cruise Control system only
when traveling on open highways in
good weather.
ś Do not use the Cruise Control when it
may be unsafe to keep the vehicle at
a constant speed.
6-82
Information
ś During normal cruise control
operation, when the SET switch is
activated or reactivated after applying
the brakes, the cruise control will
energize after approximately 3 seconds.
This delay is normal.
ś Before activating the cruise control
function, the system will check to verify
that the brake switch is operating
normally. Depress the brake pedal at
least once after turning ON the ignition
or starting the engine.
06
To Set Cruise Control Speed
To Increase Cruise Control Speed
OQX069029N
OQX069072L
1. Press the CRUISE button on the
steering wheel to turn the system on.
The cruise indicator will illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed,
which must be more than 20 MPH (30
km/h).
ś Push the toggle switch up (RES+)
and hold it, while monitoring the SET
speed on the instrument cluster.
The set speed will increase by 5 MPH
(8 km/h) increments.
Release the toggle switch when
the desired speed is shown and the
vehicle will accelerate to that speed.
ś Push the toggle switch up (RES+) and
release it immediately. The cruising
speed will increase 1.0 MPH (1.6
km/h) each time the toggle switch is
operated in this manner.
ś Depress the accelerator pedal. When
the vehicle attains the desired speed,
push the toggle switch down (SET-).
OQX069071L
To Decrease Cruise Control Speed
3. Push the toggle switch down (SET-),
and release it.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
Information
On a steep slope, the vehicle may slightly
slow down or speed up, while driving
uphill or downhill.
OQX069071L
ś Push the toggle switch down (SET-)
and hold it.Your vehicle will gradually
slow down. Release the toggle switch
at the speed you want to maintain.
6-83
While Driving
ś Push the toggle switch down (SET-)
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will decrease 1.0 MPH
(1.6 km/h) each time the toggle switch
is operated in this manner.
ś Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the
vehicle attains the desired speed, push
the toggle switch down (SET-).
To Temporarily Accelerate with the
Cruise Control ON
Depress the accelerator pedal. When you
take your foot off the accelerator, the
vehicle will return to the previously set
speed.
If you push the toggle switch down (SET-)
at the increased speed, the Cruise Control
will maintain the increased speed.
variable transmission vehicle)
Information
Each of the above actions will cancel
Cruise Control operation (the "SET"
indicator in the instrument cluster will go
off), but only pressing the CRUISE button
will turn the system off. If you wish to
resume Cruise Control operation, push the
toggle switch up (RES+) located on your
steering wheel. You will return to your
previously preset speed, unless the system
was turned off using the CRUISE button.
To Resume Preset Cruising Speed
Cruise Control Will be Canceled
When:
OQX069072L
Push the toggle switch up (RES+). If the
vehicle speed is over 20 MPH (30 km/h),
the vehicle will resume the preset speed.
OQX069075N
ś Depressing the brake pedal.
ś Pressing the CANCEL button located
on the steering wheel.
ś Pressing the CRUISE button. Both the
cruise indicator and the "SET" indicator
will turn OFF.
ś Moving the shift lever into N (Neutral).
(for automatic transmission/dual
clutch transmission vehicle)
ś Decreasing the vehicle speed to less
than approximately 20 MPH (30 km/h).
ś The ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
operating.
ś Downshifting to the 2nd gear in
manual shift mode. (for intelligent
6-84
To Turn Cruise Control Off
OQX069029N
ś Press the CRUISE button (the cruise
indicator light will go off).
ś Turn the vehicle OFF.
06
63(&,$/'5,9,1*&21',7,216
Hazardous Driving Conditions
When hazardous driving elements
are encountered such as water, snow,
ice, mud and sand, take the below
suggestions:
ś Drive cautiously and keep a longer
braking distance.
ś Avoid abrupt braking or steering.
ś When your vehicle is stuck in
snow, mud, or sand, use second
gear. Accelerate slowly to avoid
unnecessary wheel spin.
ś Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or other
non-slip materials under the wheels to
provide additional traction while the
vehicle becomes stuck in ice, snow,
or mud.
WARNING
Downshifting with an intelligent
variable transmission while driving on
slippery surfaces can cause an accident.
The sudden change in tire speed could
cause the tires to skid. Be careful when
downshifting on slippery surfaces.
Rocking the Vehicle
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle to
free it from snow, sand, or mud, first turn
the steering wheel right and left to clear
the area around your front wheels. Then,
shift back and forth between R (Reverse)
and a forward gear.
Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and do
not race the engine.
To prevent transmission wear, wait until
the wheels stop spinning before shifting
gears. Release the accelerator pedal
while shifting, and press lightly on the
accelerator pedal while the transmission
is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in
forward and reverse directions causes a
rocking motion that may free the vehicle.
WARNING
If the vehicle is stuck and excessive
wheel spin occurs, the temperature
of the tires can increase very quickly.
If the tires become damaged, a tire
blow out or tire explosion can occur.
This condition is dangerous - you and
others may be injured. Do not attempt
this procedure if people or objects are
anywhere near the vehicle.
If you attempt to free the vehicle, the
vehicle can overheat quickly, possibly
causing an engine compartment fire
or other damage. Try to avoid spinning
the wheels as much as possible to
prevent overheating of either the tires
or the engine. DO NOT allow the vehicle
to spin the wheels above 35 MPH (56
km/h).
Information
The ESC system must be turned OFF
before rocking the vehicle.
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking the
vehicle a few times, have the vehicle
pulled out by a tow vehicle to avoid
engine overheating, possible damage to
the transmission, and tire damage. See
"Towing" in chapter 7.
6-85
While Driving
Smooth Cornering
Avoid braking or gear changing in
corners, especially when roads are wet.
Ideally, corners should always be taken
under gentle acceleration.
Driving at Night
ś Tires should be properly maintained
with at least 2/32nds of an inch of
tread depth. If your tires do not have
enough tread, making a quick stop on
wet pavement can cause a skid and
possibly lead to an accident. See "Tire
Tread" in chapter 8.
ś Turn on your headlamps to make it
easier for others to see you.
ś Driving too fast through large puddles
can affect your brakes. If you must go
through puddles, try to drive through
them slowly.
ś If you believe your brakes may be wet,
apply them lightly while driving until
normal braking operation returns.
Night driving presents more hazards than
driving in the daylight. Here are some
important tips to remember:
ś Slow down and keep more distance
between you and other vehicles, as it
may be more difficult to see at night,
especially in areas where there may
not be any street lights.
ś Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glare
from other driver's headlamps.
ś Keep your headlamps clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlamps will make it much
more difficult to see at night.
ś Avoid staring directly at the
headlamps of oncoming vehicles. You
could be temporarily blinded, and it
will take several seconds for your eyes
to readjust to the darkness.
Hydroplaning
Driving in the Rain
Driving in Flooded Areas
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or on
slick pavement:
ś Slow down and allow extra following
distance. A heavy rainfall makes
it harder to see and increases the
distance needed to stop your vehicle.
ś Turn OFF your Cruise Control.
ś Replace your windshield wiper blades
when they show signs of streaking or
missing areas on the windshield.
6-86
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the water.
The best advice is SLOW DOWN when
the road is wet.
The risk of hydroplaning increases as
the depth of tire tread decreases, refer
to "Tire Tread" in chapter 8.
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel hub.
Drive through any water slowly. Allow
adequate stopping distance because
brake performance may be reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several
times while the vehicle is moving slowly.
06
Highway Driving
Tires
Adjust the tire inflation, as specified.
Under-inflation may overheat or damage
the tires.
Do not install worn-out or damaged tires,
which may reduce traction or adversely
affect vehicle handling. This could lead
to sudden tire failure that may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Information
Never over-inflate your tires above the
maximum inflation pressure, as specified
on your tires.
Fuel, Engine Coolant and Engine Oil
Driving at higher speeds on the highway
consumes more fuel and is less efficient
than driving at a slower, more moderate
speed. Maintain a moderate speed in
order to conserve fuel when driving on
the highway.
Be sure to check both the engine coolant
level and the engine oil before driving.
Drive Belt
A loose or damaged drive belt may
overheat the engine.
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover
Your multi-purpose passenger vehicle is
defined as a Sports Utility Vehicle (SUV).
SUV's have higher ground clearance
and a narrower track to make them
capable of performing in a wide variety
of off-road applications. The specific
design characteristics give them a higher
center of gravity than ordinary vehicles
making them more likely to roll over if
you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles
have a significantly higher rollover rate
than other types of vehicles. Due to this
risk, driver and passengers are strongly
recommended to buckle their seat belts.
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person
is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt.
There are steps that a driver can make
to reduce the risk of a rollover. If at all
possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt
maneuvers, do not load your vehicle
with heavy cargo on the roof, and never
modify your vehicle in any way.
WARNING
Utility vehicles have a significantly
higher rollover rate than other types of
vehicles. To prevent rollovers or loss of
control:
ś Take corners at slower speeds than
you would with a passenger vehicle.
ś Avoid sharp turns and abrupt
maneuvers.
ś Do not modify your vehicle in any
way that you would raise the center
of gravity.
ś Keep tires properly inflated.
ś Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof.
6-87
While Driving
WINTER DRIVING
The severe weather conditions of winter
quickly wear out tires and cause other
problems. To minimize winter driving
problems, you should take the following
suggestions:
Snow or Icy Conditions
You need to keep sufficient distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front of you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding, rapid
acceleration, sudden brake applications,
and sharp turns are potentially
very hazardous practices. During
deceleration, use engine braking to the
fullest extent. Sudden brake applications
on snowy or icy roads may cause the
vehicle to skid.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it
may be necessary to use snow tires or to
install tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment.
Some of the items you may want to carry
include tire chains, tow straps or chains,
a flashlight, emergency flares, sand, a
shovel, jumper cables, a window scraper,
gloves, ground cloth, coveralls, a blanket,
etc.
Snow Tires
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent in size
and type to the vehicle’s standard tires.
Otherwise, the safety and handling of
your vehicle may be adversely affected.
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle,
make sure to use radial tires of the same
size and load range as the original tires.
Mount snow tires on all four wheels
to balance your vehicle’s handling in
all weather conditions. The traction
provided by snow tires on dry roads
may not be as high as your vehicle's
original equipment tires. Check with
the tire dealer for maximum speed
recommendations.
6-88
Information
Do not install studded tires without
first checking local, state and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions against
their use.
Tire Chains
OQX079023
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them. Therefore
the use of snow tires is preferred over the
use of tire chains.
If the road and weather conditions
require the use of tire chains, be sure to
use tire chains that have been properly
selected for the size of tire on your
HYUNDAI vehicle.
Be sure to follow the guidelines and
installation instructions provided from
the tire chain manufacturer.
Damage to your vehicle caused by
improper tire chain use is not covered by
your vehicle manufacturer’s warranty.
06
WARNING
The use of tire chains may adversely
affect vehicle handling:
ś Drive less than 20 MPH (30 km/h)
or the chain manufacturer's
recommended speed limit,
whichever is lower.
ś Drive carefully and avoid bumps,
holes, sharp turns, and other road
hazards, which may cause the
vehicle to bounce.
ś Avoid sharp turns or locked wheel
braking.
Information
ś Install tire chains on both left and right
front tires. It should be noted that
installing tire chains on the tires will
provide a greater driving force, but will
not prevent side skids.
ś Do not install studded tires without
first checking local, state and municipal
regulations for possible restrictions
against their use.
Chain installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer’s instructions and mount
them as tightly possible. Drive slowly
(less than 20 MPH (30 km/h)) with
chains installed. If you hear the chains
contacting the body or chassis, stop and
tighten them. If they still make contact,
slow down until the noise stops. Remove
the tire chains as soon as you begin
driving on cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park the
vehicle on level ground away from traffic.
Turn on the vehicle Hazard Warning
Flasher and place a triangular emergency
warning device behind the vehicle (if
available). Always place the vehicle in P
(Park), apply the parking brake and turn
off the engine before installing snow
chains.
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
ś Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage your
vehicle's brake lines, suspension,
body and wheels.
ś Use SAE "S" class or wire chains.
ś If you hear noise caused by chains
contacting the body, retighten the
chain to prevent contact with the
vehicle body.
ś To prevent body damage, retighten
the chains after driving 0.3~0.6 miles
(0.5~1.0 km).
ś Do not use tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels. If
unavoidable, use a wire type chain.
ś Use wire chains less than 0.59 inch
(15mm) wide to prevent damage to
the chain’s connection.
Winter Precautions
Use High Quality Ethylene Glycol
Coolant
Your vehicle is delivered with high
quality ethylene glycol coolant in the
cooling system. It is the only type of
coolant that should be used because it
helps prevent corrosion in the cooling
system, lubricates the water pump and
prevents freezing. Be sure to replace or
replenish your coolant in accordance
with the maintenance schedule in
chapter 8. Before winter, have your
coolant tested to assure that its freezing
point is sufficient for the temperatures
anticipated during the winter.
6-89
While Driving
Change to "winter Weight" Oil if
Necessary
Do Not Let Your Parking Brake
Freeze
In some climates it is recommended that
a lower viscosity "winter weight" oil be
used during cold weather. See chapter 8
for recommendations. If you aren't sure
what weight oil you should use, consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Under some conditions your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged position.
This is most likely to happen when
there is an accumulation of snow or
ice around or near the rear brakes or
if the brakes are wet. If there is a risk
the parking brake may freeze, apply
it only temporarily while you put the
gear selector lever in P and block the
rear wheels so the car cannot roll. Then
release the parking brake.
Check Battery and Cables
Winter puts additional burdens on the
battery system. Visually inspect the
battery and cables as described in
chapter 8. The level of charge in your
battery can be checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a service station.
Check Spark Plugs and Ignition
System
Inspect your spark plugs as described in
chapter 8 and replace them if necessary.
Also check all ignition wiring and
components to be sure they are not
cracked, worn or damaged in any way.
Use Approved Window Washer Antifreeze in System
To keep the water in the window washer
system from freezing, add an approved
window washer anti-freeze solution in
accordance with instructions on the
container. Window washer anti-freeze is
available from an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and most auto parts outlets. Do
not use engine coolant or other types
of antifreeze as these may damage the
paint finish.
6-90
Do Not Let Ice and Snow Accumulate
Underneath
Under some conditions, snow and ice
can build up under the fenders and
interfere with the steering. When driving
in severe winter conditions where this
may happen, you should periodically
check underneath the car to be sure the
movement of the front wheels and the
steering components is not obstructed.
Don't Place Foreign Objects
or Materials in the Engine
Compartment
Placement of foreign object or materials
which prevent cooling of the engine, in
the engine compartment, may cause a
failure or combustion. The manufacturer
is not responsible for the damage caused
by such placement.
To Keep Locks from Freezing
To keep the locks from freezing, squirt
an approved de-icer fluid or glycerine
into the key opening. If a lock is covered
with ice, squirt it with an approved deicing fluid to remove the ice. If the lock
is frozen internally, you may be able to
thaw it out by using a heated key. Handle
the heated key with care to avoid injury.
06
VEHICLE LOAD LIMIT
Two labels on your driver's door sill show
how much weight your vehicle was
designed to carry: the Tire and Loading
Information Label and the Certification
Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize
yourself with the following terms for
determining your vehicle’s weight
ratings, from the vehicle's specifications
and the Certification Label:
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all options, equipment, passengers
and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the
Certification Label located on the driver’s
door sill.
Tire Loading Information Label
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional
equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer
plus any aftermarket equipment.
OQX089051N
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added to
the Base Curb Weight, including cargo
and optional equipment.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on each
axle (front and rear) - including vehicle
curb weight and all payload.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable weight
that can be carried by a single axle (front
or rear). These numbers are shown on
the Certification Label. The total load on
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus actual
Cargo Weight plus passengers.
OQX089052N
The label located on the driver's door
sill gives the original tire size, cold
tire pressures recommended for your
vehicle, the number of people that can
be in your vehicle and vehicle capacity
weight.
Vehicle Capacity Weight
Vehicle capacity weight is the maximum
combined weight of occupants and
cargo. If your vehicle is equipped with a
trailer, the combined weight includes the
tongue load.
6-91
While Driving
Seating Capacity
Total: 5 persons
(Front seat : 2 persons,
Rear seat : 3 persons)
Seating capacity is the maximum
number of occupants including a driver,
your vehicle may carry. However, the
seating capacity may be reduced based
upon the weight of all of the occupants,
and the weight of the cargo being carried
or towed. Do not overload the vehicle as
there is a limit to the total weight, or load
limit including occupants and cargo, the
vehicle can carry.
Towing Capacity
We do not recommend using this vehicle
for trailer towing.
Cargo Capacity
The cargo capacity of your vehicle will
increase or decrease depending on the
weight and the number of occupants
and the tongue load, if your vehicle is
equipped with a trailer.
Steps for Determining Correct Load
Limit
1. Locate the statement "The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on
your vehicle's placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be
riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX kg or
XXX lbs.
6-92
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example,
if the "XXX" amount equals 1400
lbs. and there will be five 150 lb.
passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and
luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo and
luggage load capacity calculated in
Step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
WARNING
Do not overload the vehicle as there
is a limit to the total weight, or load
limit, including occupants and cargo,
the vehicle can carry. Overloading can
shorten the life of the vehicle. If the
GVWR or the GAWR is exceeded, parts
on the vehicle can break, and it can
change the handling of your vehicle.
These could cause you to lose control
and result in an accident.
06
+
ŧ
Example 1
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 2 = 300 lbs.)
(68 kg × 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
(1100 lbs.)
(499 kg)
+
ŧ
Example 2
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 5 = 750 lbs.)
(68 kg × 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
(650 lbs.)
(295 kg)
+
ŧ
Example 3
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
Passenger Weight
(172 lbs. × 5 = 860 lbs.)
(78 kg × 5 = 390 kg)
Cargo Weight
(540 lbs.)
(245 kg)
6-93
While Driving
Certification Label
WARNING
OBH059070
The certification label is located on the
driver’s door sill at the center pillar and
shows the maximum allowable weight of
the fully loaded vehicle. This is called the
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating). The
GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle,
all occupants, fuel and cargo.
This label also tells you the maximum
weight that can be supported by the
front and rear axles, called Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR).
The total weight of the vehicle, including
all occupants, accessories, cargo, and
trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or
the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
To find out the actual loads on your front
and rear axles, you need to go to a weigh
station and weigh your vehicle. Be sure
to spread out your load equally on both
sides of the centerline.
6-94
Overloading
ś Never exceed the GVWR for your
vehicle, the GAWR for either the front
or rear axle and vehicle capacity
weight. Exceeding these ratings
can affect your vehicle’s handling
and braking ability, and cause an
accident.
ś Do not overload your vehicle.
Overloading your vehicle can cause
heat buildup in your vehicle’s tires
and possible tire failure, increased
stopping distances and poor vehicle
handling-all of which may result in a
crash.
NOTICE
Overloading your vehicle may cause
damage. Repairs would not be covered
by your warranty. Do not overload your
vehicle.
WARNING
If you carry items inside your vehicle
(e.g., suitcases, tools, packages, or
anything else), they are moving as fast
as the vehicle. If you have to stop or
turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the
items will keep going and can cause
an injury if they strike the driver or a
passenger.
ś Put items in the cargo area of your
vehicle. Try to spread the weight
evenly.
ś Do not stack items, like suitcases,
inside the vehicle above the tops of
the seats.
ś Do not leave an unsecured child
restraint in your vehicle.
ś When you carry something inside the
vehicle, secure it.
06
TRAILER TOWING
We do not recommend using this vehicle
for trailer towing.
6-95
7. Emergency Situations
Hazard Warning Flasher ....................................................................................7-2
In Case of an Emergency While Driving ...........................................................7-2
If the Engine Stalls While Driving ................................................................................ 7-2
If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad or Crossing .......................................................... 7-2
If you Have a Flat Tire While Driving ........................................................................... 7-3
If the Engine Will Not Start ................................................................................7-3
If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over or Turns Over Slowly ............................................... 7-3
If the Engine Turns Over Normally but Doesn’t Start................................................. 7-3
Jump Starting ................................................................................................... 7-4
If the Engine Overheats .................................................................................... 7-6
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (Type A) .......................................... 7-7
TPMS Malfunction Indicator ........................................................................................7-8
Changing a Tire with TPMS .........................................................................................7-8
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (Type B) ........................................ 7-10
Check Tire Pressure.....................................................................................................7-10
Tire Pressure Monitoring System ................................................................................7-11
Low Tire Pressure Telltale ........................................................................................... 7-12
Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position Indicator ............................................ 7-12
TPMS Malfunction Indicator .......................................................................................7-13
Changing a Tire with TPMS ........................................................................................7-13
If you Have a Flat Tire (With Spare Tire) ......................................................... 7-15
Jack and Tools .............................................................................................................7-15
Changing Tires.............................................................................................................7-16
Towing ...............................................................................................................7-21
Towing Service ............................................................................................................ 7-21
Removable Towing Hook ........................................................................................... 7-22
Emergency Towing ..................................................................................................... 7-23
Tie-down Hook ........................................................................................................... 7-24
7
Emergency Situations
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If the Engine Stalls While Driving
OQXI069001
The hazard warning flasher serves as
a warning to other drivers to exercise
extreme caution when approaching,
overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency
repairs are being made or when the
vehicle is stopped near the edge of a
roadway.
To turn the hazard warning flasher
on or off, press the hazard warning
flasher button. The button is located
in the center fascia panel. Both the left
and right turn signal lights will flash
simultaneously.
ś The hazard warning flasher operates
whether your vehicle is running or not.
ś The turn signals do not work when the
hazard flasher is on.
7-2
ś Reduce your speed gradually, keeping
a straight line. Move cautiously off the
road to a safe place.
ś Turn on your hazard warning flasher.
ś Try to start the engine again. If your
vehicle will not start, contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer or seek
other qualified assistance.
If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad
or Crossing
If the engine stalls at a crossroads or
crossing, if safe to do so, move the shift
lever to the N (Neutral) position and then
push the vehicle to a safe location.
07
If you Have a Flat Tire While
Driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
ś Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow down
while driving straight ahead. Do not
apply the brakes immediately or
attempt to pull off the road as this
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. When the
vehicle has slowed to such a speed
that it is safe to do so, brake carefully
and pull off the road. Drive off the
road as far as possible and park on
firm, level ground. If you are on a
divided highway, do not park in the
median area between the two traffic
lanes.
ś When the vehicle is stopped, press
the hazard warning flasher button,
move the shift lever into P (Park), and
apply the parking brake, and place
the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF
position.
ś Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on the
side of the vehicle that is away from
traffic.
ś When changing a flat tire, follow the
instructions provided later in this
chapter.
IF THE ENGINE WILL NOT
START
If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over
or Turns Over Slowly
ś Be sure the shift lever is in N (Neutral)
or P (Park). The engine starts only
when the shift lever is in N (Neutral) or
P (Park).
ś Check the battery connections to be
sure they are clean and tight.
ś Turn on the interior light. If the light
dims or goes out when you operate
the starter, the battery is drained.
Do not push or pull the vehicle to start it.
This could cause damage to your vehicle.
See instructions for “Jump Starting”
provided in this chapter.
CAUTION
Push or pull starting the vehicle may
cause the catalytic converter to
overload which can lead to damage to
the emission control system.
If the Engine Turns Over
Normally but Doesn’t Start
Check the fuel level and add fuel if
necessary.
If the engine still does not start, have
your vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7-3
Emergency Situations
JUMP STARTING
Jump starting can be dangerous if done
incorrectly. Follow the jump starting
procedure in this section to avoid serious
injury or damage to your vehicle. If in
doubt about how to properly jump start
your vehicle, we strongly recommend
that you have a service technician or
towing service do it for you.
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
to you or bystanders, always follow
these precautions when working near
or handling the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Wear eye protection designed
to protect the eyes from acid
splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
Hydrogen is always present
in battery cells, is highly
combustible, and may explode
if ignited.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
Batteries contain sulfuric acid
which is highly corrosive. Do
not allow acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
7-4
If acid gets into your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate medical
attention. If acid gets on your skin,
thoroughly wash the area. If you feel
pain or a burning sensation, get medical
attention immediately.
ś When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a
battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle if your battery is frozen.
ś NEVER attempt to recharge the
battery when the vehicle’s battery
cables are connected to the battery.
ś The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage. NEVER touch
these components with the engine
running or when the ignition switch
is in the ON position.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
ś Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to jump
start your vehicle.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle by push-starting.
07
Jump Starting Procedure
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach, but
do not allow the vehicles to touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in the
engine compartment at all times, even
when the vehicles are turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such as
radios, lights, air conditioning, etc.
Put the vehicles in P (Park) and set
the parking brakes. Turn both vehicles
OFF.
OQX079004N
4. Connect the jumper cables in
the exact sequence shown in the
illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) jumper
terminal of your vehicle (1).
5. Connect the other end of the jumper
cable to the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
6. Connect the second jumper cable to
the black, negative (-) battery/chassis
ground of the assisting vehicle (3).
7. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the black, negative (-)
chassis ground of your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct
battery or jumper terminals or the
correct ground. Do not lean over the
battery when making connections.
8. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run at approximately
2,000 rpm for a few minutes. Then
start your vehicle.
If your vehicle will not start after a few
attempts, it probably requires servicing.
In this event please seek qualified
assistance. If the cause of your battery
discharging is not apparent, have your
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from the
black, negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative
(-) battery/chassis ground of the
assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper cable
from the red, positive (+) battery/
jumper terminal of the assisting
vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).
7-5
Emergency Situations
IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS
If your temperature gauge indicates
overheating, you experience a loss of
power, or hear loud pinging or knocking,
the engine may be overheating. If this
happens, you should:
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon as it
is safe to do so.
2. Place the shift lever in P (Park) and
set the parking brake. If the air
conditioning is ON, turn it OFF.
3. If engine coolant is running out under
the vehicle or steam is coming out
from the hood, stop the engine. Do
not open the hood until the coolant
has stopped running or the steaming
has stopped. If there is no visible
loss of engine coolant and no steam,
leave the engine running and check
to be sure the engine cooling fan is
operating. If the fan is not running,
turn the engine off.
WARNING
While the engine is running,
keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the moving parts
such as the cooling fan and
drive belt to prevent serious
injury.
4. Check for coolant leaking from the
radiator, hoses or under the vehicle. (If
the air conditioning had been in use, it
is normal for cold water to be draining
from it when you stop.)
5. If engine coolant is leaking out, stop
the engine immediately and call the
nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for assistance.
7-6
WARNING
Your vehicle is equipped
with a pressurized coolant
reserve tank. NEVER remove
the engine coolant reservoir
tank/radiator cap or the drain
plug while the engine and
radiator are HOT. Hot coolant
and steam may blow out under
pressure, causing serious
injury.
Turn the engine off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the engine coolant
reservoir tank/radiator cap. Wrap
a towel or thick rag around it, and
turn it counterclockwise slowly to
release some of the pressure from the
system. Step back while the pressure is
released.
When you are sure all the pressure has
been released, continue turning the cap
counterclockwise to remove it.
6. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the engine
temperature has returned to normal.
Then, if coolant has been lost,
carefully add coolant to the reservoir
to bring the fluid level in the reservoir
up to the halfway mark.
7. Proceed with caution, keeping alert
for further signs of overheating. If
overheating happens again, call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
CAUTION
Serious loss of coolant indicates a
leak in the cooling system and should
be checked as soon as possible by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
07
7,5(35(6685(021,725,1*6<67(0ǣ7306Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
ǣ7<3($Ǥ
OQX069034L
(1) Low Tire Pressure / TPMS Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire failure
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the vehicle placard or
tire inflation pressure label. A cold tire
means the vehicle has been sitting for 3
hours and driven for less than 1 mile (1.6
km) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure. If your vehicle
has tires of a different size than the
size indicated on the vehicle placard or
tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. Accordingly,
when the low tire pressure telltale
illuminates, you should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure. Driving on
a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if
under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with
a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating
properly. The TPMS malfunction
indicator is combined with the low
tire pressure telltale. When the system
detects a malfunction, the telltale will
flash for approximately one minute and
then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists.
7-7
Emergency Situations
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able
to detect or signal low tire pressure as
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur
for a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate
tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires
or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that
the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
NOTICE
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position or engine is running.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for
approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure LCD display
remains illuminated
CAUTION
In winter or cold weather, the Low Tire
Pressure Telltale may be illuminated if
the tire pressure was adjusted to the
recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not mean
your TPMS is malfunctioning because
the decreased temperature leads to a
proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle from a
warm area to a cold area or from a cold
area to a warm area, or the outside
temperature is greatly higher or lower,
you should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to the
recommended tire inflation pressure.
7-8
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure makes
the vehicle unstable and can contribute
to loss of vehicle control and increased
braking distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires
can cause the tires to overheat and fail.
TPMS Malfunction
Indicator
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
will illuminate after it blinks for
approximately one minute when there
is a problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
illuminate after blinking for one minute
if the vehicle is near electric power
supply cables or radio transmitters
such as police stations, government
and public offices, broadcasting
stations, military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow chains
are used or electronic devices such as
computers, chargers, remote starters,
navigation, etc. This may interfere with
normal operation of the TPMS.
Changing a Tire with TPMS
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure indicator will come on. Have
the flat tire repaired by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible or
replace the flat tire with the spare tire.
07
CAUTION
It is recommended that you do not use a
puncture-repairing agent not approved
by HYUNDAI dealer to repair and/or
inflate a low pressure tire. Tire sealant
not approved by HYUNDAI dealer may
damage the tire pressure sensor.
The spare tire does not come with a
tire pressure monitoring sensor. When
the low pressure tire or the flat tire is
replaced with the spare tire, the TPMS
Malfunction Indicator will illuminate after
blinking for one minute if the vehicle
is driven at speed above 15.5 MPH (25
km/h) for approximately 20 minutes.
Once the original tire equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure
and reinstalled on the vehicle, the TPMS
Malfunction Indicator will go off within a
few minutes of driving.
If the indicators do not disappear after a
few minutes, please visit an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the tire
behind the valve stem (except for the
spare tire). You must use TPMS specific
wheels. It is recommended that you
always have your tires serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking at it.
Always use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to measure the tire’s inflation
pressure. Please note that a tire that is
hot (from being driven) will have a higher
pressure measurement than a tire that is
cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has been
sitting for 3 hours and driven for less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
WARNING
ś The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors such as nails or road
debris.
ś If you feel any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off
the accelerator, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or disabling
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may interfere
with the system’s ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions
and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering
with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may void the warranty for
that portion of the vehicle.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.
7-9
Emergency Situations
7,5(35(6685(021,725,1*6<67(0ǣ7306Ǥǣ,)(48,33('Ǥ
ǣ7<3(%Ǥ
Check Tire Pressure
OQX069034L
OQX049029L
OQX079024N
(1) Low Tire Pressure / TPMS Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
(2) Low Tire Pressure / Tire Pressure
Monitor / TPMS Malfunction Display
(shown on the cluster LCD display)
7-10
ś You can check the tire pressure in the
Assist mode on the cluster.
Refer to the “LCD Display Mode”
section in chapter 4.
ś A “Drive to display” message will
appear for the first few minutes of
driving after initial engine start up.
If the tire pressure is not displayed
after a few minutes of driving, check
the tire pressures.
ś The displayed tire pressure values may
differ from those measured with a tire
pressure gauge.
ś You can change the tire pressure unit
in the User Settings mode on the
cluster.
- psi, kpa, bar (Refer to the “User
Settings Mode” section in chapter
4).
07
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation can
reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle
handling, and lead to sudden tire failure
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if
provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle
manufacturer on the vehicle placard or
tire inflation pressure label. A cold tire
means the vehicle has been sitting for 3
hours and driven for less than 1 mile (1.6
km) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure. If your vehicle
has tires of a different size than the
size indicated on the vehicle placard or
tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. Accordingly,
when the low tire pressure telltale
illuminates, you should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure. Driving on
a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel
efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance,
and it is the driver’s responsibility to
maintain correct tire pressure, even if
under-inflation has not reached the level
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low
tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with
a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating
properly. The TPMS malfunction
indicator is combined with the low
tire pressure telltale. When the system
detects a malfunction, the telltale will
flash for approximately one minute and
then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be able
to detect or signal low tire pressure as
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur
for a variety of reasons, including the
installation of replacement or alternate
tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning
properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires
or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that
the replacement or alternate tires and
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
NOTICE
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when the
ignition switch is placed to the ON
position or engine is running.
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for
approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure LCD display
remains illuminated
7-11
Emergency Situations
Low Tire Pressure Telltale
Low Tire Pressure LCD
Display with Position
Indicator
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are
illuminated and the warning message
is displayed on the cluster LCD
display, one or more of your tires is
significantly under-inflated. The LCD
position indicator will indicate which
tire is significantly under-inflated by
illuminating the corresponding position
light.
If any of your tire pressures are indicated
as being low, immediately reduce
your speed, avoid hard cornering, and
anticipate increased stopping distances.
You should stop and check your tires
as soon as possible. Inflate the tires to
the proper pressure as indicated on the
vehicle’s placard or tire inflation pressure
label located on the driver’s side center
pillar outer panel.
If you cannot reach a service station or
if the tire cannot hold the newly added
air, replace the low pressure tire with the
spare tire. (if equipped)
The Low Tire Pressure LCD position
indicator will remain on and the TPMS
Malfunction Indicator may blink for one
minute and then remain illuminated until
you have the low pressure tire repaired
and replaced on the vehicle.
NOTICE
The spare tire is not equipped with a
tire pressure sensor.
7-12
CAUTION
In winter or cold weather, the Low Tire
Pressure Telltale may be illuminated if
the tire pressure was adjusted to the
recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not mean
your TPMS is malfunctioning because
the decreased temperature leads to a
proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle from a
warm area to a cold area or from a cold
area to a warm area, or the outside
temperature is greatly higher or lower,
you should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to the
recommended tire inflation pressure.
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure makes
the vehicle unstable and can contribute
to loss of vehicle control and increased
braking distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires
can cause the tires to overheat and fail.
07
TPMS Malfunction
Indicator
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
will illuminate after it blinks for
approximately one minute when there
is a problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
TPMS, the individual tire pressures
in the cluster LCD display will not be
available. Have the system checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
NOTICE
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
illuminate after blinking for one minute
if the vehicle is near electric power
supply cables or radio transmitters
such as police stations, government
and public offices, broadcasting
stations, military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow chains
are used or electronic devices such as
computers, chargers, remote starters,
navigation, etc. This may interfere with
normal operation of the TPMS.
Changing a Tire with TPMS
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and LCD position indicator will
come on. Have the flat tire repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible or replace the flat tire with the
spare tire. (if equipped)
CAUTION
It is recommended that you do not use a
puncture-repairing agent not approved
by HYUNDAI dealer to repair and/or
inflate a low pressure tire. Tire sealant
not approved by HYUNDAI dealer may
damage the tire pressure sensor.
The spare tire does not come with a
tire pressure monitoring sensor. When
the low pressure tire or the flat tire is
replaced with the spare tire, the Low
Tire Pressure LCD position indicator will
remain on. Also, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator will illuminate after blinking
for one minute if the vehicle is driven
at speed above 15.5 MPH (25 km/h) for
approximately 20 minutes.
Once the original tire equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure
and reinstalled on the vehicle, the Low
Tire Pressure LCD position indicator and
TPMS Malfunction Indicator will go off
within a few minutes of driving.
If the indicators do not disappear after a
few minutes, please visit an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7-13
Emergency Situations
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the tire
behind the valve stem (except for the
spare tire). You must use TPMS specific
wheels. It is recommended that you
always have your tires serviced by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
You may not be able to identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking at it.
Always use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to measure the tire’s inflation
pressure. Please note that a tire that is
hot (from being driven) will have a higher
pressure measurement than a tire that is
cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has been
sitting for 3 hours and driven for less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3 hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
WARNING
ś The TPMS cannot alert you to severe
and sudden tire damage caused by
external factors such as nails or road
debris.
ś If you feel any vehicle instability,
immediately take your foot off
the accelerator, apply the brakes
gradually with light force, and slowly
move to a safe position off the road.
7-14
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or disabling
the Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may interfere
with the system’s ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions
and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering
with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may void the warranty for
that portion of the vehicle.
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following three
conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.
07
,)<28+$9($)/$77,5(ǣ:,7+63$5(7,5(,)(48,33('Ǥ
WARNING
Changing a tire can be dangerous.
Follow the instructions in this section
when changing a tire to reduce the risk
of serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Be careful as you use the jack handle to
stay clear of the flat end. The flat end
has sharp edges that could cause cuts.
OLF064031N
Turn the winged hold down bolt
counterclockwise to remove the spare
tire.
Store the spare tire in the same
compartment by turning the winged hold
down bolt clockwise.
To prevent the spare tire and tools from
“rattling”, store them in their proper
location.
Jack and Tools
OQXI069004
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Jack handle
Jack
Wheel lug nut wrench
Towing hook
The jack, jack handle, and wheel lug
nut wrench are stored in the luggage
compartment under the luggage box
cover.
The jack is provided for emergency tire
changing only.
OLF064005
If it is hard to loosen the tire hold-down
wing bolt by hand, you can loosen it
easily using the jack handle.
1. Put the jack handle (1) inside of the
tire hold-down wing bolt.
2. Turn the tire hold-down wing bolt
counterclockwise with the jack
handle.
7-15
Emergency Situations
Changing Tires
WARNING
A vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack
causing serious injury or death to you or
those nearby. Take the following safety
precautions:
ś Never place any portion of your body
under a vehicle that is supported by
a jack.
ś NEVER attempt to change a tire in
the lane of traffic. ALWAYS move the
vehicle completely off the road on
level, firm ground away from traffic
before trying to change a tire. If you
cannot find a level, firm place off
the road, call a towing service for
assistance.
ś Be sure to use the jack provided with
the vehicle.
ś ALWAYS place the jack on the
designated jacking positions on the
vehicle and NEVER on the bumpers
or any other part of the vehicle for
jacking support.
ś Do not start or run the engine while
the vehicle is on the jack.
ś Do not allow anyone to remain in the
vehicle while it is on the jack.
ś Keep children away from the road
and the vehicle.
7-16
Follow these steps to change your
vehicle’s tire:
1. Park on a level, firm surface.
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) or
into R (Reverse) if equipped with
a manual transmission, apply the
parking brake, and place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position.
3. Press the hazard warning flasher
button.
4. Remove the wheel lug nut wrench,
jack, jack handle, and spare tire from
the vehicle.
OQX069041L
[A] : Block
5. Block both the front and rear of the
tire diagonally opposite of the tire you
are changing.
07
OQXI069007
6. Loosen the wheel lug nuts
counterclockwise one turn each in
the order shown above, but do not
remove any lug nuts until the tire has
been raised off of the ground.
OQX079002L
7. Place the jack at the designated
jacking position under the frame
closest to the tire you are changing.
The jacking positions are plates
welded to the frame with two
notches. Never jack at any other
position or part of the vehicle. Doing
so may damage the side seal molding
or other parts of the vehicle.
OQXI069009
8. Insert the jack handle into the jack
and turn it clockwise, raising the
vehicle until the tire clears the ground.
Make sure the vehicle is stable on the
jack.
9. Loosen the lug nuts with the wheel
lug nut wrench and remove them with
your fingers. Remove the wheel from
the studs and lay it flat on the ground
out of the way. Remove any dirt or
debris from the studs, mounting
surfaces, and wheel.
10. Install the spare tire onto the studs of
the hub.
11. Tighten the lug nuts with your fingers
onto the studs with the smaller end of
the lug nuts closest to the wheel.
12. Lower the vehicle to the ground
by turning the jack handle
counterclockwise.
13. Use the wheel lug nut wrench to
tighten the lug nuts in the order
shown. Double-check each lug nut
until they are tight. After changing
tires, have an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer tighten the lug nuts to their
proper torque as soon as possible. The
wheel lug nut should be tightened to
79~94 lbf·ft (11~13 kgf·m).
7-17
Emergency Situations
CAUTION
OQX079025N
If you have a tire gauge, check the tire
pressure (see “Tires and Wheels” in
chapter 2 for tire pressure instructions.).
If the pressure is lower or higher than
recommended, drive slowly to the
nearest service station and adjust it to
the recommended pressure. Always
reinstall the valve cap after checking
or adjusting tire pressure. If the cap
is not replaced, air may leak from the
tire. If you lose a valve cap, buy another
and install it as soon as possible. After
changing tires, secure the flat tire and
return the jack and tools to their proper
storage locations. If it is hard to secure
the flat tire, put the flat tire in the
luggage compartment.
NOTICE
ś Check the tire pressure as soon
as possible after installing a spare
tire. Adjust it to the recommended
pressure.
ś Check and tighten the wheel lug
nuts after driving over 30 miles (50
km), after the spare tire is installed.
Recheck the tire wheel lug nuts after
driving over 620 miles (1,000 km)
after the replaced tire is reinstalled.
7-18
Your vehicle has metric threads on the
studs and lug nuts. Make certain during
tire changing that the same nuts that
were removed are reinstalled. If you
have to replace your lug nuts make
sure they have metric threads to avoid
damaging the studs and ensure the
wheel is properly secured to the hub.
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for assistance.
If any of the equipment such as the jack,
lug nuts, studs, or other equipment is
damaged or in poor condition, do not
attempt to change the tire and call for
assistance.
Use of compact spare tires
Compact spare tires are designed for
emergency use only. Drive carefully on
the compact spare tire and always follow
the safety precautions.
WARNING
To prevent compact spare tire failure
and loss of control possibly resulting in
an accident:
ś Use the compact spare tire only in an
emergency.
ś NEVER operate your vehicle over 50
MPH (80 km/h).
ś Do not exceed the vehicle’s
maximum load rating or the load
carrying capacity shown on the
sidewall of the compact spare tire.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire
continuously. Repair or replace the
original tire as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the compact spare
tire.
07
When driving with the compact spare tire
mounted to your vehicle:
ś Check the tire pressure after installing
the compact spare tire. The compact
spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi
(420 kPa).
ś Do not take this vehicle through
an automatic car wash while the
compact spare tire is installed.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire on
any other vehicle because this tire
has been designed especially for your
vehicle.
ś The compact spare tire’s tread life is
shorter than a regular tire. Inspect
your compact spare tire regularly and
replace worn compact spare tires with
the same size and design, mounted on
the same wheel.
ś Do not use more than one compact
spare tire at a time.
NOTICE
When the original tire and wheel are
repaired and reinstalled on the vehicle,
the lug nut torque must be set correctly.
The correct lug nut tightening torque is
79~94 lbf·ft (11~13 kgf·m).
CAUTION
To prevent damaging the compact
spare tire and your vehicle:
ś Drive slowly enough for the road
conditions to avoid all hazards, such
as a potholes or debris.
ś Avoid driving over obstacles. The
compact spare tire diameter is
smaller than the diameter of a
conventional tire and reduces the
ground clearance approximately 1
inch (25 mm).
ś Do not use tire chains on the
compact spare tire. Because of the
smaller size, a tire chain will not fit
properly.
ś Do not use the compact spare tire
on any other wheels, nor should
standard tires, snow tires, wheel
covers or trim rings be used with the
compact spare wheel.
ś Do not suddenly accelerate or
decelerate (0 ~ 25 mph (0 ~ 40 km/h))
in any driving mode. It may cause
leakage of transfer oil.
7-19
Emergency Situations
Jack Label
Example
OHYK065011
The actual Jack label in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
For more detailed specifications, refer to the label attached to the jack.
1. Model Name
2. Maximum allowable load
3. When using the jack, set your parking
brake.
4. When using the jack, stop the engine.
5. Do not get under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
6. The designated locations under the
frame
7. When supporting the vehicle, the base
plate of jack must be vertical under
the lifting point.
7-20
8. Shift into Reverse gear on vehicles
with manual transmission or move
the shift lever to the P (Park) position
on vehicles with intelligent variable
transmission.
9. The jack should be used on firm level
ground.
10. Jack manufacture
11. Production date
12. Representative company and address
07
TOWING
Towing Service
CAUTION
An AWD vehicle should never be
towed with the wheels on the ground.
This can cause serious damage to the
transmission.
CAUTION
ś Do not tow the vehicle with the front
wheels on the ground as this may
cause damage to the vehicle.
A
A
OQXI069011
[A] : Dollies
If emergency towing is necessary,
we recommend having it done by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service. Proper
lifting and towing procedures are
necessary to prevent damage to the
vehicle. The use of wheel dollies or
flatbed is recommended.
On 2WD vehicles, it is acceptable to
tow the vehicle with the rear wheels
on the ground (without dollies) and
the front wheels off the ground. If any
of the loaded wheels or suspension
components are damaged or the vehicle
is being towed with the front wheels on
the ground, use a towing dolly under the
front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial tow
truck and wheel dollies are not used,
the front of the vehicle should always be
lifted, not the rear.
If your vehicle is an AWD vehicle, it must
be towed with a wheel lift and dollies or
flatbed equipment with all the wheels off
the ground.
OQXI069013
ś Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use a wheel lift or
flatbed equipment.
OQXI069014
ś Do not tow the vehicle with four
wheels in contact with the ground if
it is the vehicle equipped with IVT.
Otherwise, the transmission will be
seriously damaged. Also, make sure
not to tow the vehicle connecting it
with other vehicles including camper
vans.
OQX079026N
7-21
Emergency Situations
WARNING
Removable Towing Hook
If your vehicle is equipped with a
rollover sensor, place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF or ACC position
when the vehicle is being towed.
The side impact and curtain air bag
may deploy if the sensor detects the
situation as a rollover.
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
1. Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position.
2. Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
3. Release the parking brake.
CAUTION
Failure to place the shift lever in N
(Neutral) when being towed with the
front wheels on the ground can cause
internal damage to the transmission.
7-22
OQX079003L
1. Open the liftgate, and remove the
towing hook from the tool case.
2. Remove the hole cover pressing the
lower part of the cover on the front or
rear bumper.
3. Install the towing hook by turning it
clockwise into the hole until it is fully
secured.
4. Remove the towing hook and install
the cover after use.
07
Emergency Towing
CAUTION
Front
The driver must be in the vehicle for
steering and braking operations when
the vehicle is being towed. Passengers
other than the driver must not be in the
vehicle.
OQX079003L
Rear
OQX079015L
If towing is necessary, we recommend
you have it done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial tow
truck service.
If towing service is not available in
an emergency, your vehicle may be
temporarily towed using a cable or chain
secured to the emergency towing hook
at the front (or rear) of the vehicle.
Use extreme caution when towing the
vehicle with a cable or chain. A driver
must be in the vehicle to steer it and
operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done
only on hard-surfaced roads for a short
distance and at low speeds. Also, the
wheels, axles, power train, steering
and brakes must all be in good working
condition.
Always follow these emergency towing
precautions:
ś Place the ignition switch in the ACC
position so the steering wheel is not
locked (if equipped).
ś Place the shift lever in N (Neutral).
ś Release the parking brake.
ś Depress the brake pedal with more
force than normal since you will have
reduced braking performance.
ś More steering effort will be required
because the power steering system
will be disabled.
ś Use a vehicle heavier than your own to
tow your vehicle.
ś The drivers of both vehicles should
communicate with each other
frequently.
ś Before emergency towing, check that
the hook is not broken or damaged.
ś Fasten the towing cable or chain
securely to the hook.
ś Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady
and even force.
7-23
Emergency Situations
NOTICE
OQXI069018
ś Use a towing cable or chain less than
16 feet (5 m) long. Attach a white or
red cloth (about 12 inch (30 cm) wide)
in the middle of the cable or chain for
easy visibility.
ś Drive carefully so the towing cable or
chain remains tight during towing.
ś Before towing, check intelligent
variable transmission for fluid leaks
under your vehicle. If the intelligent
variable transmission fluid is leaking,
flatbed equipment or a towing dolly
must be used.
NOTICE
Accelerate or decelerate the vehicle
in a slow and gradual manner while
maintaining tension on the tow rope
or chain to start or drive the vehicle,
otherwise tow hooks and the vehicle
may be damaged.
7-24
To avoid damage to your vehicle and
vehicle components when towing:
ś Always pull straight ahead when
using the towing hooks. Do not pull
from the side or at a vertical angle.
ś Do not use the towing hooks to pull
a vehicle out of mud, sand or other
conditions from which the vehicle
cannot be driven out under its own
power.
ś Limit the vehicle speed to 10 MPH (15
km/h) and drive less than 1 mile (1.5
km) when towing to avoid serious
damage to the intelligent variable
transmission.
Tie-down Hook
WARNING
Do not use the tie-down hook(s) for
towing purposes. If the tiedown hook(s)
are used for towing, the tie-down
hook(s) or bumper will be damaged and
this could lead to serious injury.
8. Maintenance
Engine Compartment ....................................................................................... 8-3
Maintenance Services ...................................................................................... 8-4
Owner’s Responsibility ............................................................................................... 8-4
Owner Maintenance Precautions............................................................................... 8-4
Owner Maintenance ......................................................................................... 8-5
Owner Maintenance Schedule ....................................................................................8-5
Scheduled Maintenance Services ....................................................................8-7
Normal Maintenance Schedule.................................................................................. 8-8
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions ......................................................... 8-11
Severe Driving Conditions .......................................................................................... 8-11
Explanation of Scheduled Maintenance Items ..............................................8-12
Engine Oil .........................................................................................................8-15
Checking the Engine Oil Level................................................................................... 8-15
Checking the Engine Oil and Filter ........................................................................... 8-15
Engine Coolant.................................................................................................8-16
Checking the Engine Coolant Level .......................................................................... 8-16
Changing Engine Coolant .......................................................................................... 8-18
Brake/Clutch Fluid ...........................................................................................8-19
Checking the Brake/Clutch Fluid Level .................................................................... 8-19
Washer Fluid.................................................................................................... 8-20
Checking the Washer Fluid Level ............................................................................. 8-20
Parking Brake .................................................................................................. 8-20
Checking the Parking Brake ..................................................................................... 8-20
Air Cleaner ........................................................................................................ 8-21
Filter Replacement ..................................................................................................... 8-21
Climate Control Air Filter ................................................................................ 8-22
Filter Inspection..........................................................................................................8-22
Wiper Blades ................................................................................................... 8-23
Blade Inspection ........................................................................................................8-23
Blade Replacement ....................................................................................................8-23
Battery ............................................................................................................. 8-25
For Best Battery Service ............................................................................................8-26
Battery Recharging ....................................................................................................8-26
Reset Features ............................................................................................................8-26
8
Tires and Wheels ..............................................................................................8-27
Tire Care ...................................................................................................................... 8-27
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures ........................................................... 8-27
Check Tire Inflation Pressure.....................................................................................8-28
Tire Rotation ...............................................................................................................8-29
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ...........................................................................8-29
Tire Replacement ...................................................................................................... 8-30
Wheel Replacement ................................................................................................... 8-31
Tire Traction ................................................................................................................ 8-31
Tire Maintenance........................................................................................................ 8-31
Tire Sidewall Labeling ................................................................................................ 8-31
Tire Terminology and Definitions ..............................................................................8-35
All Season Tires...........................................................................................................8-37
Summer Tires .............................................................................................................8-37
Snow Tires...................................................................................................................8-37
Radial-Ply Tires .......................................................................................................... 8-38
Low Aspect Ratio Tires.............................................................................................. 8-38
Fuses ................................................................................................................ 8-39
Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement....................................................................... 8-40
Engine Compartment Panel Fuse Replacement ...................................................... 8-41
Fuse/Relay Panel Description................................................................................... 8-43
Light Bulbs.......................................................................................................8-50
Headlamp, Parking Lamp, Daytime Running Light, Turn Signal Lamp, Cornering
Lamp and Side Marker .............................................................................................. 8-50
Side Repeater Lamp Replacement .......................................................................... 8-54
Rear Combination Light Bulb Replacement.............................................................8-55
High Mounted Stop Lamp Replacement ..................................................................8-57
License Plate Light Bulb Replacement .....................................................................8-57
Interior Light Bulb Replacement .............................................................................. 8-58
8
Appearance Care ............................................................................................8-59
Exterior Care .............................................................................................................. 8-59
Interior Care ............................................................................................................... 8-63
Emission Control System................................................................................8-65
Crankcase Emission Control System ....................................................................... 8-66
Evaporative Emission Control System Including Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery
(ORVR)........................................................................................................................ 8-66
Exhaust Emission Control System............................................................................ 8-66
California Perchlorate Notice .........................................................................8-68
Consumer Information ...................................................................................8-69
Reporting Safety Defects ............................................................................... 8-70
08
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OQX089001L
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Engine coolant reservoir
Brake/clutch fluid reservoir
Air cleaner
Engine oil dipstick
Engine oil filler cap
6.
7.
8.
9.
Windshield washer fluid reservoir
Fuse box
Battery
Engine coolant cap
8-3
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle and
injury to yourself whenever performing
any maintenance or inspection
procedures.
We recommend you have your
vehicle maintained and repaired by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. An
authorized HYUNDAI dealer meets
HYUNDAI’s high service quality
standards and receives technical support
from HYUNDAI in order to provide you
with a high level of service satisfaction.
Owner’s Responsibility
Maintenance service and record
retention are the owner’s responsibility.
You should retain documents that show
proper maintenance has been performed
on your vehicle in accordance with
the scheduled maintenance service
charts shown on the following pages.
You need this information to establish
your compliance with the servicing
and maintenance requirements of your
vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is
provided in your Owner’s Handbook &
Warranty Information booklet.
Repairs and adjustments required as a
result of improper maintenance or a lack
of required maintenance are not covered.
8-4
Owner Maintenance Precautions
Inadequate, incomplete or insufficient
servicing may result in operational
problems with your vehicle that could
lead to vehicle damage, an accident, or
personal injury. This chapter provides
instructions only for the maintenance
items that are easy to perform. Several
procedures can be done only by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer with special
tools.
Your vehicle should not be modified
in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance, safety
or durability of your vehicle and may, in
addition, violate conditions of the limited
warranties covering the vehicle.
Certain modifications may also be in
violation of regulations established by
the U.S. Department of Transportation
and other federal or state agencies.
NOTICE
Improper owner maintenance during
the warranty period may affect
warranty coverage. For details, read
the separate Owner’s Handbook &
Warranty Information booklet provided
with the vehicle. If you’re unsure about
any service or maintenance procedure,
have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
08
OWNER MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Performing maintenance work on a
vehicle can be dangerous. If you lack
sufficient knowledge and experience or
the proper tools and equipment to do
the work, have it done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ALWAYS follow these precautions for
performing maintenance work:
ś Park your vehicle on level ground,
move the shift lever into the P (Park,
for intelligent variable transmission
vehicle) position, place the ignition
switch in the LOCK/OFF position.
ś Block the tires (front and back) to
prevent the vehicle from moving.
Remove loose clothing or jewelry
that can become entangled in
moving parts.
ś If you must run the engine during
maintenance, do so out doors or in
an area with plenty of ventilation.
ś Keep flames, sparks, or smoking
materials away from the battery and
fuel-related parts.
The following lists are vehicle checks and
inspections that should be performed
by the owner or an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer at the frequencies indicated to
help ensure safe, dependable operation
of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer as
soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance vehicle
checks are generally not covered by
warranties and you may be charged for
labor, parts and lubricants used.
Owner Maintenance Schedule
When You Stop for Fuel:
ś Check the engine oil level.
ś Check the coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
ś Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
ś Check the for low or under-inflated
tires.
WARNING
Be careful when checking your engine
coolant level when the engine is hot.
This may result in coolant being blown
out of the opening and cause serious
burns and other injuries.
8-5
Maintenance
While Operating Your Vehicle:
ś Note any changes in the sound of the
exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumes
in the vehicle.
ś Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice if there is any increased
steering effort or looseness in the
steering wheel, or change in its
straight-ahead position.
ś Notice if your vehicle constantly turns
slightly or “pulls” to one side when
traveling on smooth, level road.
ś When stopping, listen and check for
unusual sounds, pulling to one side,
increased brake pedal travel or “hardto-push” brake pedal.
ś If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your transmission occurs,
check the transmission fluid level.
ś Check the intelligent variable
transmission P (Park) function.
ś Check the parking brake.
ś Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
At Least Monthly:
ś Check coolant level in the engine
coolant reservoir.
ś Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the brake lights, turn
signals and hazard warning flashers.
ś Check the inflation pressures of all
tires including the spare for tires that
are worn, show uneven wear, or are
damaged.
ś Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
8-6
At Least Twice a Year:
(i.e., Every Spring And Autumn)
ś Check radiator, heater and air
conditioning hoses for leaks or
damage.
ś Check windshield washer spray and
wiper operation. Clean wiper blades
with a clean cloth dampened with
washer a fluid.
ś Check headlamp alignment.
ś Check muffler, exhaust pipes, shields
and clamps.
ś Check the seat belts for wear and
function.
At Least Once a Year:
ś Clean body and door drain holes.
ś Lubricate door hinges and hood
hinges.
ś Lubricate door and hood locks and
latches.
ś Lubricate door rubber weather strips.
ś Lubricate door checker.
ś Check the air conditioning system.
ś Inspect and lubricate automatic
transmission linkage and controls.
ś Clean the battery and terminals.
ś Check the brake fluid level.
08
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES
Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where none of
the following conditions apply. If any of the following conditions apply, you must follow
the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions.
ś Repeated short distance driving.
ś Driving in dusty conditions or sandy areas.
ś Extensive use of brakes.
ś Driving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are used.
ś Driving on rough or muddy roads.
ś Driving in mountainous areas.
ś Extended periods of idling or low speed operation.
ś Driving for a prolonged period in cold temperatures and/or extremely humid
climates.
ś More than 50% driving in heavy city traffic during hot weather above 90°F (32°C).
ś Engine oil usage which is not recommended (Mineral type, Semi-synthetic, lower
grade spec, etc.)
For additional information or assistance see your authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
After 10 years or 100,000 miles, we recommend to use severe maintenance
schedule.
8-7
8-8
R
R
I
I
I
I
R
65
40
60
R
78
48
72
R
91
56
84
R
104
64
96
R
117
72
108
R
130
80
120
R
143
88
132
I
R
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
Replace every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
Rotate tires every 8,000 miles (13,000 km)
Replace every 96,000 miles (156,000 km) or 144 months
R
R
156
96
144
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
At first, inspect at 48,000 miles (78,000 km) or 72 months.
Thereafter, inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
169
104
156
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*1 : Requires API SN PLUS (or above) grade engine oil. If a lower grade engine oil is used, then the engine oil and engine oil filter
must be replaced at every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months as indicated for severe maintenance condition.
*2 : If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive is recommended. Additives are available from your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.
*3 : The drive belt should be replaced when cracks occur or tension is reduced excessively.
Drive belts *3
R
52
32
48
Add fuel additives every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months
R
39
24
36
At first, replace at 120,000 miles (200,000 km) or 10 years.
Thereafter, replace every 24,000 miles (39,000 km) or 36 months
I
Battery condition
I
26
13
Km×1,000
16
8
Miles×1,000
24
12
Months
Vacuum hose
Engine coolant
Climate control air filter
(for evaporator and blower unit)
Tires
Spark plugs
Air cleaner filter
Fuel additives
*2
Engine oil and engine oil filter
*1
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE
ITEM
Normal Maintenance Schedule
Maintenance
I
I
I
Disc brakes and pads
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots/
lower arm ball joint, upper arm ball joint
I
I
I
I
I
I
Air conditioner refrigerant
Air conditioner compressor
Exhaust pipe and muffler
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
Manual transmission fluid (If equipped)
Intelligent variable transmission fluid (If equipped)
I
I
I
Suspension mounting bolts
Driveshaft and boots
I
I
26
Km×1,000
16
I
8
Miles×1,000
24
13
12
Months
Brake lines, hoses and connections
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE
ITEM
Normal Maintenance Schedule (CONT)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
39
24
36
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
52
32
48
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
78
48
72
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
91
56
84
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
104
64
96
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
117
72
108
I
No check, No service required
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
65
40
60
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
130
80
120
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
143
88
132
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
156
96
144
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
169
104
156
08
8-9
8-10
I
I
I
I
I
78
48
72
91
56
84
I
I
I
I
I
104
64
96
117
72
108
I
I
I
I
130
80
120
143
88
132
Inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months,
Replace every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 48 months
I
65
40
60
I
I
I
I
I
156
96
144
169
104
156
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
*4 : Fuel filter & Fuel tank air filter are considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this
maintenance schedule depends on fuel quality. If there are some important safety matters like fuel flow restriction, surging,
loss of power, hard starting problem, etc. replace the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule and consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.
Brake fluid
Parking brake
I
I
Fuel lines, hoses and connections
I
I
52
I
39
32
Fuel filter *4
26
24
48
Fuel tank air filter *4
13
Km×1,000
16
36
I
8
Miles×1,000
24
I
12
Months
Vapor hose, fuel filler cap and fuel tank
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
MAINTENANCE
ITEM
Normal Maintenance Schedule (CONT)
Maintenance
08
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars normally used under
severe driving conditions. Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance
intervals.
I: Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace or change.
MAINTENANCE ITEM
MAINTENANCE
OPERATION
MAINTENANCE
INTERVALS
DRIVING
CONDITION
Every 5,000 miles or A, B, C, D, E, F,
6 months
G, H, I, J, K, L
Engine oil and filter
R
Air cleaner filter
R
More frequently
C, E
Spark plugs
R
More frequently
A, B, H, I, K
Intelligent variable transmission
fluid (If equipped)
R
Every 60,000 miles
A, C, D, E, F, G,
H, I, J
Manual transmission fluid
R
Every 80,000 miles
C, D, F, G, H,
I, J
Front brake disc/pads, calipers
I
More frequently
C, D, G, H
Rear brake shoes or disc/pads
I
More frequently
C, D, G, F
Parking brake
I
More frequently
C, D, G, H
Steering gear box, linkage &
boots/lower arm ball joint,
upper arm ball joint
I
More frequently
C, D, E, F, G,
H, I
Drive shafts and boots
I
More frequently
C, D, E, F, G,
H, I, J
Climate control air filter
(for evaporator and blower unit)
R
More frequently
C, E
Severe Driving Conditions
A. Repeatedly driving short distances
of less than 5 miles (8 km) in normal
temperature or less than 10 miles (16
km) in freezing temperature
B. Extensive engine idling or low speed
driving for long distances
C. Driving on rough, dusty, muddy,
unpaved, graveled or saltspread roads
D. Driving in areas using salt or other
corrosive materials or in very cold
weather
E. Driving in sandy areas
F. Driving in heavy traffic area over 90°F
(32°C)
G. Driving on uphill, downhill, or
mountain road
H. Towing a Trailer, or using a camper, or
roof rack
I. Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other
commercial use or vehicle towing
J. Driving over 106 mph (170 km/h)
K. Frequently driving in stop-and-go
conditions
L. Engine oil usage which is not
recommended (Mineral type, Semisynthetic, lower grade spec, etc.)
8-11
Maintenance
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Engine Oil and Filter
The engine oil and filter should be
changed at the intervals specified in the
maintenance schedule. If the vehicle
is being driven in severe conditions,
more frequent oil and filter changes are
required.
Drive Belts
Inspect all drive belts for evidence
of cuts, cracks, excessive wear or oil
saturation and replace if necessary. Drive
belts should be checked periodically
for proper tension and adjusted as
necessary.
Fuel Filter
A clogged-up fuel filter may limit the
vehicle driving speed, damage the
emission system, and cause the hard
starting. When a considerable amount
of foreign substances are accumulated
in the fuel tank, the fuel filter should be
replaced.
Upon installing a new fuel filter, operate
the engine for several minutes, and
check the connections for any leakages.
Fuel filters should be installed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-12
Fuel Lines, Fuel Hoses and
Connections
Check the fuel lines, fuel hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
replace any damaged or leaking parts
immediately.
Vapor Hose and Fuel Filler Cap
The vapor hose and fuel filler cap should
be inspected at those intervals specified
in the maintenance schedule. Make sure
a new vapor hose or fuel filler cap is
correctly replaced.
Vacuum Crankcase Ventilation
Hoses (if equipped)
Inspect the surface of hoses for evidence
of heat and/or mechanical damage.
Hard and brittle rubber, cracking,
tears, cuts, abrasions, and excessive
swelling indicate deterioration. Particular
attention should be paid to examine
those hose surfaces nearest to high heat
sources, such as the exhaust manifold.
Inspect the hose routing to ensure that
the hoses do not come in contact with
any heat source, sharp edges or moving
component which might cause heat
damage or mechanical wear. Inspect
all hose connections, such as clamps
and couplings, to make sure they are
secure, and that no leaks are present.
Hoses should be replaced immediately if
there is any evidence of deterioration or
damage.
08
Air Cleaner Filter
A genuine HYUNDAI air cleaner filter
is recommended when the filter is
replaced.
Spark Plugs
Make sure to install new spark plugs of
the correct heat range.
When assembling parts, be sure to
wipe out foreign substances inside
and outside of the boot bottom of the
ignition coil and the insulator of the
spark plug with a soft cloth to prevent
contamination of the spark plug
insulator.
Cooling System
Check cooling system components, such
as radiator, coolant reservoir, hoses and
connections for leakage and damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Engine Coolant
The coolant should be changed at the
intervals specified in the maintenance
schedule.
Intelligent Variable Transmission
(IVT) Fluid (if equipped)
NOTICE
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT)
fluid color is basically light amber.
As the vehicle is driven, the Intelligent
Variable Transmission (IVT) fluid will
begin to look darker. This is a normal
condition and you should not judge the
need to replace the fluid based upon
the changed color.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified fluid could
result in transmission malfunction
and failure. Use only the specified
fluid (recommended Lubricants and
Capacities is in chapter. 2).
Manual Transmission Fluid
(if equipped)
Inspect the manual transmission fluid
according to the maintenance schedule.
Brake Hoses and Lines
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and any
leakage. Replace any deteriorated or
damaged parts immediately.
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT)
fluid should not be checked under
normal usage conditions. But in
severe conditions, the fluid should be
changed at an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer in accordance to the scheduled
maintenance at the beginning of this
chapter.
8-13
Maintenance
Brake/Clutch Fluid
Suspension Mounting Bolts
Check the brake fluid level in the brake
fluid reservoir. The level should be
between the MIN and the MAX marks
on the side of the reservoir. Use only
hydraulic brake fluid conforming to DOT
4 specification.
Check the suspension connections for
looseness or damage. Retighten to the
specified torque.
Parking Brake
With the vehicle stopped and the engine
off, check for excessive freeplay in the
steering wheel. Check the linkage for
bends or damage. Check the dust boots
and ball joints for deterioration, cracks,
or damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Inspect the parking brake system
including the parking brake pedal and
cables.
Brake Discs, Pads, Calipers and
Rotors
Check the pads for excessive wear, discs
for run out and wear, and calipers for
fluid leakage.
Exhaust Pipe and Muffler
Visually inspect the exhaust pipes,
muffler and hangers for cracks,
deterioration, or damage. Start
the engine and listen carefully for
any exhaust gas leakage. Tighten
connections or replace parts as
necessary.
8-14
Steering Gear Box, Linkage &
Boots/Lower Arm Ball Joint
Drive Shafts and Boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and clamps
for cracks, deterioration, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts and, if
necessary, repack the grease.
Air Conditioning Refrigerant
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
08
ENGINE OIL
Checking the Engine Oil Level
1. Follow all of the oil manufacturer’s
precautions.
2. Be sure the vehicle is on the level
ground in P (Park) with the parking
brake set. If possible, block the
wheels.
3. Turn the engine on and allow the
engine to reach normal operating
temperature.
4. Turn the engine off and wait about 15
minutes for the oil to return to the oil
pan.
5. Pull the dipstick out, wipe it clean, and
re-insert it fully.
Use only the specified engine oil. (refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” in chapter 2).
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your engine:
ś Do not overfill with engine oil. Add oil
in small quantities and recheck level
to ensure engine is not overfilled.
ś Do not spill engine oil when adding
or changing engine oil. Use a funnel
to help prevent oil from being spilled
on engine components. Wipe off
spilled oil immediately.
Checking the Engine Oil and
Filter
OQX089003L
6. Pull the dipstick out again and check
the level. The level should be between
F and L.
OCN7080082L
Have engine oil and filter changed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer according
to the Maintenance Schedule at the
beginning of this chapter.
WARNING
OQX089004L
7. If it is near or at L, add enough oil to
bring the level to F.
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Engine oil contains chemicals known to
the State of California to cause cancer,
birth defects and reproductive harm.
Used engine oil may cause irritation or
cancer of the skin if left in contact with
the skin for prolonged periods of time.
Always protect your skin by washing
your hands thoroughly with soap and
warm water as soon as possible after
handling used oil.
8-15
Maintenance
ENGINE COOLANT
The high-pressure cooling system has a
reservoir filled with year-round antifreeze
coolant. The reservoir is filled at the
factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at
the beginning of the winter season and
before traveling to a colder climate.
NOTICE
ś When the engine overheats from
low engine coolant, suddenly adding
engine coolant may cause cracks
in the engine. To prevent damage,
add engine coolant slowly in small
quantities.
ś Do not drive with no engine coolant.
It may cause water pump failure and
engine seizure, etc.
Checking the Engine Coolant
Level
OQX089005L
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen or
deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between the F and the L marks on the
side of the coolant reservoir when the
engine is cool.
8-16
If the coolant level is low, add enough
distilled (deionized) water to bring the
level to the F mark, but do not overfill. If
frequent additions are required, see an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for a cooling
system inspection.
Recommended Engine Coolant
ś When adding coolant, use only
distilled (deionized) water for your
vehicle and never mix hard water in
the coolant filled at the factory.
ś An improper coolant mixture can
result in severe malfunction or engine
damage.
ś The engine in your vehicle has
aluminum engine parts and must be
protected by an ethylene-glycol with
phosphate based coolant to prevent
corrosion and freezing.
ś Do not use alcohol or methanol
coolant or mix them with the specified
coolant.
ś Do not use a solution that contains
more than 60% antifreeze or less than
35% antifreeze, which would reduce
the effectiveness of the solution.
08
For mixing percentage, refer to the
following table:
Ambient
Temperature
Mixture Percentage
(volume)
Antifreeze
Water
5°F (-15°C)
35
65
-13°F (-25°C)
40
60
-31°F (-35°C)
50
50
-49°F (-45°C)
60
40
OQX089005N
WARNING
Information
If in doubt about the mix ratio, a 50%
water and 50% antifreeze mix is the
easiest to mix together as it will be the
same quantity of each. It is suitable to use
for most temperature ranges of - 31°F and
higher.
WARNING
Make sure the coolant cap is properly
closed after refilling coolant. Otherwise
the engine could be overheated while
driving.
Engine room front view
Never remove the engine
coolant reservoir tank/radiator
cap or the drain plug while the
engine and radiator are hot.
Hot coolant and steam may blow out
under pressure, causing serious injury.
Turn the engine off and wait until the
engine cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the engine coolant
reservoir tank/radiator cap. Wrap
a thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the first
stop. Step back while the pressure is
released from the cooling system. When
you are sure all the pressure has been
released, press down on the cap, using
a thick towel, and continue turning
counterclockwise to remove it.
OQX089006L
1. Check if the coolant cap label is
straight In front.
2. Make sure that the tiny protrusions
inside the coolant cap is securely
interlocked.
8-17
Maintenance
WARNING
The electric motor for the
cooling fan may continue to
operate or start up when the
engine is not running and can
cause serious injury. Keep
hands, clothing and tools away
from the rotating fan blades of
the cooling fan.
The electric motor for the cooling
fan is controlled by engine coolant
temperature, refrigerant pressure and
vehicle speed. As the engine coolant
temperature decreases, the electric
motor will automatically shut off. This
is a normal condition. If your vehicle is
equipped with GDI, the electric motor
for the cooling fan may begin to operate
at any time and continue to operate until
you disconnect the negative battery
cable.
8-18
Changing Engine Coolant
Have coolant changed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer according to the
Maintenance Schedule at the beginning
of this chapter.
WARNING
Do not use engine coolant or antifreeze
in the washer fluid reservoir.
Engine coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Engine coolant may also cause damage
to paint and body trim.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to engine parts, put
a thick towel around the radiator cap
before refilling the coolant to prevent
the coolant from overflowing into
engine parts, such as the alternator.
08
BRAKE/CLUTCH FLUID
Checking the Brake/Clutch Fluid
Level
WARNING
Do not allow brake fluid to come in
contact with your eyes. If brake/clutch
fluid comes in contact with your eyes,
flush your eyes with clean water for
at least 15 minutes and get immediate
medical attention.
NOTICE
OQX089007L
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX and MIN marks on the side
of the reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap and
adding brake/clutch fluid, clean the area
around the reservoir cap thoroughly to
prevent brake fluid contamination.
If the level is low, add the specified
brake/clutch fluid to the MAX level. The
level will fall with accumulated mileage.
This is a normal condition associated
with the wear of the brake linings. If
the fluid level is excessively low, have
the brake/clutch system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Do not allow brake fluid to contact
the vehicle’s body paint, as paint
damage will result.
ś Brake/clutch fluid, which has been
exposed to open air for an extended
time should NEVER be used as its
quality cannot be guaranteed. It
should be disposed of properly.
ś Do not use the wrong kind of brake
fluid. A few drops of mineral based
oil, such as engine oil, in your brake
system can damage brake system
parts.
Information
Use only the specified brake fluid (refer
to “Recommended Lubricants and
Capacities” in chapter 2).
WARNING
If the brake system requires frequent
additions of fluid this could indicate
a leak in the brake system. Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
8-19
Maintenance
WASHER FLUID
PARKING BRAKE
Checking the Washer Fluid Level
Checking the Parking Brake
OQX089008L
Check the fluid level in the washer fluid
reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain
water may be used if washer fluid is not
available. However, use washer solvent
with antifreeze characteristics in cold
climates to prevent freezing.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury or death, take
the following safety precautions when
using washer fluid:
ś Do not use engine coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir.
Engine coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident or damage to paint and
body trim.
ś Do not allow sparks or flames to
contact the washer fluid or the
washer fluid reservoir. Washer fluid
may contain alcohol and can be
flammable.
ś Do not drink washer fluid and avoid
contact with skin. Washer fluid is
harmful to humans and animals.
ś Keep washer fluid away from
children and animals.
8-20
OQX069005L
Check the stroke of the parking brake
by counting the number of “clicks”
heard while fully applying it from the
released position. Also, the parking brake
alone should securely hold the vehicle
on a fairly steep grade. If the stroke is
more or less than specified, have the
parking brake adjusted by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Stroke : 6~7 clicks at a force of 44 lbs
(20 kg, 196 N)
08
AIR CLEANER
Filter Replacement
The air cleaner filter can be cleaned for
inspection using compressed air.
Do not attempt to wash or to rinse it, as
water will damage the filter.
If soiled, the air cleaner filter must be
replaced.
OQX089041
4. Lock the cover with the cover
attaching clips.
5. Check that the cover is firmly
installed.
Information
OAD078142
1. Loosen the air cleaner cover attaching
clips and open the cover.
2. Wipe the inside of the air cleaner.
If the vehicle is operated in extremely
dusty or sandy areas, replace the element
more often than the usual recommended
intervals (refer to “Maintenance Under
Severe Usage Conditions” in this chapter).
NOTICE
OAD078143
3. Replace the air cleaner filter.
ś Do not drive with the air cleaner filter
removed. This will result in excessive
engine wear.
ś When removing the air cleaner filter,
be careful that dust or dirt does not
enter the air intake, or damage may
result.
ś Use HYUNDAI genuine parts. Use of
non-genuine parts could damage the
air flow sensor.
8-21
Maintenance
CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER
Filter Inspection
The climate control air filter should be
replaced according to the Maintenance
Schedule. If the vehicle is operated
in severely air-polluted cities or on
dusty rough roads for a long period, it
should be inspected more frequently
and replaced earlier. When you replace
the climate control air filter, replace it
performing the following procedure,
and be careful to avoid damaging other
components.
OQX089045
OQX089046
OQX089010L
1. With the glove box open, push in both
sides of the glove box as shown. This
will ensure that the glove box stopper
pins will get released from its holding
location allowing the glove box to
hang.
2. Open the climate control air filter
cover (2) by pushing or pressing the
clip (1) on the right and left side.
OPD076026
3. Replace the climate control air filter.
4. Reassemble in the reverse order of
disassembly.
NOTICE
8-22
Install a new climate control air filter
in the correct direction with the arrow
V\PERO Ƣ IDFLQJGRZQZDUGVRWKHUZLVH
it may be noisy and the effectiveness of
the filter may be reduced.
08
WIPER BLADES
Blade Inspection
Blade Replacement
Contamination of either the windshield
or the wiper blades with foreign matter
can reduce the effectiveness of the
windshield wiper functionality. Common
sources of contamination are insects,
tree sap, and hot wax treatments used
by some commercial car washes. If the
blades are not wiping properly, clean
both the window and the blades with a
clean cloth dampened with washer fluid.
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn or
cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper blades,
arms or other components, do not:
ś Use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or near
them.
ś Attempt to move the wipers
manually.
ś Use non-specified wiper blades.
Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by
automatic car washes have been known to
make the windshield difficult to clean.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, do not attempt to
move the wipers manually.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified wiper blade
could result in wiper malfunction and
failure.
NOTICE
ś In order to prevent damage to the
hood and the wiper arms, the wiper
arms should only be lifted when in
the top wiping position.
ś Always return the wiper arms to the
windshield before driving.
Front Windshield Wiper Blade
Replacement
OGSR076067
1. Put the front windshield wipers into
the service position.
2. Raise the wiper arm and slightly rotate
the wiper blade assembly to expose
the plastic locking clip.
8-23
Maintenance
NOTICE
Do not allow the wiper arm to fall
against the windshield, since it may
chip or crack the windshield.
Rear Window Wiper Blade
Replacement
OTL075050
OGSR076066
OGSR076068
3. Press the clip (1) and slide the blade
assembly downward (2).
4. Lift it off the arm.
5. Install the blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
6. Return the wiper arm on the
windshield.
8-24
1. Raise the wiper arm and pull out the
wiper blade assembly.
OTL075051
2. Install the new blade assembly by
inserting the center part into the slot
in the wiper arm until it clicks into
place.
3. Make sure the blade assembly is
installed firmly by trying to pull it
slightly.
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, have the wiper
blades replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
08
BATTERY
WARNING
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
to you or bystanders, always follow
these precautions when working near
or handling the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions carefully when
handling a battery.
Wear eye protection designed
to protect the eyes from acid
splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks, or
smoking materials away from
the battery.
Hydrogen is always present
in battery cells, is highly
combustible, and may explode
if ignited.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children.
Batteries contain sulfuric acid
which is highly corrosive. Do
not allow acid to contact your
eyes, skin or clothing.
If acid gets into your eyes, flush your
eyes with clean water for at least 15
minutes and get immediate medical
attention. If acid gets on your skin,
thoroughly wash the area. If you feel
pain or a burning sensation, get medical
attention immediately.
ś When lifting a plastic-cased battery,
excessive pressure on the case may
cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a
battery carrier or with your hands on
opposite corners.
ś Do not attempt to jump start your
vehicle if your battery is frozen.
ś NEVER attempt to recharge the
battery when the vehicle’s battery
cables are connected to the battery.
ś The electrical ignition system works
with high voltage. NEVER touch
these components with the engine
running or when the ignition switch
is in the ON position.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Battery posts, terminals, and related
accessories contain lead and lead
compounds, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer,
birth defects and reproductive harm.
Batteries also contain other chemicals
known to the State of California
to cause cancer. Wash hands after
handling.
NOTICE
ś When you do not use the vehicle for a
long time in a low temperature area,
disconnect the battery and keep it
indoors.
ś Always charge the battery fully to
prevent battery case damage in low
temperature areas.
8-25
Maintenance
For Best Battery Service
OQX089042
ś Keep the battery securely mounted.
ś Keep the battery top clean and dry.
ś Keep the terminals and connections
clean, tight, and coated with
petroleum jelly or terminal grease.
ś Rinse any spilled acid from the battery
immediately with a solution of water
and baking soda.
Battery Recharging
WARNING
Always follow these instructions when
recharging your vehicle’s battery to
avoid the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH from explosions or acid burns:
ś Before performing maintenance or
recharging the battery, turn off all
accessories and place the ignition
switch to the LOCK/OFF position.
ś Keep all flames, sparks, or smoking
materials away from the battery.
ś Always work outdoors or in an area
with plenty of ventilation.
ś Wear eye protection when checking
the battery during charging.
ś The battery must be removed from
the vehicle and placed in a well
ventilated area.
ś Watch the battery during charging,
and stop or reduce the charging
rate if the battery cells begin boiling
violently.
8-26
ś The negative battery cable must
be removed first and installed last
when the battery is disconnected.
Disconnect the battery charger in the
following order:
1. Turn off the battery charger main
switch.
2. Unhook the negative clamp from
the negative battery terminal.
3. Unhook the positive clamp from
the positive battery terminal.
ś Always use a genuine HYUNDAI
approved battery when you replace
the battery.
By Jump Starting
After a jump start from a good battery,
drive the vehicle for 20-30 minutes
before it is shutoff. The vehicle may
not restart if you shut it off before the
battery had a chance to adequately
recharge. See “Jump Starting” in chapter
7 for more information on jump starting
procedures.
Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to
the environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s) or
regulations.
Reset Features
The following items may need to be reset
after the battery has been discharged or
the battery has been disconnected. See
chapter 3 or 4 for:
ś Power Windows
ś Trip Computer
ś Climate Control System
ś Clock
ś Audio System
ś Sunroof
08
TIRES AND WHEELS
WARNING
Tire failure may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident. To reduce risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the
following precautions:
ś Inspect your tires monthly for
proper inflation as well as wear
and damage.
ś The recommended cold tire
pressure for your vehicle can be
found in this manual and on the
tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar. Always use a
tire pressure gauge to measure
tire pressure. Tires with too
much or too little pressure wear
unevenly causing poor handling.
ś Check the pressure of the
spare every time you check the
pressure of the other tires on
your vehicle.
ś Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of
braking effectiveness, steering
control, or traction.
ś ALWAYS replace tires with
the same type, size, brand,
construction and tread pattern
as each tire that was originally
supplied with this vehicle. Using
tires and wheels other than the
recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics,
poor vehicle control, or
negatively affect your vehicle’s
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
resulting in a serious accident.
Tire Care
For proper maintenance, safety, and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended
tire inflation pressures and stay
within the load limits and weight
distribution recommended for your
vehicle.
OQX089049N
All specifications (sizes and
pressures) can be found on a label
attached to the driver’s side center
pillar.
Recommended Cold Tire
Inflation Pressures
All tire pressures (including the
spare) should be checked when the
tires are cold. “Cold tires” means the
vehicle has not been driven for at
least three hours or has been driven
for less than one mile (1.6 km).
Warm tires normally exceed
recommended cold tire pressures
by 4 to 6 psi (28 to 41 kPa). Do not
release air from warm tires to adjust
the pressure or the tires will be
under-inflated. For recommended
inflation pressure, refer to “Tire and
Wheels” in chapter 2.
8-27
Maintenance
WARNING
Recommended pressures must be
maintained for the best ride, vehicle
handling, and minimum tire wear.
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and lead to
sudden tire failure that could result
in loss of vehicle control resulting in
an accident.
Severe under-inflation can lead
to severe heat build-up, causing
blowouts, tread separation and
other tire failures that can result in
the loss of vehicle control resulting
in an accident. This risk is much
higher on hot days and when
driving for long periods at high
speeds.
CAUTION
ś Under-inflation results in
excessive wear, poor handling
and reduced fuel economy.
Wheel deformation is also
possible. Keep your tire pressures
at the proper levels. If a tire
frequently needs refilling, have
it checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Over-inflation produces a harsh
ride, excessive wear at the center
of the tire tread, and a greater
possibility of damage from road
hazards.
8-28
Check Tire Inflation Pressure
Check your tires, including the spare
tire, once a month or more.
How to Check
Use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to check tire pressure. You
can not tell if your tires are properly
inflated simply by looking at them.
Radial tires may look properly inflated
when they are under-inflated.
Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem. Press the tire gauge
firmly onto the valve to get a
pressure measurement. If the cold
tire inflation pressure matches the
recommended pressure on the tire
label located on the driver’s side
center pillar or in this manual. No
further adjustment is necessary. If
the pressure is low, add air until you
reach the recommended pressure.
Make sure to put the valve caps
back on the valve stems. Without
the valve cap, dirt or moisture could
get into the valve core and cause
air leakage. If a valve cap is missing,
install a new one as soon as possible.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the
tire pressure with the tire gauge. Be
sure to put the valve caps back on
the valve stems. Without the valve
cap, dirt or moisture could get into
the valve core and cause air leakage.
If a valve cap is missing, install a new
one as soon as possible.
A cold tire means the vehicle has
been sitting for 3 hours and driven
for less than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3
hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring
the inflation pressure. Always be sure
the tire is cold before inflating to the
recommended pressure.
08
Tire Rotation
To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI
recommends that the tires
be rotated according to the
maintenance schedule or sooner if
irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for
uneven wear and damage. Abnormal
wear is usually caused by incorrect
tire pressure, improper wheel
alignment, out-of-balance wheels,
severe braking or severe cornering.
Look for bumps or bulges in the
tread or side of the tire. Replace
the tire if you find any of these
conditions. Replace the tire if fabric
or cord is visible. After rotation, be
sure to bring the front and rear tire
pressures to specification and check
lug nut tightness (proper torque is
79~94 lbf·ft [11~13 kgf·m]).
Without a spare tire
ODH073802
Disc brake pads should be inspected
for wear whenever tires are rotated.
Information
Tires that are asymmetrical or
directional can only be installed on
the wheel in one direction. The outside
and inside of an asymmetrical tire
is not easily distinguishable. Pay
careful attention to the markings
on the sidewalls of the tires, noting
the “outside” marking and also the
rotating direction before installing
them on the vehicle.
WARNING
ś Do not use the compact spare
tire for tire rotation.
ś Do not mix bias ply and radial ply
tires under any circumstances.
This may cause unusual handling
characteristics that may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in
an accident.
Wheel Alignment and Tire
Balance
The wheels on your vehicle were
aligned and balanced carefully at the
factory to give you the longest tire
life and best overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to
have your wheels aligned again.
However, if you notice unusual tire
wear or your vehicle pulling one way
or the other, the alignment may need
to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating
when driving on a smooth road, your
wheels may need to be rebalanced.
NOTICE
Improper wheel weights can
damage your vehicle’s aluminum
wheels. Use only approved wheel
weights.
8-29
Maintenance
Tire Replacement
WARNING
Tread wear indicator
OLMB073027
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear
indicator will appear as a solid band
across the tread. This shows there is
less than 2/32 inch (1.6 mm) of tread
left on the tire. Replace the tire when
this happens.
Do not wait for the tread surface to
become level with the tread wear
indicators before replacing the tire.
8-30
To reduce the risk of DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY:
ś Replace tires that are worn, show
uneven wear, or are damaged.
Worn tires can cause loss of
braking effectiveness, steering
control, and traction.
ś Always replace tires with the
same size as each tire that was
originally supplied with this
vehicle. Using tires and wheels
other than the recommended
sizes could cause unusual
handling characteristics, poor
vehicle control, or negatively
affect your vehicle’s Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) resulting in a
serious accident.
ś Tires degrade over time, even
when they are not being used.
Regardless of the remaining
tread, HYUNDAI recommends
that tires be replaced after six (6)
years of normal service.
ś When replacing tires, it is
recommended to replace the
two front or two rear tires as a
pair. Replacing just one tire can
seriously affect your vehicle’s
handling. If only replacing one
pair of tires, it is recommended
to install the pair of new tires on
the rear axle.
ś Heat caused by hot climates or
frequent high loading conditions
can accelerate the aging process.
Failure to follow this warning
may cause sudden tire failure,
which could lead to a loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
08
Compact Spare Tire Replacement
A compact spare tire has a shorter
tread life than a regular size tire.
Replace it when you can see the
tread wear indicator bars on the tire.
The replacement compact spare tire
should be the same size and design
tire as the one provided with your
new vehicle and should be mounted
on the same compact spare tire
wheel. The compact spare tire is
not designed to be mounted on a
regular size wheel, and the compact
spare tire wheel is not designed for
mounting a regular size tire.
WARNING
The original tire should be repaired
or replaced as soon as possible to
avoid failure of the spare and loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident. The compact spare tire
is for emergency use only. Do not
operate your vehicle over 50 MPH
(80 km/h) when using the compact
spare tire.
Wheel Replacement
When replacing the metal wheels
for any reason, make sure the new
wheels are equivalent to the original
factory units in diameter, rim width
and offset.
Tire Traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you
drive on worn tires, tires that are
improperly inflated or on slippery
road surfaces. Tires should be
replaced when the tread depth is at
least 2/32 inch (1.6 mm). To reduce
the possibility of losing control, slow
down whenever there is rain, snow
or ice on the road.
Tire Maintenance
In addition to proper inflation,
correct wheel alignment helps to
decrease tire wear. If you find a tire
is worn unevenly, have your dealer
check the wheel alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This
will increase vehicle ride comfort
and tire life. Additionally, a tire
should always be rebalanced if it is
removed from the wheel.
Tire Sidewall Labeling
This information identifies and
describes the fundamental
characteristics of the tire and also
provides the tire identification
number (TIN) for safety standard
certification. The TIN can be used to
identify the tire in case of a recall.
8-31
Maintenance
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with
important information that you need
if you ever have to replace one. The
following explains what the letters
and numbers in the wheel size
designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
6.0J X 15
OLMB073028
1. Manufacturer or Brand Name
Manufacturer or brand name is
shown.
2. Tire Size Designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a
tire size designation. You will need
this information when selecting
replacement tires for your car.
The following explains what the
letters and numbers in the tire size
designation mean.
Example tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as
an example only; your tire size
designator could vary depending on
your vehicle.)
185/65/R15 88H
185 - Tire width in millimeters.
65 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section
height as a percentage of its
width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
15 - Rim diameter in inches.
88 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum
load the tire can carry.
H - Speed Rating Symbol. See the
speed rating chart in this section
for additional information.
8-32
6.0 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
15 - Rim diameter in inches.
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the
different speed ratings currently
being used for passenger vehicle
tires. The speed rating is part of the
tire size designation on the sidewall
of the tire. This symbol corresponds
to that tire’s designed maximum safe
operating speed.
Speed Rating
Symbol
S
T
H
V
W
Y
Maximum Speed
112 mph (180 km/h)
118 mph (190 km/h)
130 mph (210 km/h)
149 mph (240 km/h)
168 mph (270 km/h)
186 mph (300 km/h)
08
3. Checking Tire Life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
Any tires that are over six years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
(including the spare tire) should be
replaced by new ones. You can find
the manufacturing date on the tire
sidewall (possibly on the inside of
the wheel), displaying the DOT Code.
The DOT Code is a series of numbers
on a tire consisting of numbers and
English letters. The manufacturing
date is designated by the last four
digits (characters) of the DOT code.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
The front part of the DOT shows a
plant code number, tire size and
tread pattern and the last four
numbers indicate week and year
manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 1421 represents that
the tire was produced in the 14th
week of 2021.
4. Tire Ply Composition And Material
The number of layers or plies of
rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include
steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
The letter “R” means radial ply
construction; the letter “D” means
diagonal or bias ply construction;
and the letter “B” means belted-bias
ply construction.
5. Maximum Permissible Inflation
Pressure
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer
to the Tire and Loading Information
label for recommended inflation
pressure.
6. Maximum Load Rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that
can be carried by the tire. When
replacing the tires on the vehicle,
always use a tire that has the same
load rating as the factory installed
tire.
7. Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and
maximum section width.
For example:
TREAD WEAR 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
8-33
Maintenance
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a
comparative rating based on the
wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would
wear one-and-a-half times (1½) as
well on the government course as a
tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm
due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in
road characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the
sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires.
The tires available as standard or
optional equipment on your vehicle
may vary with respect to grade.
Traction AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest
to lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those
grades represent the tire’s ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces
of asphalt and concrete. A tire
marked C may have poor traction
performance.
8-34
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this
tire is based on straight-ahead
braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering,
hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
Temperature A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation
of heat and its ability to dissipate
heat when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can
cause the material of the tire to
degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. Grade C responds
to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet
under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades
B and A represent higher levels of
performance on the laboratory test
wheel than the minimum required
by law.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this
tire is established for a tire that
is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
under-inflation, over-inflation, or
excessive loading, either separately
or in combination, can cause heat
build-up and possible sudden
tire failure. This may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
08
Tire Terminology and Definitions
Air Pressure
The amount of air inside the tire
pressing outward on the tire. Air
pressure is expressed in pounds per
square inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).
Accessory Weight
This means the combined weight
of optional accessories. Some
examples of optional accessories
are automatic transmission, power
seats, and air conditioning.
Aspect Ratio
The relationship of a tire’s height to
its width.
Belt
A rubber coated layer of cords that
is located between the plies and the
tread. Cords may be made from steel
or other reinforcing materials.
Bead
The tire bead contains steel wires
wrapped by steel cords that hold the
tire onto the rim.
Bias Ply Tire
A pneumatic tire in which the plies are
laid at alternate angles less than 90
degrees to the centerline of the tread.
Cold Tire Pressure
The amount of air pressure in a tire,
measured in pounds per square inch
(psi) or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire
has built up heat from driving.
Curb Weight
This means the weight of a motor
vehicle with standard and optional
equipment including the maximum
capacity of fuel, oil and coolant, but
without passengers and cargo.
DOT Markings
A code molded into the sidewall
of a tire signifying that the tire
is in compliance with the U.S.
Department of Transportation motor
vehicle safety standards. The DOT
code includes the Tire Identification
Number (TIN), an alphanumeric
designator which can also identify
the tire manufacturer, production
plant, brand and date of production.
GVWR
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
GAWR FRT
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the
Front Axle.
GAWR RR
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the
Rear axle.
Intended Outboard Sidewall
The side of an asymmetrical tire,
that must always face outward when
mounted on a vehicle.
Kilopascal (kPa)
The metric unit for air pressure.
Light Truck (LT) Tire
A tire designated by its manufacturer
as primarily intended for use on
lightweight trucks or multipurpose
passenger vehicles.
Load Ratings
The maximum load that a tire is rated
to carry for a given inflation pressure.
Load Index
An assigned number ranging from 1
to 279 that corresponds to the load
carrying capacity of a tire.
8-35
Maintenance
Maximum Inflation Pressure
The maximum air pressure to which
a cold tire may be inflated. The
maximum air pressure is molded
onto the sidewall.
Maximum Load Rating
The load rating for a tire at the
maximum permissible inflation
pressure for that tire.
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight
The sum of curb weight; accessory
weight; vehicle capacity weight; and
production options weight.
Normal Occupant Weight
The number of occupants a vehicle
is designed to seat multiplied by 150
pounds (68 kg).
Occupant Distribution
Designated seating positions.
Outward Facing Sidewall
An asymmetrical tire has a particular
side that faces outward when
mounted on a vehicle. The outward
facing sidewall bears white lettering
or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or
model name molding that is higher
or deeper than the same moldings
on the inner facing sidewall.
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire
A tire used on passenger cars
and some light duty trucks and
multipurpose vehicles.
Ply
A layer of rubber-coated parallel
cords.
8-36
Pneumatic Tire
A mechanical device made of rubber,
chemicals, fabric and steel or other
materials, that, when mounted on
an automotive wheel provides the
traction and contains the gas or fluid
that sustains the load.
Pneumatic Options Weight
The combined weight of installed
regular production options weighing
over 5 lb. (2.3 kg) in excess of the
standard items which they replace,
not previously considered in
curb weight or accessory weight,
including heavy duty breaks, ride
levelers, roof rack, heavy duty
battery, and special trim.
Recommended Inflation Pressure
Vehicle manufacturer’s
recommended tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
Radial Ply Tire
A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords
that extend to the beads are laid at 90
degrees to the centerline of the tread.
Rim
A metal support for a tire and upon
which the tire beads are seated.
Sidewall
The portion of a tire between the
tread and the bead.
Speed Rating
An alphanumeric code assigned to a
tire indicating the maximum speed
at which a tire can operate.
Traction
The friction between the tire and the
road surface. The amount of grip
provided.
08
Tread
The portion of a tire that comes into
contact with the road.
Treadwear Indicators
Narrow bands, sometimes called
“wear bars”, that show across the
tread of a tire when only 1/16 inch of
tread remains.
UTQGS
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards is a tire information
system that provides consumers
with ratings for a tire’s traction,
temperature and treadwear.
Ratings are determined by tire
manufacturers using government
testing procedures. The ratings are
molded into the sidewall of the tire.
Vehicle Capacity Weight
The number of designated seating
positions multiplied by 150 lbs. (68
kg) plus the rated cargo and luggage
load.
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire
Load on an individual tire due to curb
and accessory weight plus maximum
occupant and cargo weight.
Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire
Load on an individual tire that is
determined by distributing to each
axle its share of the curb weight,
accessory weight, and normal
occupant weight and dividing by 2.
Vehicle Placard
A label permanently attached
to a vehicle showing the
original equipment tire size and
recommended inflation pressure.
All Season Tires
HYUNDAI specifies all season
tires on some models to provide
good performance for use all year
round, including snowy and icy
road conditions. All season tires
are identified by ALL SEASON and/
or M+S (Mud and Snow) on the tire
sidewall. Snow tires have better
snow traction than all season tires
and may be more appropriate in
some areas.
Summer Tires
HYUNDAI specifies summer tires on
some models to provide superior
performance on dry roads. Summer
tire performance is substantially
reduced in snow and ice. Summer
tires do not have the tire traction
rating M+S (Mud and Snow) on
the tire side wall. If you plan to
operate your vehicle in snowy or icy
conditions, HYUNDAI recommends
the use of snow tires or all season
tires on all four wheels.
Snow Tires
If you equip your car with snow
tires, they should be the same size
and have the same load capacity as
the original tires. Snow tires should
be installed on all four wheels;
otherwise, poor handling may result.
Snow tires should carry 4 psi (28 kPa)
more air pressure than the pressure
recommended for the standard
tires on the tire label on the driver’s
side of the center pillar, or up to the
maximum pressure shown on the tire
sidewall, whichever is less. Do not
drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h)
when your vehicle is equipped with
snow tires.
8-37
Maintenance
Radial-Ply Tires
Low Aspect Ratio Tires
Radial-ply tires provide improved
tread life, road hazard resistance and
smoother high speed ride. The radialply tires used on this vehicle are of
belted construction, and are selected
to complement the ride and handling
characteristics of your vehicle.
Radial-ply tires have the same load
carrying capacity, as bias-ply or bias
belted tires of the same size, and use
the same recommended inflation
pressure. Mixing of radial-ply tires
with bias-ply or bias belted tires is not
recommended. Any combinations of
radial-ply and bias-ply or bias belted
tires when used on the same vehicle
will seriously deteriorate vehicle
handling. The best rule to follow is:
Identical pairs of radial-ply tires should
always be used as a set for the front
tires and a set for the rear tires.
Longer wearing tires can be more
susceptible to irregular tread wear.
It is very important to follow the tire
rotation interval in this chapter to
achieve the tread life potential of these
tires. Cuts and punctures in radial-ply
tires are repairable only in the tread
area, because of sidewall flexing.
Consult your tire dealer for radial-ply
tire repairs.
The aspect ratio is lower than 50 on
low aspect ratio tires.
Because low aspect ratio tires are
optimized for handling and braking,
their sidewall is a little stiffer than a
standard tire. Also low aspect ratio tires
tend to be wider and consequently
have a greater contact patch with
the road surface. In some instances
they may generate more road noise
compared with standard tires.
WARNING
Do not mix bias ply and radial ply tires
under any circumstances. This may
cause unusual handling characteristics
that may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
8-38
CAUTION
Because the sidewall of a low aspect
ratio tire is shorter than a standard tire,
the rim of the wheel and the tire itself
is more easily susceptible to damage.
Use caution when driving and follow
the guidelines below to help minimize
damage to the wheel and tire:
ś When driving on a rough road
or off road, drive cautiously
because tires and wheels may
be damaged. And after driving,
inspect tires and wheels.
ś When passing over a pothole,
speed bump, manhole, or curb
stone, drive slowly so that the tires
and wheels are not damaged.
ś If the tire is subjected to a severe
impact, have the tire and wheel
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 1,800 miles
(3,000km).
CAUTION
ś It is not easy to recognize tire
damage with your own eyes. But
if there is the slightest hint of tire
damage, have the tire checked or
replaced because the tire damage
may cause air leakage from the tire.
ś If the tire is damaged by driving
on a rough road, off road, pothole,
manhole, or curb stone, it will not
be covered by the warranty.
08
FUSES
Ŷ Blade type
Normal
Blown
Ŷ Cartridge type
If the electrical system does not work,
first check the driver’s side fuse panel.
Before replacing a blown fuse, turn the
engine and all switches off, and then
disconnect the negative battery cable.
Always replace a blown fuse with one of
the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this
indicates an electrical problem.
Avoid using the system involved and
immediately consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Normal
Blown
Ŷ Multi fuse
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but
another fuse of the same rating.
ś A higher capacity fuse could cause
damage and possibly cause a fire.
ś Do not install a wire or aluminum
foil instead of the proper fuse even as a temporary repair. It may
cause extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
NOTICE
Normal
Blown
Do not use a screwdriver or any other
metal object to remove fuses because
it may cause a short circuit and damage
the system.
OTM078035
A vehicle’s electrical system is protected
from electrical overload damage by
fuses.
This vehicle has 2 (or 3) fuse panels, one
located in the driver’s side panel bolster,
the other in the engine compartment
near the battery.
If any of your vehicle’s lights,
accessories, or controls do not work,
check the appropriate circuit fuse. If a
fuse has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
8-39
Maintenance
Instrument Panel Fuse
Replacement
OQX089024L
1.
2.
3.
4.
Turn the engine off.
Turn all other switches OFF.
Open the fuse panel cover.
Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
7. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly in
the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
In an emergency, if you do not have a
spare fuse, use a fuse of the same rating
from a circuit you may not need for
operating the vehicle.
If the headlamps or other electrical
components do not work and the fuses
are undamaged, check the fuse panel
in the engine compartment. If a fuse is
blown, it must be replaced with the same
rating.
Fuse Switch
OQX089036L
OQXI079022
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight out.
Use the removal tool provided in the
engine compartment fuse panel.
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it if
it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in
the instrument panel fuse panels (or in
the engine compartment fuse panel).
8-40
Always, place the fuse switch to the ON
position.
If you move the switch to the OFF
position, some items such as the audio
system and digital clock must be reset
and the smart key may not work properly.
08
Engine Compartment Panel Fuse
Replacement
Information
Blade type fuse
OOS047142L
If the fuse switch is OFF, the above
message will appear.
OQX089038L
Cartridge type fuse
NOTICE
ś Always place the fuse switch in the
ON position while driving the vehicle.
ś Do not move the fuse switch
repeatedly. The fuse switch may be
damaged.
OQX089039L
1. Turn the engine off.
2. Turn all other switches OFF.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tap and pulling up.
4. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. To remove or insert the
fuse, use the fuse puller in the engine
compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly in
the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-41
Maintenance
Multi Fuse
CAUTION
After checking the fuse box in the
engine compartment securely close
the fuse box cover inside the engine
compartment, until it clicks.
If the fuse box is not closed properly,
water may leak in side, possibly causing
a malfunction with the electrical
system.
Main Fuse
OQX089047N
OQXI079025
If the main fuse is blown, it must be
removed as follows:
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tab and pulling it up.
4. Remove the nuts shown in the picture
above.
5. Replace the fuse with a new one of
the same rating.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
Information
If the main fuse is blown, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-42
If the multi fuse is blown, it must be
removed as follows:
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tab and pulling it up.
4. Remove the nuts shown in the picture
above.
5. Replace the fuse with a new one of
the same rating.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
Information
If the multi fuse is blown, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
08
Fuse/Relay Panel Description
Instrument Panel Fuse Panel
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse box on
your vehicle, refer to the fuse box label.
OQX089024L
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OQX089053N
8-43
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
(A)
POWER OUTLET 3
20A
USB Charger
INTERIOR LAMP
10A
Front Vanity Lamp LH/RH, Room Lamp, Map Lamp
HEATED MIRROR
10A
Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror, A/C Control Module
P/WINDOW LH
25A
Power Window Main Switch
FCA
10A
Forward Collision Avoidance Assist Unit
POWER OUTLET 2
20A
Front Power Outlet
IBU 1
15A
IBU
MULTIMEDIA
20A
Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit
SAFETY P/
WINDOW
25A
Driver Safety Power Window Module
P/WINDOW RH
25A
Power Window Main Switch, Passenger Power Window Switch
TCU2
15A
Transaxle Range Switch, Back-Up Lamp Switch
BRAKE SWITCH
10A
IBU, Stop Lamp Switch
MEMORY 1
10A
Instrument Cluster, A/C Control Module
START
7.5A
[M/T] ECM, IBU, [IVT] Transmission Range Switch
8-44
Circuit Protected
08
Driver’s side fuse panel
Fuse Name
(A)
Circuit Protected
S/HEATER
20A
Front Seat Warmer Control Module
MODULE 1
7.5A
Stop Lamp Switch, ATM Shift Lever
MEMORY 2
7.5A
SRS Control Module
AIR BAG
10A
Passenger Occupant Detection Sensor, SRS Control Module
DOOR LOCK
20A
Tail Gate Relay, T/Turn Unlock Realy, Door Lock/Unlock Realy
ECU 6
10A
ECM, PCM
DRL
10A
DRL Relay
MODULE 6
10A
Data Link Connector, Key Interlock Solenoid
T/SIGNAL LAMP
15A
IBU
MODULE 2
10A
Crash Pad Switch, Multifunction Camera Unit, Blind Spot
Collision Warning Unit LH/RH
SUNROOF
15A
Sunroof Motor
MODULE 3
7.5A
Console Switch, ATM Shift Lever Indicator, A/C Control Module,
Audio, Front Seat Warmer Control Module
8-45
Maintenance
Driver’s side fuse panel
Fuse Name
(A)
WIPER RR
15A
E/R Junction Block (Wiper RR Relay), Rear Wiper Motor
WASHER
15A
Multifunction Switch
A/BAG IND
7.5A
Center Facia Switch, Instrument Cluster
IBU 2
7.5A
IBU
ABS3
7.5A
E/R Junction Block (Multipurpose Check Connector), ESC
Module
WIPER FRT
25A
E/R Junction Block (Wiper FRT Low Relay), Front Wiper Motor
A/C 2
7.5A
E/R Junction Block (Blower Relay), A/C Control Module
HEATED
STEERING
15A
Not Used
CLUSTER
7.5A
Instrument Cluster
MODULE 7
10A
Power Outlet Relay, Power Outside Mirror Switch, IBU, Audio,
A/V & Navigation Head Unit
MDPS 2
7.5A
MDPS Unit
MODULE 5
10A
IBU, Front Seat Warmer Control Module
MODULE 4
7.5A
IBU
A/C 3
7.5A
Blower Motor, A/C Control Module
8-46
Circuit Protected
08
Engine Compartment Fuse Panel
Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your vehicle;
the information is accurate at the time of
printing. When you inspect the fuse panel
in your vehicle, refer to the fuse panel
label.
OQXI079024
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can
find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/
relay names and ratings.
OQX089054N
8-47
Maintenance
Engine compartment fuse panel
Fuse Name
MULTI
FUSE
FUSE
8-48
(A)
Circuit Protected
ALT
125A
Alternator, Multi Fuse - MDPS 1, Fuse - Rear Heated,
Blower, ABS 1, ABS 2
MDPS 1
80A
MDPS Unit
REAR
HEATED
40A
ICU Junction Block (Rear Heated Relay)
ABS 1
40A
Multipurpose Check Connector, ESC Module
ABS 2
40A
ESC Module
BLOWER
40A
Blower Relay
WIPER
10A
Wiper FRT LO Realy, IBU
ECU2
15A
ECM/PCM
ECU4
15A
ECM/PCM
ECU5
15A
ECM/PCM
IGN COIL
20A
Ignition Coil #1~#4
INJECTOR
15A
ECM/PCM, Injector #1~#4, Fuel Pump Relay
PTC HEATER
50A
PTC Heater Relay
B+3
50A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - DOOR LOCK, S/HEATER,
SAFETY P/WINDOW, SUNROOF, Power Window Relay)
IG2
40A
Start Relay, PDM Relay Box (IG2 Relay), Ignition Switch
08
Engine compartment fuse panel
Fuse Name
FUSE
(A)
Circuit Protected
COOLING
FAN
40A
Cooling Fan 1/2 Relay
B+4
40A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - MODULE 6, BRAKE
SWITCH, T/SIGNAL LAMP, DRL, IBU 1, Leak Current
Autocut Device)
ECU1
30A
Main Relay, Fuse - ECU 4, ECU 5
A/C 1
10A
A/C Relay
FUEL PUMP
20A
Fuel Pump Relay
HORN
15A
Horn Relay
B+2
30A
ICU Junction Block (IPS (5CH) E-SWITCH, IPS (2CH))
IG1
30A
[With Smart Key] PDM Relay Box (IG1 Relay)
[W/O Smart Key] Ignition Switch
POWER
OUTLET 1
40A
ICU Junction Block (Power Outlet Relay)
B+1
30A
ICU Junction Block (IPS (5CH) E-SWITCH, IPS (1CH))
8-49
Maintenance
LIGHT BULBS
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
to replace most vehicle light bulbs. It is
difficult to replace vehicle light bulbs
because other parts of the vehicle must
be removed before you can get to the
bulb. This is especially true for removing
the headlamp assembly to get to the
bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlamp
assembly can result in damage to the
vehicle.
Headlamp, Parking Lamp,
Daytime Running Light, Turn
Signal Lamp, Cornering Lamp
and Side Marker
Type A
Information
The headlamp and tail lamp lenses could
appear frosty if the vehicle is washed after
driving or the vehicle is driven at night
in wet weather. This condition is caused
by temperature difference between the
lamp inside and outside and, it does not
indicate a problem with your vehicle.
When moisture condenses in the lamp,
it will be removed after driving with the
headlamp on. The removable level may
differ depending on lamp size, lamp
position and environmental condition.
However, if moisture is not removed, we
recommend that your vehicle is inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OQX089014N
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Headlamp (High/Low)
Parking lamp
Turn signal lamp
Side marker
Headlamp and parking lamp
WARNING
WARNING
ś Prior to replacing a lamp, depress the
foot brake, move the shift lever into P
(Park) apply the parking brake, place
the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF
position, and take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle to avoid
sudden movement of the vehicle and
to prevent possible electric shock.
ś Be aware the bulbs may be hot and
may burn your fingers.
8-50
OQX089043
ś Handle halogen bulbs with care.
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces
of glass that could cause injuries if
broken.
ś Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
08
ś Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
ś Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
ś A bulb should be operated only when
installed in a headlamp.
ś If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
5. Remove the bulb from the headlamp
assembly.
6. Install a new headlamp bulb and snap
the headlamp bulb retaining wire into
position by aligning the wire with the
groove on the bulb.
7. Connect the headlamp bulb socketconnector.
8. Install the headlamp bulb cover by
turning it clockwise.
Headlamp and parking lamp
The headlamp aiming should be adjusted
after an accident or after the headlamp
assembly is reinstalled at an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Headlamp (high/low beam)
Information
OQX089015L
Parking lamp
OQX089017L
OQX089016N
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the headlamp bulb cover by
turning it counterclockwise.
4. Disconnect the headlamp bulb
socket-connector.
Turn signal lamp/side marker
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the socket (1) from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
4. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
8-51
Maintenance
5. Install a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
6. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly.
7. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
Headlamp (bulb type)
WARNING
Type B, C
OQX089043
OQX089055N
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Cornering lamp
Headlamp (Low/High)
Daytime running lamp/parking lamp
Turn signal lamp
Side marker
8-52
ś Handle halogen bulbs with care.
Halogen bulbs contain pressurized
gas that will produce flying pieces
of glass that could cause injuries if
broken.
ś Wear eye protection when changing
a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down
before handling it.
ś Always handle them carefully, and
avoid scratches and abrasions. If
the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with
liquids.
ś Never touch the glass with bare
hands. Residual oil may cause the
bulb to overheat and burst when lit.
ś A bulb should be operated only when
installed in a headlamp.
ś If a bulb becomes damaged or
cracked, replace it immediately and
carefully dispose of it.
08
Headlamp (high/low beam)
OQX089015L
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the headlamp bulb cover by
turning it counterclockwise.
4. Disconnect the headlamp bulb
socket-connector.
5. Remove the bulb from the headlamp
assembly.
6. Install a new headlamp bulb and snap
the headlamp bulb retaining wire into
position by aligning the wire with the
groove on the bulb.
7. Connect the headlamp bulb socketconnector.
8. Install the headlamp bulb cover by
turning it clockwise.
Information
The headlamp aiming should be adjusted
after an accident or after the headlamp
assembly is reinstalled at an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
OQX089016L
Cornering lamp
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
4. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
5. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
6. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly.
7. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
Headlamp (LED type)
Your vehicle is equipped with LED lamps.
LED lamps do not have replaceable
bulbs. If the LED lamp does not
operate, have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-53
Maintenance
Side Repeater Lamp
Replacement (if equipped)
Type A
OQX089017L
Turn signal lamp/side marker
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
3. Remove the socket (1) from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
4. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
5. Install a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
6. Install the socket in the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly.
7. Push the socket into the assembly and
turn the socket clockwise.
Parking lamp and daytime running light
Your vehicle is equipped with LED lamps.
LED lamps do not have replaceable
bulbs. If the LED lamp does not
operate, have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
8-54
OHCR076032
Type B
OQXI049074
[Type A]
1. Remove the lamp assembly from the
vehicle by prying the lens and pulling
the assembly out.
2. Disconnect the bulb electrical
connector.
3. Separate the socket and the lens parts
by turning the socket counterclockwise
until the tabs on the socket align with
the slots on the lens part.
4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
5. Insert a new bulb in the socket.
6. Reassemble the socket and the lens part.
7. Connect the bulb electrical connector.
8. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
[Type B]
If the LED lamp does not operate, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
08
Rear Combination Light Bulb
Replacement
Type A (Standard)
OQXI079037
OQX089019N
Type B (LED)
Stop/tail Lamp And Turn Signal
Lamp Replacement
1. Open the liftgate.
2. Open the lamp assembly retaining
screw covers.
3. Loosen the lamp assembly retaining
screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.
OQX089056N
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Tail lamp
Stop/Tail lamp
Turn signal lamp
Back-up lamp
Side marker
OQXI079038
4. Remove the rear combination lamp
assembly from the body of the
vehicle.
8-55
Maintenance
Tail / Stop Lamp (Type B)
Type A (Standard)
Your vehicle is equipped with LED lamps.
LED lamps do not have replaceable
bulbs. If the LED lamp does not
operate, have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAi dealer.
Stop/tail lamp
Side Marker
Turn signal lamp
OQXI079039
Type B (LED)
Your vehicle is equipped with LED lamps.
LED lamps do not have replaceable
bulbs. If the LED lamp does not
operate, have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Back up
Turn signal lamp
OQXI079040
5. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
6. Remove the bulb from the socket
by pressing it in and rotating it
counterclockwise until the tabs on the
bulb align with the slots in the socket.
Pull the bulb out of the socket.
7. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into
the socket and rotating it until it locks
into place.
8. Install the socket into the assembly by
aligning the tabs on the socket with
the slots in the assembly. Push the
socket into the assembly and turn the
socket clockwise.
9. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
8-56
OQX089037
1. Disconnect the negative battery
cable.
2. Loosen the retaining clips under the
bumper and screws on the wheel
house trim.
3. Pry trim under the bumper toward the
vehicle.
4. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
5. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
6. Insert a new bulb in the socket.
7. Reinstall the light assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
08
High Mounted Stop Lamp
Replacement
License Plate Light Bulb
Replacement
OQX059132
1. Open the liftgate.
2. Remove the lamp cover from the lamp
assembly with a cross-tip screwdriver.
3. Remove the socket from the
assembly by turning the socket
counterclockwise until the tabs on
the socket align with the slots on the
assembly.
4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
5. Insert a new bulb in the socket.
6. Reinstall the light assembly to the
body of the vehicle.
OQX089034L
1. Remove the cover by pressing it as
direction of the arrows.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
3. Install a new bulb.
4. Reinstall in the reverse order.
8-57
Maintenance
Interior Light Bulb Replacement
Vanity mirror lamp
Map Lamp, Room Lamp, Vanity
Mirror Lamp, Luggage Compartment
Lamp And Glove Box Lamp
Map lamp (Type A)
OOS077046
Luggage compartment lamp
OQXI079045
Map lamp (Type B)
OQX089022L
OQX089044
Room lamp
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, gently
pry the lens from the interior lamp
housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight
out.
WARNING
Prior to working on the Interior Lights,
ensure that the “OFF” button is
depressed to avoid burning your fingers
or receiving an electric shock.
OQXI079043
3. Install a new bulb in the socket.
4. Align the lens tabs with the interior
lamp housing notches and snap the
lens into place.
NOTICE
Use care not to dirty or damage lens,
lens tab, and plastic housings.
8-58
08
APPEARANCE CARE
Exterior Care
Exterior General Caution
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning and
caution statements that appear on the
label.
High-pressure Washing
ś When using high-pressure washers,
make sure to maintain sufficient
distance from the vehicle. Insufficient
clearance or excessive pressure can
lead to component damage or water
penetration.
ś Do not spray the camera, sensors or
its surrounding area directly with a
high pressure washer. Shock applied
from high pressure water may cause
the device to not operate normally.
ś Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers) or
connectors as they may be damaged
if they come into contact with high
pressure water.
ś Do not use any high-pressure nozzles,
which induce either one-direct water
stream or water swirling.
Protecting Your Vehicle’s Finish
Washing
To help protect your vehicle’s finish from
rust and deterioration, wash it thoroughly
and frequently at least once a month
with lukewarm or cold water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to the
removal of any accumulation of salt, dirt,
mud, and other foreign materials. Make
sure the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors and rocker panels are kept
clear and clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar deposits
can damage your vehicle’s finish if not
removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain water
may not completely remove all these
deposits. A mild soap, safe for use on
painted surfaces, should be used.
After washing, rinse the vehicle
thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see
if they have been affected by water
before getting on the road. If braking
performance is impaired, dry the
brakes by applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward speed.
NOTICE
ś Do not use strong soap, chemical
detergents or hot water, and do not
wash the vehicle in direct sunlight
or when the body of the vehicle is
warm.
ś Be careful when washing the side
windows of your vehicle.
Especially, with high-pressure water,
water may leak through the windows
and wet the interior.
ś To prevent damage to the plastic
parts, do not clean with chemical
solvents or strong detergents.
8-59
Maintenance
OQX089025N
NOTICE
ś Water washing in the engine
compartment including high
pressure water washing may cause
the failure of electrical circuits
located in the engine compartment.
ś Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
Automatic car wash which uses rotating
brushes should not be used as this can
damage the surface of your vehicle. A
steam cleaner which washes the vehicle
surface at high temperature may result
the oil to adhere and leave stains that is
difficult to remove.
Use a soft cloth (e.g. microfiber towel
or sponge) when washing your vehicle
and dry with a microfiber towel. When
you hand wash your vehicle, you should
not use a cleaner that finishes with wax.
If the vehicle surface is too dirty (sand,
dirt, dust, contaminant, etc.), clean the
surface with water before washing the
car.
8-60
Waxing
A good coat of wax provides a barrier
between your paint and environmental
contamination.
Keeping a good coat of wax on your
vehicle will help protect it.
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle before
waxing. Use a good quality liquid or
paste wax, and follow the manufacturer’s
instructions. Wax all metal trim to protect
it and to maintain its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials
with a spot remover will usually strip the
wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax
these areas even if the rest of the vehicle
does not yet need waxing.
NOTICE
ś Wiping dust or dirt off the body with
a dry cloth will scratch the finish.
ś Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or
caustic agents on chrome-plated or
anodized aluminum parts. This may
result in damage to the protective
coating and cause discoloration or
paint deterioration.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
Do not use any polish protector such as
a detergent, an abrasive and a polish.
In case wax is applied, remove the wax
immediately using a silicon remover
and if any tar or tar contaminant is on
the surface use a tar remover to clean.
However, be careful not to apply too
much pressure on the painted area.
08
Repairing Your Vehicle’s Finish
Underbody Maintenance
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major repair
expense.
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated
rusting can occur on underbody parts
such as the fuel lines, frame, floor pan
and exhaust system, even though they
have been treated with rust protection.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody
and wheel openings with lukewarm or
cold water once a month, after off-road
driving and at the end of each winter. Pay
special attention to these areas because
it is difficult to see all the mud and dirt.
It will do more harm than good to wet
down the road grime without removing
it. The lower edges of doors, rocker
panels, and frame members have drain
holes that should not be allowed to clog
with dirt; trapped water in these areas
can cause rusting.
NOTICE
If your vehicle is damaged and requires
any metal repair or replacement,
be sure the body shop applies anticorrosion materials to the parts
repaired or replaced.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)
In case of matte paint finish vehicles,
it is impossible to modify only the
damaged area and repair of the whole
part is necessary. If the vehicle is
damaged and painting is required,
we recommend that you have your
vehicle maintained and repaired by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Take
extreme care, as it is difficult to restore
the quality after the repair.
Bright-metal Maintenance
ś To remove road tar and insects, use
a tar remover, not a scraper or other
sharp object.
ś To protect the surfaces of brightmetal
parts from corrosion, apply a coating
of wax or chrome preservative and rub
to a high luster.
ś During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test the
brakes while driving slowly to see if
they have been affected by water. If
braking performance is impaired, dry
the brakes by applying them lightly
while maintaining a slow forward
speed.
Aluminum Wheel Maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated with a
clear protective finish.
8-61
Maintenance
NOTICE
ś Do not use abrasive cleaner,
polishing compound, solvent, or wire
brushes on aluminum wheels.
ś Clean the wheel when it has cooled.
ś Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly with
water. Also, clean the wheels after
driving on salted roads.
ś Do not wash the wheels with highspeed car wash brushes.
ś Do not use any cleaners containing
acid or alkaline detergents.
Corrosion Protection
Protecting your vehicle from corrosion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, HYUNDAI produces vehicles
of the highest quality. However, this is
only part of the job. To achieve the longterm corrosion resistance your vehicle
can deliver, the owner’s cooperation and
assistance is also required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion
on your vehicle are:
ś Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath
the vehicle.
ś Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion
or minor scrapes and dents which
leave unprotected metal exposed to
corrosion.
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle is
regularly exposed to corrosive materials,
corrosion protection is particularly
important. Some of the common causes
of accelerated corrosion are road salts,
dust control chemicals, ocean air and
industrial pollution.
8-62
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to occur.
For example, corrosion is accelerated
by high humidity, particularly when
temperatures are just above freezing. In
such conditions, the corrosive material is
kept in contact with the car surfaces by
moisture that is slow to evaporate.
Mud is particularly corrosive because it is
slow to dry and holds moisture in contact
with the vehicle. Although the mud
appears to be dry, it can still retain the
moisture and promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate
corrosion of parts that are not properly
ventilated so the moisture can be
dispersed. For all these reasons, it is
particularly important to keep your
vehicle clean and free of mud or
accumulations of other materials. This
applies not only to the visible surfaces
but particularly to the underside of the
vehicle.
To help prevent corrosion
Keep your vehicle clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free of
corrosive materials. Attention to the
underside of the vehicle is particularly
important.
ś If you live in a high-corrosion area —
where road salts are used, near the
ocean, areas with industrial pollution,
acid rain, etc.—, you should take extra
care to prevent corrosion. In winter,
hose off the underside of your vehicle
at least once a month and be sure to
clean the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
08
ś When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, pay particular attention to the
components under the fenders and
other areas that are hidden from view.
Do a thorough job; just dampening
the accumulated mud rather than
washing it away will accelerate
corrosion rather than prevent it. Water
under high pressure and steam are
particularly effective in removing
accumulated mud and corrosive
materials.
ś When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members, be
sure that drain holes are kept open so
that moisture can escape and not be
trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your vehicle in a damp,
poorly ventilated garage. This creates
a favorable environment for corrosion.
This is particularly true if you wash your
vehicle in the garage or drive it into the
garage when it is still wet or covered with
snow, ice or mud. Even a heated garage
can contribute to corrosion unless it is
well ventilated so moisture is dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish should
be covered with “touch-up” paint as
soon as possible to reduce the possibility
of corrosion. If bare metal is showing
through, the attention of a qualified body
and paint shop is recommended.
Bird droppings are highly corrosive and
may damage painted surfaces in just a
few hours. Always remove bird droppings
as soon as possible.
Interior Care
Interior General Precautions
Prevent caustic solutions such as
perfume and cosmetic oil, from
contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage or discoloration.
If they do contact the interior parts,
wipe them off immediately. See the
instructions for the proper way to clean
vinyl.
NOTICE
ś Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/
electronic components inside the
vehicle as this may damage them.
ś When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use
neutral detergents or low alcohol
content solutions. If you use high
alcohol content solutions or acid/
alkaline detergents, the color of the
leather may fade or the surface may
get stripped off.
Cleaning the Upholstery and Interior
Trim
Vinyl (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.
Clean vinyl surfaces with a vinyl cleaner.
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
fabric with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solution
recommended for upholstery or carpets.
Remove fresh spots immediately with
a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do
not receive immediate attention, the
fabric can be stained and its color can be
affected. Also, its fire-resistant properties
can be reduced if the material is not
properly maintained.
8-63
Maintenance
NOTICE
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may affect the
fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant
properties.
Leather (if equipped)
ś Features of seat leather
- Leather is made from the outer skin
of an animal, which goes through a
special process to be available for
use. Since it is a natural product,
each part differs in thickness or
density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature and
humidity.
- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving
comfort and stability.
- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
CAUTION
ś Wrinkles or abrasions which appear
naturally from usage are not covered
by warranty.
ś Belts with metallic accessories,
zippers or keys inside the back
pocket may damage the seat fabric.
ś Make sure not to wet the seat. It may
change the nature of natural leather.
ś Jeans or clothes which could bleach
may contaminate the surface of the
seat covering fabric.
8-64
ś Caring for the leather seats
- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the seat. It
will prevent abrasion or damage of
the leather and maintain its quality.
- Wipe the natural leather seat cover
often with dry or soft cloth.
- Use of proper leather protector may
prevent abrasion of the cover and
helps maintain the color. Be sure to
read the instructions and consult
a specialist when using leather
coating or protective agent.
- Light colored (beige, cream beige)
leather is easily contaminated and
the stain is noticeable. Clean the
seats frequently.
- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
ś Cleaning the leather seats
- Remove all contaminations
instantly. Refer to instructions below
for removal of each contaminant.
- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminated spot.
Wipe off the cream with a wet cloth
and remove water with a dry cloth.
- Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until
contaminations do not smear.
- Oil
Remove oil instantly with
absorbable cloth and wipe with
stain remover used only for natural
leather.
- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and
remove gradually.
08
Cleaning the Seat Belt Webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any
mild soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the soap.
Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing
because this may weaken the seat belt.
Cleaning the Interior Window Glass
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become hazy (that is, covered
with an oily, greasy or waxy film), they
should be cleaned with glass cleaner.
Follow the directions on the glass cleaner
container.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the inside of
the rear window. This may result in
damage to the rear window defroster
grid.
EMISSION CONTROL
SYSTEM
The emission control system of your
vehicle is covered by a written limited
warranty. Please see the warranty
information contained in the Owner’s
Handbook & Warranty Information
booklet in your vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emission control system to meet all
applicable emission regulations. There
are three emission control systems, as
follows.
(1) Crankcase emission control system
(2) Evaporative emission control system
(3) Exhaust emission control system
In order to ensure the proper function
of the emission control systems, it
is recommended that you have your
vehicle inspected and maintained
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in
accordance with the maintenance
schedule in this manual.
NOTICE
For the Inspection and Maintenance
Test (with Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system)
ś To prevent the vehicle from misfiring
during dynamometer testing, turn
the Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system off by pressing the ESC
switch (ESC OFF light illuminated).
ś After dynamometer testing is
completed, turn the ESC system back
on by pressing the ESC switch again.
8-65
Maintenance
1. Crankcase Emission Control
System
3. Exhaust Emission Control
System
The positive crankcase ventilation system
is employed to prevent air pollution
caused by blow-by gases being emitted
from the crankcase. This system supplies
fresh filtered air to the crankcase through
the air intake hose. Inside the crankcase,
the fresh air mixes with blow-by gases,
which then pass through the PCV valve
into the induction system.
The Exhaust Emission Control System is
a highly effective system which controls
exhaust emissions while maintaining
good vehicle performance.
When the engine starts or fails to start,
excessive attempts to restart the engine
may cause damage to the emission
system.
2. Evaporative Emission Control
System Including Onboard
Refueling Vapor Recovery
(ORVR)
The Evaporative Emission Control System
is designed to prevent fuel vapors from
escaping into the atmosphere. The
ORVR system is designed to allow the
vapors from the fuel tank to be loaded
into a canister while refueling at the gas
station, preventing the escape of fuel
vapors into the atmosphere.
Canister
Fuel vapors generated inside the fuel
tank are absorbed and stored in the
onboard canister. When the engine is
running, the fuel vapors absorbed in the
canister are drawn into the surge tank
through the purge control solenoid valve.
Purge Control Solenoid Valve (PCSV)
The purge control solenoid valve
is controlled by the Engine Control
Module (ECM); when the engine coolant
temperature is low during idling, the
PCSV closes so that evaporated fuel
is not taken into the engine. After the
engine warms-up during ordinary
driving, the PCSV opens to introduce
evaporated fuel to the engine.
8-66
Engine Exhaust (carbon Monoxide)
Precautions
ś Carbon monoxide can be present
with other exhaust fumes. If you smell
exhaust fumes of any kind in your
vehicle, drive with all the windows
fully open. Have your vehicle checked
and repaired immediately.
WARNING
Engine exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide (CO). Though colorless and
odorless, it is dangerous and could be
lethal if inhaled. Follow the instructions
on this page to avoid CO poisoning.
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Engine exhaust and a wide variety of
automobile components and parts,
including components found in the
interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain
or emit chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and
birth defects and reproductive harm.
In addition, certain fluids contained
in vehicles and certain products of
component wear contain or emit
chemicals known to the State of
California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm.
08
ś Do not operate the engine in confined
or closed areas (such as garages) any
more than what is necessary to move
the vehicle in or out of the area.
ś When the vehicle is stopped in an
open area for more than a short time
with the engine running, adjust the
ventilation system (as needed) to draw
outside air into the vehicle.
ś Never sit in a parked or stopped
vehicle for any extended time with the
engine running.
ś When the engine stalls or fails to
start, excessive attempts to restart
the engine may cause damage to the
emission control system.
Operating Precautions for Catalytic
Converters (if equipped)
WARNING
The exhaust system and catalytic
converter are very hot during and
immediately after the engine has been
running. To avoid SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH:
ś Do not park, idle, or drive the vehicle
over or near flammable objects, such
as grass, vegetation, paper, leaves,
etc. A hot exhaust system can ignite
flammable items under your vehicle.
ś Keep away from the exhaust system
and catalytic converter or you may
get burned.
Also, Do not remove the heat sink
around the exhaust system, do not
seal the bottom of the vehicle, and
do not coat the vehicle for corrosion
control. It may present a fire risk
under certain conditions.
Your vehicle is equipped with a catalytic
converter emission control device.
To prevent damage to the catalytic
converter and to your vehicle, take the
following precautions:
ś Use only UNLEADED FUEL for
gasoline engines.
ś Do not operate the vehicle when
there are signs of engine malfunction,
such as misfire or a noticeable loss of
performance.
ś Do not misuse or abuse the engine.
Examples of misuse are coasting with
the engine off and descending steep
grades in gear with the engine off.
ś Do not operate the engine at high
idle speed for extended periods (5
minutes or more).
ś Do not modify or tamper with any
part of the engine or emission
control system. All inspections and
adjustments must be made by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ś Avoid driving with extremely low
fuel level. If you run out of gasoline,
it could cause the engine to misfire
and result in excessive loading of the
catalytic converter.
8-67
Maintenance
CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE NOTICE
Perchlorate Material-special handling may apply, See:
https://dtsc.ca.gov/perchlorate.
Notice to California Vehicle Dismantlers:
Perchlorate containing materials, such as air bag inflators, seatbelt pretensioners and
keyless remote entry batteries, must be disposed of according to Title 22 California
Code of Regulations Section 67384.10 (a).
8-68
08
CONSUMER INFORMATION
This consumer information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued
by the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.Your HYUNDAI dealer will help answer any questions you may have as
you read this information.
HYUNDAI motor vehicles are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed all
applicable safety standards.
For your safety, however, we strongly urge you to read and follow all directions in
this Owner’s Manual, particularly the information under the headings “NOTICE”,
“CAUTION” and “WARNING”.
If, after reading this manual, you have any questions regarding the operation of your
vehicle, please contact the Hyundai Customer Care Center.
Hyundai Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728
800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through Friday,
between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST
and Saturday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Care assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are available
Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
8-69
Maintenance
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause
injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888- 327-4236
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov;
download the SaferCar mobile application;
or write to: Administrator, NHTSA
1200 New Jersey Ave, SE,
West Building Washington, D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a
safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your
dealer, or HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.
8-70
Index
I
Index
A
Accessing Your Vehicle .........................................................................................5-4
Immobilizer System ........................................................................................ 5-11
Remote Key....................................................................................................... 5-4
Smart Key.......................................................................................................... 5-7
Air Bag - Advanced Supplemental Restraint System ..........................................3-31
Additional Safety Precautions ......................................................................... 3-51
Air Bag Warning Labels .................................................................................. 3-51
How Does the Air Bag System Operate? ........................................................ 3-36
Occupant Classification System (OCS) .......................................................... 3-40
SRS Care ......................................................................................................... 3-50
What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates ....................................................... 3-39
Where Are the Air Bags?................................................................................. 3-33
Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? ............................................. 3-46
Air Cleaner...........................................................................................................8-21
Filter Replacement .......................................................................................... 8-21
Air Conditioning System .....................................................................................2-10
Appearance Care..................................................................................................8-59
Exterior Care ................................................................................................... 8-59
Interior Care .................................................................................................... 8-63
Automatic Climate Control System .....................................................................5-56
Automatic Temperature Control Mode ........................................................... 5-57
Manual Temperature Control Mode ................................................................ 5-58
System Maintenance ....................................................................................... 5-63
System Operation ............................................................................................ 5-62
B
Battery .................................................................................................................8-25
Battery Recharging.......................................................................................... 8-26
For Best Battery Service ................................................................................. 8-26
Reset Features ................................................................................................. 8-26
Before Driving .......................................................................................................6-5
Before Entering the Vehicle .............................................................................. 6-5
Before Starting .................................................................................................. 6-5
I-2
I
Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) .................................................................6-31
Detecting Sensor ............................................................................................. 6-34
Limitations of the System ............................................................................... 6-36
System Description ......................................................................................... 6-31
System Setting................................................................................................. 6-32
Warning and System Control .......................................................................... 6-33
Brake/Clutch Fluid ..............................................................................................8-19
Checking the Brake/Clutch Fluid Level.......................................................... 8-19
Brake System .......................................................................................................6-20
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)....................................................................... 6-22
Disc Brakes Wear Indicator............................................................................. 6-20
Electronic Stability Control (ESC).................................................................. 6-24
Good Braking Practices................................................................................... 6-27
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ...................................................................... 6-27
Parking Brake .................................................................................................. 6-21
Power Brakes .................................................................................................. 6-20
Rear Drum Brakes ........................................................................................... 6-20
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) ............................................................ 6-26
Bulb Wattage..........................................................................................................2-8
C
California Perchlorate Notice ..............................................................................8-68
Child Restraint System (CRS) .............................................................................3-23
Children Always in the Rear ........................................................................... 3-23
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)...................................................... 3-25
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) ...................................................... 3-24
Climate Control Air Filter....................................................................................8-22
Filter Inspection .............................................................................................. 8-22
Consumer Information .........................................................................................8-69
Cruise Control......................................................................................................6-82
Cruise Control Operation ................................................................................ 6-82
D
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY ................................................................6-39
The Radio Frequency Components (Rear Corner Radar) Complies:.............. 6-39
Dimensions ............................................................................................................2-7
I-3
Index
Door Locks ..........................................................................................................5-12
Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features ................................................... 5-15
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks ................................................................... 5-15
Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle .............................................. 5-13
Operating Door Locks from Outside the Vehicle ............................................ 5-12
Drive Mode Integrated Control System...............................................................6-28
LCD Display Message .................................................................................... 6-30
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) .......................................................................6-78
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert ..................................................................... 6-81
Resetting the System ....................................................................................... 6-79
System Malfunction ........................................................................................ 6-79
System Setting and Activation ........................................................................ 6-78
System Standby ............................................................................................... 6-79
E
Emission Control System ....................................................................................8-65
Crankcase Emission Control System .............................................................. 8-66
Evaporative Emission Control System Including Onboard Refueling Vapor
Recovery (ORVR) ........................................................................................... 8-66
Exhaust Emission Control System .................................................................. 8-66
Engine ....................................................................................................................2-7
Engine Compartment .............................................................................................8-3
Engine Compartment .............................................................................................2-6
Engine Coolant ....................................................................................................8-16
Changing Engine Coolant ............................................................................... 8-18
Checking the Engine Coolant Level ............................................................... 8-16
Engine Number ....................................................................................................2-14
Engine Oil ............................................................................................................8-15
Checking the Engine Oil and Filter................................................................. 8-15
Checking the Engine Oil Level ....................................................................... 8-15
Explanation of Scheduled Maintenance Items ....................................................8-12
Air Cleaner Filter ............................................................................................ 8-13
Air Conditioning Refrigerant .......................................................................... 8-14
Brake/Clutch Fluid .......................................................................................... 8-14
Brake Discs, Pads, Calipers and Rotors .......................................................... 8-14
Brake Hoses and Lines .................................................................................... 8-13
Cooling System ............................................................................................... 8-13
Drive Belts ...................................................................................................... 8-12
I-4
I
Drive Shafts and Boots.................................................................................... 8-14
Engine Coolant ................................................................................................ 8-13
Engine Oil and Filter ....................................................................................... 8-12
Exhaust Pipe and Muffler................................................................................ 8-14
Fuel Filter ........................................................................................................ 8-12
Fuel Lines, Fuel Hoses and Connections ........................................................ 8-12
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) Fluid ................................................ 8-13
Manual Transmission Fluid ............................................................................. 8-13
Parking Brake .................................................................................................. 8-14
Spark Plugs...................................................................................................... 8-13
Steering Gear Box, Linkage & Boots/Lower Arm Ball Joint ......................... 8-14
Suspension Mounting Bolts ............................................................................ 8-14
Vacuum Crankcase Ventilation Hoses ............................................................. 8-12
Vapor Hose and Fuel Filler Cap ...................................................................... 8-12
Exterior Features..................................................................................................5-75
Roof Side Rails ............................................................................................... 5-75
Exterior Features..................................................................................................5-31
Fuel Filler Door ............................................................................................... 5-34
Hood ................................................................................................................ 5-31
Liftgate ............................................................................................................ 5-32
Exterior Overview .................................................................................................2-2
F
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) System ...........................................6-48
FCA Sensor ..................................................................................................... 6-52
FCA Warning Message and System Control ................................................... 6-50
Limitations of the System ............................................................................... 6-54
System Malfunction ........................................................................................ 6-53
System Setting and Activation ........................................................................ 6-48
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) System-Sensor Fusion ...................6-59
FCA Sensor ..................................................................................................... 6-63
FCA Warning Message and System Control ................................................... 6-61
Limitations of the System ............................................................................... 6-66
System Malfunction ........................................................................................ 6-65
System Setting and Activation ........................................................................ 6-59
Fuel Requirements .................................................................................................1-5
I-5
Index
Fuses ....................................................................................................................8-39
Engine Compartment Panel Fuse Replacement .............................................. 8-41
Fuse/Relay Panel Description ......................................................................... 8-43
Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement ............................................................... 8-40
G
Guide to Hyundai Genuine Parts ...........................................................................1-3
H
Hazard Warning Flasher ........................................................................................7-2
How to Use This Manual .......................................................................................1-4
I
If the Engine Overheats .........................................................................................7-6
If the Engine Will Not Start ...................................................................................7-3
If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over or Turns Over Slowly ................................... 7-3
If the Engine Turns Over Normally but Doesn’t Start ...................................... 7-3
If you Have a Flat Tire (With Spare Tire) ............................................................7-15
Changing Tires ................................................................................................ 7-16
Jack and Tools ................................................................................................. 7-15
Ignition Switch ......................................................................................................6-6
Engine Start/Stop Button................................................................................... 6-9
Key Ignition Switch .......................................................................................... 6-6
Important Safety Precautions.................................................................................3-2
Air Bag Hazards ................................................................................................ 3-2
Always Wear Your Seat Belt ............................................................................. 3-2
Control Your Speed ........................................................................................... 3-2
Driver Distraction.............................................................................................. 3-2
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition ............................................................... 3-2
Restrain All Children......................................................................................... 3-2
In Case of an Emergency While Driving ...............................................................7-2
If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad or Crossing................................................. 7-2
If the Engine Stalls While Driving .................................................................... 7-2
If you Have a Flat Tire While Driving .............................................................. 7-3
I-6
I
Infotainment System ............................................................................................5-76
Antenna ........................................................................................................... 5-76
Audio (Display Audio) / Video / Navigation System (AVN) .......................... 5-78
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology Hands-Free ............................................... 5-78
Steering Wheel Audio Control ........................................................................ 5-77
USB and IPod® Port ....................................................................................... 5-76
Instrument Cluster .................................................................................................4-4
Gauges and Meters ............................................................................................ 4-5
Instrument Cluster Control................................................................................ 4-5
LCD Display Messages ................................................................................... 4-17
Transmission Shift Indicator ............................................................................. 4-8
Warning and Indicator Lights............................................................................ 4-9
Instrument Panel Overview ...................................................................................2-5
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) ..............................................................6-15
Good Driving Practices ................................................................................... 6-19
Intelligent Variable Transmission (IVT) Operation ........................................ 6-15
Interior Features ...................................................................................................5-69
Cargo Area Cover ............................................................................................ 5-74
Clock ............................................................................................................... 5-72
Clothes Hanger ................................................................................................ 5-72
Cup Holder ...................................................................................................... 5-69
Floor Mat Anchor(s)........................................................................................ 5-73
Luggage Net Holder ........................................................................................ 5-73
Power Outlet.................................................................................................... 5-70
Sunvisor........................................................................................................... 5-70
USB Charger ................................................................................................... 5-71
Interior Overview...................................................................................................2-4
J
Jump Starting .........................................................................................................7-4
L
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) ................................................................................6-71
Limitations of the System ............................................................................... 6-76
LKA System Function Change........................................................................ 6-77
LKA System Operation ................................................................................... 6-72
Warning Light and Message............................................................................ 6-75
I-7
Index
LCD Display ........................................................................................................4-22
LCD Display Control ...................................................................................... 4-22
LCD Display Modes ....................................................................................... 4-23
Light Bulbs ..........................................................................................................8-50
Headlamp, Parking Lamp, Daytime Running Light, Turn Signal Lamp,
Cornering Lamp and Side Marker................................................................... 8-50
High Mounted Stop Lamp Replacement ......................................................... 8-57
Interior Light Bulb Replacement .................................................................... 8-58
License Plate Light Bulb Replacement ........................................................... 8-57
Rear Combination Light Bulb Replacement ................................................... 8-55
Side Repeater Lamp Replacement .................................................................. 8-54
Lighting ...............................................................................................................5-36
Exterior Lights ................................................................................................ 5-36
Interior Lights.................................................................................................. 5-42
M
Maintenance Services ............................................................................................8-4
Owner Maintenance Precautions....................................................................... 8-4
Owner’s Responsibility ..................................................................................... 8-4
Manual Climate Control System .........................................................................5-48
Heating and Air Conditioning ......................................................................... 5-49
System Maintenance ....................................................................................... 5-54
System Operation ............................................................................................ 5-52
Manual Transmission ...........................................................................................6-12
Good Driving Practices ................................................................................... 6-14
Manual Transmission Operation ..................................................................... 6-12
Mirrors .................................................................................................................5-19
Inside Rearview Mirror ................................................................................... 5-19
Side View Mirrors ........................................................................................... 5-20
O
Owner Maintenance ...............................................................................................8-5
Owner Maintenance Schedule........................................................................... 8-5
P
Parking Brake ......................................................................................................8-20
Checking the Parking Brake............................................................................ 8-20
I-8
I
R
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) ..................................................6-40
Detecting Sensor ............................................................................................. 6-43
Limitations of the System ............................................................................... 6-44
System Description ......................................................................................... 6-40
System Setting and Operation ......................................................................... 6-40
Warning and System Control .......................................................................... 6-42
Rear View Monitor System .................................................................................5-47
Recommended Lubricants and Capacities ........................................................... 2-11
Recommended SAE Viscosity Number .......................................................... 2-12
Reporting Safety Defects .....................................................................................8-70
S
Safety Messages.....................................................................................................1-4
Scheduled Maintenance Services ..........................................................................8-7
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions................................................ 8-11
Normal Maintenance Schedule ......................................................................... 8-8
Normal Maintenance Schedule (CONT)........................................................... 8-9
Normal Maintenance Schedule (CONT)......................................................... 8-10
Severe Driving Conditions .............................................................................. 8-11
Seat Belts .............................................................................................................3-14
Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions ......................................................... 3-20
Care of Seat Belts ............................................................................................ 3-22
Seat Belt Restraint System .............................................................................. 3-16
Seat Belt Safety Precautions ........................................................................... 3-14
Seat Belt Warning Light .................................................................................. 3-15
Seats .......................................................................................................................3-3
Front Seats......................................................................................................... 3-5
Head Restraints ................................................................................................. 3-9
Rear Seats .......................................................................................................... 3-7
Safety Precautions ............................................................................................. 3-4
Seat Warmers................................................................................................... 3-12
I-9
Index
Special Driving Conditions .................................................................................6-85
Driving at Night .............................................................................................. 6-86
Driving in Flooded Areas ................................................................................ 6-86
Driving in the Rain .......................................................................................... 6-86
Hazardous Driving Conditions........................................................................ 6-85
Highway Driving............................................................................................. 6-87
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover ..................................................................... 6-87
Rocking the Vehicle ........................................................................................ 6-85
Smooth Cornering ........................................................................................... 6-86
Steering Wheel.....................................................................................................5-17
Electric Power Steering (EPS) ........................................................................ 5-17
Horn................................................................................................................. 5-19
Tilt Steering / Telescope Steering ................................................................... 5-18
Storage Compartment ..........................................................................................5-68
Center Console Storage ................................................................................... 5-68
Glove Box ....................................................................................................... 5-69
Sliding Armrest ............................................................................................... 5-68
Sunroof ................................................................................................................5-26
Automatic Reversal ......................................................................................... 5-28
Front Lamps .................................................................................................... 5-29
Sunroof Opening and Closing ......................................................................... 5-28
Sunroof Open Warning.................................................................................... 5-30
Sunshade ......................................................................................................... 5-27
Tilt Open/close ................................................................................................ 5-27
T
Theft-Alarm System ............................................................................................5-16
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (Type A) .............................................7-7
Changing a Tire with TPMS ............................................................................. 7-8
TPMS Malfunction Indicator ............................................................................ 7-8
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) (Type B) ...........................................7-10
Changing a Tire with TPMS ........................................................................... 7-13
Check Tire Pressure......................................................................................... 7-10
Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position Indicator ............................... 7-12
Low Tire Pressure Telltale............................................................................... 7-12
Tire Pressure Monitoring System .................................................................... 7-11
TPMS Malfunction Indicator .......................................................................... 7-13
Tires and Wheels ...................................................................................................2-9
I-10
I
Tires and Wheels .................................................................................................8-27
All Season Tires .............................................................................................. 8-37
Check Tire Inflation Pressure .......................................................................... 8-28
Low Aspect Ratio Tires ................................................................................... 8-38
Radial-Ply Tires............................................................................................... 8-38
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures.................................................. 8-27
Snow Tires....................................................................................................... 8-37
Summer Tires .................................................................................................. 8-37
Tire Care .......................................................................................................... 8-27
Tire Maintenance............................................................................................. 8-31
Tire Replacement ............................................................................................ 8-30
Tire Rotation ................................................................................................... 8-29
Tire Sidewall Labeling .................................................................................... 8-31
Tire Terminology and Definitions ................................................................... 8-35
Tire Traction .................................................................................................... 8-31
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ................................................................ 8-29
Wheel Replacement ........................................................................................ 8-31
Tire Specification and Pressure Label .................................................................2-14
Towing .................................................................................................................7-21
Emergency Towing.......................................................................................... 7-23
Removable Towing Hook................................................................................ 7-22
Tie-down Hook ............................................................................................... 7-24
Towing Service................................................................................................ 7-21
Trailer Towing .....................................................................................................6-95
Trip Computer......................................................................................................4-31
V
Vehicle Break-In Process .......................................................................................1-7
Vehicle Certification Label ..................................................................................2-13
Vehicle Data Collection and Event Data Recorders ..............................................1-8
Vehicle Identification Number (vin) ....................................................................2-13
Vehicle Load Limit ..............................................................................................6-91
Tire Loading Information Label ...................................................................... 6-91
Vehicle Modifications ............................................................................................1-7
Volume and Weight ..............................................................................................2-10
I-11
Index
W
Washer Fluid ........................................................................................................8-20
Checking the Washer Fluid Level ................................................................... 8-20
Windows ..............................................................................................................5-22
Power Windows .............................................................................................. 5-23
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging ................................................................5-65
Rear Window Defroster................................................................................... 5-67
Winter Driving .....................................................................................................6-88
Snow or Icy Conditions................................................................................... 6-88
Winter Precautions .......................................................................................... 6-89
Wiper Blades........................................................................................................8-23
Blade Inspection .............................................................................................. 8-23
Blade Replacement.......................................................................................... 8-23
Wipers and Washers .............................................................................................5-45
Rear Window Wiper and Washer .................................................................... 5-46
Windshield Washers ........................................................................................ 5-46
Windshield Wipers .......................................................................................... 5-45
I-12